Home
        LXE VX6 User's Manual
         Contents
1.                                        322 Control Panel Options  Power  Depending on the Software Revision  some devices may have a Schemes tab   Factory Default Settings  Switch state to User Idle Never  Switch state to System Idle Never  Switch state to Suspen Never  The Schemes tab can be used to control the display backlight and shut the VX6 Off  The mode  timers are cumulative  The System Idle timer begins the countdown after the User Idle timer has  expired and the Suspend timer begins the countdown after the System Idle timer has expired  For  example  if the User Idle timer is set to Never  the power scheme timers never place the device in  User Idle  System Idle or Suspend modes   For a VX6  the User Idle state turns off the display backlight  There is no System Idle mode so  the VX6 remains in User Idle mode until the Suspend timer expires or a primary even occurs   Please see    Power Modes    in Chapter 2     Physical Description and Layout      IMPORTANT  There is no Suspend mode on the VX6  If the Suspend timer is enabled  the  VX6 will shut down when the Suspend timer expires   Power Properties m OK E  Schemes   Device Status  Power Scheme  Jac Power y  3  Switch state to User Idle   Never y   Switch state to System Idle   Never y   Switch state to Suspend   Never y   Figure C 19 Power Properties  The Device Status tab displays the status of power managed devices  Note that since the VX6  does not support power management  all devices show the    high    power
2.                               267  Pas vo           M 268    E EQ VX6RG J    Index    O O 263  AppLock Registry settings                 eeeeee 339  ASCII Control Codes in hex                          sss 341  At Power OM   ccccononoconcnccnononcnononcnccnnanananoncnnos 115 319  Audio   CONNEC COT   ere erede eed 46  Auto hide  iaa iia 86  304  Auto reconnect  Bluetooth                       sss 99    B    Background and Window colors                     102  313  Backlight timers                      sss 102  313  Barcode   Data Entty cuadras tada 9   Enable or Disable                             ees 161   Symbology Settings                    sse 163  Barcode data   edit buttons    nee retener 166  Barcode manipulation                         eee 158  Barcode match list                       eee 166  Barcode processing overview                     seseess 157  Barcode scanner data entry                    sess 9  Barcode Tab  oe etm p Heer 161  Battery   CMOS  SpecificatiOWMS    ooooonconnonincnocnnicncanonnnonos 287  Battery Auto Turn Off    102  313  Baud Raten sansi 119  157  323  Beeper  Specifications                   sss 287  Bluetooth   barcode reader setup   ooooooccocccoccconinononononnnnnnnnnnnnos 21   deVIi COS                   O 20   Initial Us a E 17   LXEZ Pairing specification                    esee 33   ens Em 18   Subsequent Use    19  Bluetooth control panel                           sess 93  Bluetooth Properties panel                            ssses 9
3.                 esee 84  302  Component Locations                essen 6 8  Computer Friendly Name                        sss 98  Configuration   AppLock E crescissi sinesine 270   Ethernet e eesenia eee 137  Connect   ACUVES VNC arrir teika inoks einai 83  301  Connect Using               essere 116  320  Connector   AUGIO RS 46   USB paa oe Re RR 41  Connectors    tees te 36  Connectors  Specifications                  ssssssss 287  Contrast Up and Down   Not applicable    iori tte 56  Control characters    169  Control Keys  locati0O    ooooononnnnnincnicnnocnoonconnconccnnoo 56  Control Panel options                        eee 87  305  Controller  Video   Specifications                          287  Copyrights   cooooonoccocccocononononocononnnonononncnanonanonos 122  326  GPUs toes tetendit dU e Red ERU 1 31    Create a dialup  direct  or VPN connection    113  317    VX6 Reference Guide    Index    Ctrl Char Mapping                  esses 161  169  Current Time canada taa 100  311  Custom ID  A A s E aie ERE 171  Custom identifiers               esses 170  Custom Identifiers                    sese 161    D    Data Bits iih ues 119  157  323  Data Cnty narnia ae 9  Daylight Savings                    ees 100  311  DB9 DB9O Serial Cable   Tech Specifications                       sss 39  130  Decimal   Hexadecimal Equivalent   iub                          345   A esse cesenss ETE ieas 346  Defaults   Caps Eock ueceenveei erre ters 54  A MUNDUS 105  315  Desktop  uiae ter
4.              R    85  A                                      M    86  Porn iM PE                                     86  Control AA RM aN ER ARNBUE RARI ERRARE RARE 87  POUL                                               s 88  Language and FONDIS ii iio 89  Identityine Soltware do ii 90  Ridi MAC AM ta 90  ACCESSIBILI OI e A ener ean  91  O Contool tocas 92  AP PA A 93  PASCO ao cman M  S 94  Bluetooth DEVICES isa in 95  BluetootiDevice Properties daa 96  A ssa HT CP PE REED 9T  Turn Off Bluetooth Butt OH  uen ape eroe e P ee wit eid nto pli pee FRU bo oo Fl Cea 97  OPI asset dae tue tan Pan a a a a a Ta E Rech d esata 97  T0  P A A E O E              98  Easy Patria and Auto Rec uscar EE dod EES ERENS 99  A A 100  brocante 100  juo p ats d MEE UP RR 101  jc  mate emet tn 102  DA PM er 102  PEG ATG ec cers ato ae                              102  A A tae 102  put Panal custodia 103  Internet OPHONS NN E 104  Keyboard es neni                            P 105  Key P anan N A 106  T EANET A E E AEE E A e Cos DoD come 106  A a ea haa      n    h 107  RC A 108  iO A n ea UEP nels oor ey ARRE 108  How To  Remap a Koy Seguen enini a E E AEA 108  How To  Remap an  Application Lis na ena 108  How To  Remap a Command eii ia 109  A E EE E E E E E E E EEE E E E Sewers 110    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    vi Table of Contents    MONSE ONO Tm M E T 111  MEA AO IU MT 111  COMINO ri 111  Enable TERESA A A A A A deeds a 111  Allow Remote Desktop Autolo Niutin rada 111  Attola unica TIMES
5.              eene 286   APPENDIX B TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS 287  POTS Ev sre Doe e ET npl ie Bla SSeS aia 287  Environmental Specifications iuuenes ab nc EFE EA REM A Sa GE LGE PUE RIF nsin 288   Duplo 289  UPS Battery Pack Specifications aiii 289  Network Device Specifications             cccccccccsseseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeseeeeeeeeenees 290  Summit 802 11b g CF 2 4GHZ aire 290  S  mmit 802 1 DAE CF 2 4 5 QGH ces 290  BONO HDI deb HMM O IAN 290  PCMCIA Cisco c  Type M t     P     291  PCMCIA  Symbol 11016 2 AGHZ Type iii id 291   APPENDIX C VX6 CE  NET 4 2 293  A et os y MN I A 293  Windows CE   NET 4 2 Operating System                                         eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeee 293   Wireless Network  Onn Il as onder stan axa Re aot 293  os Sa A A IS 293  A imis d x eiat amid id llontdata tuuc bcne Dexbdcica timed 293  INSI SOIN ono iii 294  O A rH 294  Software ADPIC dali di ATO 294  O INN m T E EE 295  LXE BPCO HOD o paa hme RA Mao did 295  A A A A In 295  Wavelink Avalanche Enabler  Optional  ao 295   B E AE  o S SE A ea E E M D E E E E NM E a DU 297  Folders  Copiesat Startur O A R UAM URN BM 298  My Computer PO aa 298  Start Menu Program BIOS siii 299  Commu dad 300  e NE 300  CONICO ou bb NR A E RN MUN ni aM MM 301    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    Table of Contents   Start FTP Server  Stop FIP SBEUBE ari id iii 301  Command Prom pi A a TE 302  A E EAE NEE 302  Media PEIUBE  siii siii 302  Remote Desktop Connection asserenar Fed E N see  303  EEE E e
6.            124  Phillips No  1 Screwdriver                       sesssssss 63  Physical Controls                         eene 35  Physical Specification                      sss 287  Pin 9   COMI I and Scanner                  sse 37   IPOWEF EL              119  323  Pin O POW  RUBER EEUU MIE 157  Pinout   COMI 2  seni ii ie Ges eR BREE 37   COM a e 38  Power Cable   Adapting VX1 2 4 Power Supply                         72  Power Connector                  eese 47   A Hone gr UR Hi Hee 7   Specification   oooooconnnnoconocnconcnoncconcconcnnnonnnonnnnnos 287  Power Port 1 while asleep                        esses 159  Power Status LED                      eene 35  Power Supply   CMOS  Battery    niente entr tn tete beer 32   CMOS NiCd Battery                 sss 73   Specifications    ooooccnonoconocnnoncconconnonnnonccno conocio 287  NS susestosagstvorashecgeoievsesineeevotevseas ds 35   Localia id 7   Se sieecisisthi esiis ieisereiss 287    E EQ VX6RG J    Index    PREGEDITEXE 200 133  Pre loaded FilesS      oononnnccnnnnccononaccconononnos   76  131  294  Printer Serial Port    eei iris 38  Processing order                    eere 163  Prompt   Comm ias 84  302  Q  Quick Start Instructions                   seen 4    R    Radio   MAC Address occcccococcnononnncnnnancnninnanononananonnn 90  308  Radio Specifications   ORCS Gl pV A ne EEE ES 290  291  RAe E E 105 315  R  calibration  iii 120  324  AAA EE 135  136  Regional Setting     oononnncncnnncnnnncnnnenennnnnraranancc
7.            sess 165  Strip Leading and Trailing                                     157  SMS nina 10  60  Data Entry            asserentes 10  properties    sce dais 120  324  SOON iii 120  324  VX6 Reference Guide    358    Switch applications    Multi AppLock             2 eee 5  Symbol ID   and EV 15 Imager    162  Symbology setting parameters                               164  Symbology Settings                    sse 161  System   Hardware Configuration                    ssssssss 30  System  Memoty      onere ER ais 31  System Requirements  WPA  Cisco                        223    T    Terminal Emulator List                       sss 1  Terminal Emulator  connect                         esses 12  0 BU E           P 102  313  Tine AMS 100  311  Toggle 2nd key on and off                            ssss 55  Torque Wrench    nene 63  TOUC  SCIEON    ccconocccnnonoccnononcncnonancnononanononancnronnnos 10  60  Data Enlty   ect tere veis eoe reo rever ae i 10  Finger or Stylus                sese 10  A A EES REGERES 60  Tiansctibet   secnm u 85  303  Translate All               essere 169  Translate control codes                        sss 169  Troubleshooting  ACHIVES yc    uci esp ierit reete Ska cee 128  AppLock Password                        ees 268  Multi Application AppLock                              280  Type II 2 4GHz Radio Card                          63  67  68    U       Uninterruptible Power Supply  UPS                         32  UPS ene HEC PSOE 32   Operati
8.           New  Rename  Delete    Scan    lt i  Security  EAP type      None y    None        WEP keys PSKs   Credentials       Figure 5 12 Default Profile    e Make any desired parameter changes as described in the applicable following section  determined by network security type and click the Commit button to save the  changes     Be sure to click the Commit button after all changes have been made     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    204 Summit Radio    No Security    To connect to a wireless network with no security  make sure the following profile options are  used     e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to None  e Set Encryption to None  e Set Auth Type to Open    Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 13 No Security    Once configured  click the Commit button  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the  Main tab and warmboot  The SCU Main tab shows the device is associated after the radio  connects to the network     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    WEP  To connect using WEP  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to None  e Set Encryption to Manual WEP  e Set Auth Type to Open    Summit Client Utility    Profile   Default y  SBC  Security  EAP type      Manual WEP y   None y     WEP herir    Figure 5 14 WEP Encryption    Click the WEP keys PSKs button     WEP Key Entry    Enter 10 or 26 Hex digits  A F  0
9.         Figure 5 77 Symbol Wireless Network Properties    Disable WEP  e If WEP is to be disabled  tap the down arrow in the Authentication drop down box   Select Open     e Tap the down arrow in the Encryption drop down box  Tap Disabled and WEP is  disabled     e Tap the OK button to return to the Wireless Information tab     Enable WEP  e Tap the down arrow in the Authentication drop down box   e Tap the WEP Authentication protocol     e Ifthe key is provided automatically by your network  check the    Key provided  automatically  checkbox     e Ifyou wish to enter your Authentication key  uncheck the    Key provided  automatically  checkbox and enter the Network Key in the Network Key text box     e Tap the OK button to return to the Wireless Information tab     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    248    Symbol Radio    Continue    Tap the Advanced     button on the Wireless Information Tab  Make sure there is a checkmark in  the    Use Windows to configure my wireless settings    checkbox  Make sure there is no  checkmark in the    Automatically connect to non preferred networks    checkbox     Tap OK to return to the Wireless Information tab     Tap the Connect button        Advanced Wireless Settings  x   Use Windows to configure my wireless settings    r Automatically connect to Networks to   All available y   non preferred networks       access     Ok   Cancel      Figure 5 78 Symbol Advanced Wireless Settings             To access NETWLANI Properties again  double t
10.         Remove Programs Remove user installed programs in their entirety        Scanner Set scanner keyboard wedge  scanner icon appearance  active scanner  port  and scan key settings  Assign baud rate  parity  stop bits and data  bits for available COM ports   See Chapter 4     Scanner            Stylus Set double tap sensitivity properties and or calibrate the touch panel        System Review System and Computer data and revision levels  Adjust Storage  and Program memory settings        Volume and Sounds   Set volume parameters and assign sound wav files to Windows CE  events        Wi Fi Set the parameters for a Summit radio  See Chapter 5     Wireless  Network Configuration    for details on the SCU                 Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   About    Displays hardware and software details        Tab Title Contents    Software GUID  Windows Windows CE version  OAL Version  Bootloader Version   Compile Version  FPGA Version and Language          Hardware CPU Type  Codec Type  FPGA Version  Scanner type  Display  Flash memory   and DRAM memory    Versions LXE Utilities  LXE Drivers  LXE Image  LXE API  and Internet Explorer                   Network IP   Current network connection IP and MAC address        User application version information can be shown in the Version window  Version window  information is taken from the registry     Modify the Registry using the Registry Editor  see section titled    VX6 Utilities      LXE  recommends caution when editin
11.        86  304  External Auto Turn Off                       ssuses 102  313  External Connectors                  ssssseeeeeee 36   AdO epe aae e e E EE i 46   POWEE seits istese ingens  Seena tine EE E S EERE 47   Sa TE E EEA E E EE 37 38   USB iii a 41  External Connectors  Specifications                       287  F  Factory Default Settings   ATA Compact Flash Slot                           117  321   Cisco Cent  A bees 220   Date Time             essere 100 311   Display                 essere 102  313   Input Panel inci iris 103  314   Internet Options                   sese 104  315   Keyboard  odere dU nere 105  315   OTE EE E 114 318   Password coocccococcccnononcnoconnncnnnancnconannnnconnnnoos 115  319   PC Connection   ccccoccccccnoncncnonencninonnnarinnnnnos 116  320   PCMCIA Slots                       esee 117  321   Regional Settings                esses 119   Scanner    entente 119  323   OR ue 121  325   Volume Mixer    110 316  Factory Default  reset to                ssssssssssss 137  Features Gun ae iR REN eats 1  Flash and Reflash     ooonooconnnnccccinoncccnonancnrnnnnnos 135  136  Flash Memory    1  FTP Server  start and stop                            s  83  301  Fuse   Replacement  sisenesime i 73  G    ce 121  325  Getting Started    reete cis 4  H  Hardware   Configuration AA A 30   Ver siii 29  180  223  Hat Encoded Characters                          sess 177  Hat Encoding and RFID                              esses 343  Heater  Touchscreen    o
12.      TX Diversity        Rx Diversity      Added Global Tab parameter     DFS Channels        Appendix A     Key maps Revised NumLock information     Appendix B     Technical Revised    Network Device Specifications      Specifications    Revision H  September 2008    Chapter 1   Introduction Added section    Configuring the VX6 with LXEConnect        Chapter 2     Physical Revised section    Custom Key Maps      Description and Layout    Chapter 3     System Removed sections    Storage Manager        Disabling the Touchscreen      Configuration    Disabling the Touchscreen Heater        Configuring CapsLock Behavior         Configuring IPv6    and    Enabling GrabTime      Revised sections    Control Panel Options   and    LAUNCH EXE        Added section    KeyPad        MX3 VXC Options           Chapter 4     Scanner Revised chapter    Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Revised section    Summit Radio       Configuration   Chapter 6     AppLock Added sections    Match    and    Options Tab      Revised section    Launch Button       Appendix A     Key Maps Removed section    Creating Custom Keymaps     Keymapping is now in the  KeyPad section of Chapter 3     Revised section     Key Map 101 Key Equivalencies           VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Revision History 351    Revision J  September 2008    Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Added sections     Auto Profile    and    Auth Server       Configuration F          8 Revised sections     Main Tab        Radio Mode    a
13.     Suffix      Figure 4 7 Add Prefix Suffix Controls        V  Code ID   Barcode Data             Use this option to specify a string of text  hex values or hat encoded values to be added to the  beginning  prefix  or the end  suffix  of the barcode data  Up to 19 characters can be included in  the string  The string can include any character from the keyboard plus characters specified by hex  equivalent or entering in hat encoding  Please see the    Hat Encoding    section in Appendix B for a  list of characters with their hex and hat encoded values     Using the Escape function allows entering of literal hex and hat values     Add Prefix To enable a prefix  check the Prefix checkbox and enter the desired string in the  textbox  The default is disabled  unchecked  with a blank text string  When  barcode data is processed  the Prefix string is sent to the output buffer before  any other data  Because all stripping operations have already occurred  stripping  settings do not affect the prefix  The prefix is added to the output buffer for the  Symbology selected from the pulldown list  If    All    is selected  the prefix is  added for any symbology that has not been specifically configured     Add Suffix To enable a suffix  check the Suffix checkbox and enter the desired string in the  textbox  The default is disabled  unchecked  with a blank text string  When  barcode data is processed  the Suffix string is sent to the output buffer after the  barcode data  Because all strip
14.     Versions LXE Utilities  LXE Drivers  LXE Image  LXE API  and Internet Explorer          Network IP   Current network connection IP and MAC address                 User application version information can be shown in the Version window  Version window  information is taken from the registry     Modify the Registry using the Registry Editor  see section titled    VX6 Utilities      LXE  recommends caution when editing the Registry and also recommends making a backup copy of  the registry before changes are made     The registry settings for the Version window are under HKEY LOCAL MACHINE   Software V  LXE   Version in the registry     Create a new string value under this key  The string name should be the Application name to  appear in the Version window  The data for the value should be the version number to appear in  the Version window     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 307    Language and Fonts  The Software tab displays any fonts built into the OS image           Software Network IP    GUID 8B075942 C347 EEEF 709D DSB052F6F 724  Windows CE version Windows CE 4 20 patched through Apr 30 2006  OAL version VXC VXCPC422BT XScale PXA255 Jun 8 2006 09 01 06    Bootloader version VXC VXCPC422BT XScale PXA255 Jun 8 2006 09 29 49  Compile version VXCPC422BT compiled Jun 8 2006 09 01 14  FPGA version FPGA v 2 6  Language ANSI 1252  Win Latin 1  OEM 437  US   Enalish only          Figure C 3 About Properties  Software    The fonts built into the OS imag
15.     a barcode is  thru to the converted to  application  text    Ox0A          VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation    Barcode Processing Examples    173    The following table shows examples of stripping and prefix suffix configurations  The examples    assume that the scanner is configured to transmit an AIM identifier                                                  Symbology   All p  di pow a   T 5 Code93  Enable Enabled Enabled Enabled Enabled Disabled  Min length 1 4 1 1  Max length all all all 10  Strip Code ID Enabled Enabled Disabled Enabled  Strip Leading 3 0 3 3  Strip Barcode Data 123     qe    456     Strip Trailing 0 0 3 3  Prefix    aaa       bbb     cec     ddd     Suffix www       XXX       yyy       ZZZ                   Provided that the wedge is configured with the above table  below are examples of scanned  barcode data and results of these manipulations                                                                             Barcode Symbology Raw Scanner Data Resulting Data  EAN 128  C11234567890123 bbb1234567890xxx  EAN 128  C111234567890123 bbb11234567890xxx  EAN 128  C1123  lt  rejected  gt   too short   EAN 13  E01234567890987 ccc E04567890yyy  EAN 13  E01231234567890987 ccc E0234567890yyy  EAN 13  E01234 ccc E0yyy  12 5 1104444567890987654321  lt  rejected  gt   too long   12 5 1104444567890123 ddd7890zzz  12 5 110444 dddzzz  12 5 11022245622 ddd45zzz  Code 93 1G0123456  lt  rejected  gt   disabled   Code 93 1G0444444  lt  rej
16.    Connector Ethernet  COM3   PRINTER PC Connector   9pin male  D      DC out  12V        AC Adapter    AC in  120   240V        p    Uninterruptible    Power  Supply  UPS        DC in  12 80V           DC in  12 80V        Figure 2 1 VX6 Hardware Configuration    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Hardware Configuration 31    Central Processing Unit  The LXE VX6 contains a 400MHz Intel PXA255 CPU     l O Components  The VX6 supports the following I O components   e Two 9 pin RS 232 serial ports configured as     o COMI  o  CONMG  labeled    COM2 3        Note  There is no COM2 port on the VX6   e Two PCMCIA slots  supporting Type I or II PCMCIA cards    e One slot for SD memory card   e Compact flash drive   e Integrated QWERTY keyboard   e Ports available via dongle cable   o USB Host port  o USB Client port  o Ethernet port    e One audio jack providing monaural audio output     System Memory  Main system memory is 128MB DRAM     Note  The 64MB SDRAM option has been discontinued     Video Subsystem    The LXE VX6 video subsystem consists of a color TFT display  The video subsystem complies  with the VESA VL bus standard  The resolution of this display is 800 by 320 pixels  This  resolution complies with the SVGA graphics industry standard     The display supports screen blanking to eliminate driver distraction when the vehicle is in motion   Please see    Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable    later in this chapter and    Screen  Blanking  in Chapter 4     
17.    Figure 5 101 Browsing to Private Key Location    Using the explorer buttons  browse to the location where you copied the private key file  change    the Type pull down list to    Private Keys     select the certificate desired and click OK  Enter the  password for the certificate if appropriate     Click on View to see the certificate details again     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 261    Certificate Details             Figure 5 102 Private Key Present    The private key should now say present  If it does not  there is a problem  Possible items to  check     e Make sure the certificate was generated with a separate private key file  as shown  earlier in this section  If the certificate was not generated with a separate private key  file  generate a new certificate and follow the import process again     e Make sure the certificate and private key file have the same name  for example  vx6user cer for the certificate and vx6user pvk for the private key file  If the file  names are not the same  rename the private key file and import it again     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    262 Certificates    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Chapter 6 AppLock    Introduction    LXE   s AppLock is designed to be run on LXE certified Windows CE based devices only  LXE  loads the AppLock program as part of the LXE customer installation process     Configuration parameters are specified by the AppLock Administrator for the mobile device end   user  AppLock is passwo
18.    If signal strength is less than this trigger value  the radio looks for a different AP with a stronger  signal     Options   50   55   60   65   70   75 dBm   Custom  see Note above     Default   65 dBm    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    194 Summit Radio    Roam Delta    Amount by which the new AP   s signal strength must exceed the current AP   s signal strength  before roaming is attempted     Options  5  10  15  20  25  30  35 dBm   Custom  see Note above     Default  10 dBm  for 802 11b g radio   5 dBm  for 802 11a b g radio   Roam Period    The amount of time  after association or a roam scan with no roam  that the radio collects  Received Signal Strength Indication  RSSI  scan data before a roaming decision is made     Options  5  10  15  20  25  30  35  40  45  50  55  60 sec   Custom  see Note above     Default  10 seconds  for 802 11b g radio   5 seconds  for 802 11a b g radio   BG Channel Set    Defines the 2 4GHz channels to be scanned for an AP when the radio is contemplating roaming   By specifying the channels to search roaming time may be reduced over scanning all channels     Options  Full  all channels   1  6  11  the most commonly used channels   1  7  13  For ETSI and TELEC radios only   Custom  see Note above     Default  Full    DFS Channels   Not currently supported    Support for 5GHz 802 11a channels where support for DFS is required   Options  On  Off  Default  Off    Aggressive Scan    When set to On and the current connection to an AP becomes
19.    Key Maps     for keypress combinations        Esc    oup W CAPS Persa ns Mor POr NO Nor MO y ex Benes    Fi A ro Ars Ara A r5 A Fe Mr  M re ro AiO 7 9        A  amp        ns EELE      CTRL  eaf aul R A vi ul Dol el      r f      2 PgU   00000000005  5 z Home W PgDn W END  lt  DEL Y     gt    0000000009009    Figure 2 23 QWERTY Keyboard Standard       IBM 3270 Overlay    0009099099098090 8600  eeveecoooaoee AAN  ek AAA AAA Eee E   0000000079009    Figure 2 24 QWERTY Keyboard with IBM 3270 Overlay          IBM 5252 Overlay    esc Bono Mes Jp BREAK R S Sr Mor POr NO Mor MO y ox ISNIS    F1    F2 APS 4 A Fs rer  M rs    ro rio 7 9        A  amp        ns EN      CTRL  3608880000608                     Pu     rE aD Pol Dott tid py enter    Home W PgDn W END  lt  DEL Y     gt   0000000000    Figure 2 25 QWERTY Keyboard with IBM 5250 Overlay       Note  Press the  lt CTRL gt     lt Enter gt  keys to initiate the IBM 5250 Field Exit Function     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    The QWERTY Keyboard 53    Key Maps    The keyboard supports all 101 keyboard functions  However  because the keyboard only has 60  keys  all functions are not visible  or printed on the keyboard   Therefore the VX6 keyboard  supports what is called hidden keys    keys that are accessible but not visible on the keyboard     The hidden keys supported by the VX6 are listed in Appendix A     Key Maps        Custom Key Maps    A key or combination of keys can be remapped to provide a single keypress  a strin
20.    The designation of the mobile device to the Avalanche CE Manager is LXE_VXC   See Also     Using Wavelink Avalanche on LXE Windows Computers        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 141    Enabler Configuration  The Enabler user interface application is launched by clicking   either the Avalanche icon on the desktop or Taskbar  Avalanche Icon  or  ES selecting Avalanche from the Programs menu     The opening screen presents the user with the connection status and a  navigation menu     File View Help        Avalanche Enabler 4 02 24  Copyright 2003 2008  Wavelink Corporation     Checking COM1  Connecting to  SERIAL    Agent not found     Connection pending     Checking TCP     Connecting to  SERIAL    Figure 3 39 Avalanche Enabler Opening Screen    Some parameters and features described in this section may not be available if you are not running  the latest version of the Enabler  Please contact your LXE representative for details           File View Help  Connect Updates Adapter Info  Abort Programs About  Settings Icons  Scan Config List  Exit Details   Launchable   All Packages   Time on Taskbar   Device Status                   E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    142    File Menu Options    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration       Connect    The Connect option under the File menu allows the user to initiate a manual  connection to the Mobile Device Server  The connection methods  by default   are wireless and COM connect
21.    There may be an audio or visual signal when a connection   reconnected between a paired  active device is re connected  A visual  signal may be a dialog box placed on the display  Tap the X  button or OK button to close the dialog box    Report failure to Enabled   The time delay is 30 minutes  This value cannot be changed    reconnect             by the user  There may be an audio or visual signal when a  connection between a paired  active device is re connected   A visual signal may be a dialog box placed on the display   Tap the X button or OK button to close the dialog box     Possible reasons for failure to reconnect  Timeout expired  without reconnecting  attempted to pair with a device that is  currently paired with another device  attempted to pair with  a known device that moved out of range or was turned off   attempted to pair with a known device but the reason why  reconnect failed is unknown           E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide                                  98 Control Panel Options   Option Default   Information   Computer is Enabled   Disable this option to inhibit VX6 connection with all   connectable Bluetooth devices    Computer is Disabled   Enable this option to ensure other devices can discover the   discoverable VX6    Prompt if devices Disabled   When enabled  a dialog box is placed on the display  Tap   request to pair the X button  OK button or No button to close the dialog  box    Continuous Search Disabled   When enabled  the VX6 neve
22.    To set the Scanner parameters  please see Chapter 4     Scanner    for details     Storage Manager    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Storage Manager    Installed storage devices are listed by device name in the dropdown box  To view information  about the disk or perform store operations  select a device from the list     On line help is available for this option   Topics available are     e Manage storage devices  e Manage disk partitions  e Creating a new partition    e Advanced partition features    LXE recommends caution when formatting or dismounting storage devices and when creating  new partitions or deleting partitions on the storage device     The internal ATA  System  card does not appear in the Storage Manager menu     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    324 Control Panel Options    Stylus  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Stylus  Set double tap sensitivity properties and or calibrate the touch panel   Double Tap  Follow the instructions on the screen and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take  effect immediately   Calibration       Stylus Properties fa OK x     Double Tap   Calibration      If your Windows CE device is not responding properly to your taps  you       may need to recalibrate your screen     Recalibration involves tapping the center of a target  If you miss the  center  keep the stylus on the screen  slide it over the target s center   and then lift the stylus  To start  tap Recalibrate     Recalibrate    Figu
23.    USB Host Connector       Figure 2 11 Dongle Cable USB Host Port    Pinout  Pin Signal Description  1 5V USB 23 USB Power  Current Limited  2 USB2N A USBD   3 USB2P A USBD   4 DGND USB Power Return  Shell CGND Chassis Ground    USB Client Connector       Figure 2 12 Dongle Cable USB Client Port    Pinout    Pin Signal Description    1 5V USB 23 USB Power  Current Limited    2 USB2N A USBD   3 USB2P A USB D    4 DGND USB Power Return    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors    RJ45 Connector  Pinout  Pin   1  2  3  4  5  6  7  8    E EQ VX6RG J    Signal  TXP       Figure 2 13 Dongle Cable Ethernet Port    Description  Transmit    Transmit      Receive     Not Connected  Not Connected  Receive        Not Connected          Not Connected    45    VX6 Reference Guide    46 External Connectors    Audio Connector  The VX6 audio connector accepts a headset with a 2 5mm plug  such as a mono telephone headset  with microphone or a stereo headset     Please refer to    Mixer    in Chapter 3     System Configuration    for information on configuring the  audio port for either a mono headset with microphone or a stereo headset           1 2 3  Figure 2 14 VX6 Audio Jack for External Speaker or Headphones    Note  The VX6 is not configured for standard PC speakers     Pinout    Pin Description  1 Microphone  2 Speaker  3 Ground    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors 47    Power Supply Connector    Power is supplied to the VX6 through the power conn
24.   192    Diags Tab    Summit Radio    Summit Client Utility        Diagnostics Output                 Figure 5 8 SCU   Diags Tab    The Diags screen can be used for troubleshooting network traffic and radio connectivity issues     V X6 Reference Guide     Re connect     Use this button to apply  or reapply  the current profile and attempt  to associate or authenticate to the wireless LAN  All activity is logged in the  Diagnostic Output box on the lower part of the screen     Release Renew     Obtain a new IP address through release and renew  All activity is  logged in the Diagnostic Output box  Ifa fixed IP address has been assigned to the  radio  this is also noted in the Diagnostic Output box  Note that the current IP  address is displayed above this button     Start Ping     Start a continuous ping to the IP address specified in the text box to the  right of this button  Once the button is clicked  the ping begins and the button label  changes to Stop Ping  Clicking the button ends the ping  The ping also ends when  any other button on this screen is clicked or the user browses away from the Diags  tab  The results of the ping are displayed in the Diagnostic Output box     Diagnostics     Also attempts to  re connect to the wireless LAN  However  this  option provides more data in the Diagnostic Output box than the  Re connect option   This data dump includes radio state  profile settings  global settings  and a list of  broadcast SSID APs     Save To        Use this sav
25.   ActiveSync menu item can be used to establish the connection over the radio link     See Also   Important Information     Cold Boot and Loss of Host Re connection     Start FTP Server   Stop FTP Server    These shortcuts call the Services Manager to start and stop the FTP server  The server defaults to  Off  for security  unless it is explicitly turned on from the menu          The COMG port is labeled    COM2 3        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    84 Start Menu Program Options    Command Prompt    Access  Start   Programs   Command Prompt    x     Pocket CMD v 4 20  y  gt           Figure 3 1 Pocket CMD Prompt Screen    Type help at the command prompt for a list of available commands     Exit the Command Prompt by typing exit at the command prompt or select File   Close     Internet Explorer    Access  Start   Programs   Internet Explorer    This option requires a radio card and an Internet Service Provider  There are a few changes in the  Windows CE version of Internet Explorer as it relates to the general desktop Windows PC  Internet Explorer options  Click the         button to access Internet Explorer Help     Media Player    Access  Start   Programs   Media Player    There are few changes in the Windows CE version of Media Player as it relates to the general  desktop Windows PC Microsoft Media Player options  Click the         button to access Media  Player Help     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Start Menu Program Options 85    Remote Desktop Connection   
26.   After a Custom Identifier is defined  Symbology Settings can be  defined for the identifier just like standard Code IDs              See Also  Barcode Processing Overview earlier in this chapter     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    162    Enable Code ID    Barcode Manipulation    This parameter determines the type of barcode identifier being processed     Note     Since the VX6 does not contain an internal scanner  this feature requires that the  external scanner be manually configured to include the Code ID as part of the incoming  barcode data  Please refer to the scanner documentation to enable the Code ID     Transmission of the Code ID is enabled at the scanner for all barcode symbologies  not for an  individual symbology  Code ID is sent from the scanner so the scanner driver can discriminate                         between symbologies   Options  None The only entry in the Symbology list is All  The barcode data is received but it  is not checked for a Code ID   AIM The Symbology list is loaded with the known AIM ID symbologies for that  platform  plus any configured Custom code IDs   Symbol The Symbology list is loaded with the known Symbol ID symbologies for that  platform  plus any configured Custom Code IDs   Custom Does not change the scanner   s Code ID transmission setting  The Symbology  list is loaded with any configured Custom Code IDs   Notes    VX6 Reference Guide    When Strip  Code ID  see Symbology panel  is not enabled  the code ID is sent as part o
27.   Cbl  US    Scanner  Powerscan  XLR  Low Temp  8    Cbl    Scanner  Powerscan  XLR  Low Temp  12    Cbl    Scanner  LS3408 Fuzzy Logic SR  D9 Interface Cable  8ft    Scanner  LS3408 Extended Range  D9 Interface Cable  8ft    27    8300A326SCNRPWRSR8DA9F  8300A326SCNRPWRSR8DA9F R    8300A327SCNRPWRSR12DA9F   above part is not RoHS compliant     8300A332SCNRS8D9FLT   above part is not RoHS compliant     8300A333SCNRS12D9FLT   above part is not RoHS compliant     8310A326SCNRPWRLR8DA9F  8310A326SCNRPWRLR8DAQ9F R    8310A327SCNRPWRLR12DA9F  8310A327SCNRPWRLR12DA9F R    8310A332SCNRL8D9FLT   above part is not RoHS compliant     8310A333SCNRL12D9FLT   above part is not RoHS compliant     8320A326SCNRPWRXLR8DA9F  8320A326SCNRPWRXLR8DA9F R    8320A327SCNRPWRXLR12DA9F   above part is not RoHS compliant     8320A332SCNRX8D9FLT   above part is not RoHS compliant     8320A333SCNRX12D9FLT   above part is not RoHS compliant     8510A326SCNRFZYDA9F  8510A32685CNRFZYDA9F R    520A3268CNRERDAOF R          VX6 Reference Guide    28    Bluetooth Scanner and Accessories    LXE Bluetooth module with laser ring scanner  battery  two  hand wrist straps  large and small     LXE Bluetooth module with 1D 2D imager ring scanner   battery  two hand wrist straps  large and small     Li Ion Spare Battery for LXE Bluetooth Ring Scanner  Module    LXE 8 bay battery charger with US power cord  LXE single bay charger with US wall plug  PowerScan 7000BT Scanner RS 232 with pointer    PowerScan 7000BT Base Sta
28.   Center Console can be run automatically following each boot        Select Auto Execute App   The drop down box provides a list of applications that have been  installed by the Avalanche Mobility Center Console        Delay before execution Time delay before launching Auto Execute application                 E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    146    Server Contact    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration             ok  x     Startupjshut s       Avalanche Update Settings      Connection   Execution   Server Contact    Sync clock  Contact   On startup     On resume      Periodic Update               On ext  power          at  00 00  Midnight  Wakeup device if suspended  boot before attempt       require external power    Use relative offset    Figure 3 42 Server Contact Options       Sync Clock    Reset the time on the mobile computer based on the time on  the Mobile Device Server        Contact    On Startup     Connect to the Mobile Device Server when the  Enabler is accessed        On Resume     Connect to the Mobile Device Server when  resuming from Suspend mode        On Ext  Power     Initiate connection to the Mobile Device  Server when the device is connected to an external power  source  such as based on a docking event        Allows the administrator to configure the Enabler to contact  the Mobile Device Server and query for updates at a regular  interval beginning at a specific time        Wakeup device if suspended    If the time interval for periodic contact
29.   Eu settings may result in an inability to connect with your desktop  computer     Allow connection with desktop computer when device is attached    Connect using     USB Client       Figure 3 28 Communication   PC Connection Tab          Please refer to the    Backup VX6 Files    section later in this chapter for parameter setting  recommendations     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 117    PCMCIA    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PCMCIA    Enable or disable the PCMCIA slots  Information on the card currently in the PCMCIA slots and  the Compact Flash slot is provided        Factory Default Settings  Disable slot now Unchecked                   The Slot 0 and Slot 1 Tabs contain the same parameters  If a card is present in the slot  a  description of the card is displayed  To disable a slot  check the Disable slot now checkbox and  tap OK  The change takes effect immediately  Slot 0 is the lower slot  labeled    PCMCIA B     Slot  1 is the upper slot  labeled    PCMCIA A        PCMCIA Control    sito   soti   se      Card  Cisco Systems 350 Series Wireless LAM Adapter 512A       Disable slot now  E Write protect slot     Power slot during sleep  3 3        Figure 3 29 PCMCIA Control Tab  Slot 0 and Slot 1    The Slot 2 Tab provides information on the internal Compact Flash ATA drive  There are no user  configurable options     PCMCIA Control         soto   se    soez      Card   Internal ATA  61 MB        Figure 3 30 Compact Flash ATA Co
30.   IBM 3270 keyboard                          sess 286  IBM 5270 keyboard                          ess 286  Keyboard  O 105 315  Backlight    ooooconncnnnnicnincnnccnocnconnconccnnconnccnncnnnonnos 53  Connector  Locati0M      ooooocnnnccccnnonnccononancnnonnnnronns 7  Control Keys  eiecit tiere itp etes 56  Data entry scsi  ata 9  Hidden Key Functions                         sees 53  LED Indicators    54  Onscreen only              ssssseeeeee 103 314  VX6 Reference Guide    356       Shortcuts a 57  KEYCOMP compiler                     eeeeeeenee 340  L  LAUNCH EXEoooooccconcnoonnccnnnnnonncconocooncccnnncononcconoos 131  LEAP   A erre 221   Summit Radio                   sse 206  LED indicators    54  LEDs   2d oae r 55   Caps Lock  CAPS    cessere 54   Secondary Keys    esent eerte 55  List configured ActiveSync connections         116  320  Location   Antenna Connector coooooooccnnccnnononnnononcnnonnnnanonnncnons 36   COMI and COM 3 rninn na 36   A EE eens es 36   Power DC Connector oocoocccnnnonnnonononnnononnnonnnnnnnnnnno 36   Power Switch               essere 36   Printer Port    36   RS232 POTS aicce rsss trente ete nentes 36   Scanner Port    eni tnt mnes 36   Serial Ports    36   USB Connector cooccconoconinonoconononnnonnonnnnccnnncnnononnnoos 36  Logging   ADpLOCE A A 279  Loss of Host Re connection                     sees 127  M  MAC Address                 eee 90  308  Ma a E 119  323  MA neee ei i 25  Match list               essen 166   n MP M ED 167  Match
31.   MAC   00 40 FD 00 00 00 MAC    00 0F 34 00 00 00  IP   0 0 0 0 IP    100  100  100  100  GW    GW             Figure 3 5 About Properties  Network IP    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 91    Accessibility    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Accessibility    Customize the way the keyboard  sound  display  mouse  automatic reset and notification sound  function  There is no change from general desktop Accessibility options  Adjust the settings and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately        Accessibility       Keyboard   sound   Display   Mouse   General    Use StickyKevs if you want to use Shift  Ctrl   or Alt key by pressing one key at a time         Use StickyKeys    Use TogoleKeys if you want to hear tones when  pressing CapsLock  NumLock  and ScrollLock       Use ToggleKeys          Figure 3 6 Accessibility Properties  Keyboard    Note  The StickyKeys option SHOULD NOT be used on the VX6  It does not work for the  integrated VX6 keyboard     If the ToggleKeys option is selected  please note that Scroll Lock key does not produce a sound as  the CapsLock and NumLock keys do  This is due to a limitation in the Microsoft Windows CE  operating system     Accessibility  id OK E    Keyboard   Sound Display   Mouse   General          Use SoundSentry if you want Windows to generate  visual warnings when your system makes a sound         Use SoundSentry          Figure 3 7 Accessibility Properties  Sound  If
32.   PCMCIA Radio        Custom Key Maps        Input Panel  Virtual Keyboard          Video Subsystem    and    The Display         Added new section     Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable        Chapter 3     Power Supply Revised    VX6 Input Power Specifications        Chapter 4     System Revised    Installed Software        Start Menu Program Options        Network  Configuration and Dialup Connections        Control Panel Options        About        Date Time         Keyboard        Password        Regional Settings        Remote Desktop  Connection        Scanner        Storage Manager        LAUNCH EXE    and     Reflash the VX6    sections   Added new sections     Folders Copies at Startup    and    Enabling  GrabTime        Removed section     Bluetooth Manager        Renamed    VX6 Command Line Utility    to    VX6 Command Line Utilities     and updated section     Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Revised    Profiles Tab    section     Configuration Split radio configuration section into two sections    Cisco Radio    and     Symbol radio     Added a new section     Summit Radio     Each section  contains the manufacturer specific configuration information     Moved all certificate generating and installation instructions to a new     Certificates    section     Chapter 6     AppLock New chapter  Information previously included in Appendix B is now  referred to as    Single Application      Added Multi Application AppLock to chapter     Appendix A     
33.   Selected hotkey is not allowed  Please reenter   When RFTerm is not installed on the mobile device  the RFTerm keys are not restricted from use     See Also  Appendix D     Reference Material  sections titled AppLock Error Messages and  AppLock Registry Settings     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Appendix A Key Maps    The VX6 Keypad       Esc Bono W CAPS fenex ns Soyavy Ory Ov Mor MO y skr Benes    F1 A Fo A Fa 4 A Fs rer  AS ro rio 7 9               INS WELE      CTRL  a Pk e A vI ul oL A            i i i   PgUp  gt   3686668086668  s Home M PgDn END    DEL        60600000000    Figure A 1 VX6 QWERTY Keyboard       The key map table that follows lists the commands used when running LXE   s VX6     Key Map 101 Key Equivalencies    When using a sequence of keys that includes the 2    key  press the 2  key first then the rest of the  key sequence     Note  The VX6 keyboard does not have a NumLock indicator  NumLock isalways On     When the VX6 boots  the default condition of Caps  or CapsLock  is Off  The Caps  or  CapsLock  condition can be set toggled with a  lt 2nd gt   lt FI gt  key sequence  The CAPS  LED on the keyboard is illuminated when CapsLock is On  The warmboot behavior of  CapsLock can be set via the MX3 VXC Options tab in the Windows CE Control Panel   Please see Chapter 3 for more details                Press These Keys and Then    27  swe   om  an   patos   EE                 To get this key Press this key       Increase Brightness    Decrease Brightnes
34.   VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Introduction    Chapter 3 System Configuration    There are several different aspects to the setup and configuration of the VX6  Many of the setup  and configuration settings are dependent upon the optional features such as hardware and software  installed on the unit  The examples found in this chapter are to be used as examples only  the  configuration of your specific VX6 computer may vary  The following sections provide a general  reference for the configuration of the VX6 and some of its optional features     Your VX6 operating system may be Windows CE  NET 4 2 or Windows CE 5 0  The VX6  operating system is displayed on the Desktop as Windows CE  NET or Windows CE  This is the  factory default value for the Desktop Display Background     This chapter presents information and procedures for Windows CE 5 0 only  Windows CE  NET  4 2 information and procedures are contained in Appendix C     VX6 CE  NET 4 2        Windows CE Operating System    LA For general use instruction  please refer to commercially available Windows CE  user s guides or the Windows CE on line Help application installed with the VX6     This chapter   s contents assume the system administrator is familiar with Microsoft Windows  options and capabilities loaded on most standard Windows computers     Therefore  the sections that follow describe only those Windows capabilities that are unique to the  VX6 and its Windows CE environment     Wireless Network Configurati
35.   X Xx X X X  C   C   O     Oo    O x   Oo O a    C       C                      S c                   to cx Si So  a             ey cc o6    x 6                                        ao    Co c       Figure D 1 Decimal   Hexadecimal Chart  0 to 159 Decimal     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    346 Decimal   Hexadecimal Chart    0 JM   0 FB WN RO          vo                                        Figure D 2 Decimal   Hexadecimal Chart  160 to 255 Decimal     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Revision History 347    Revision History    Revision A  Initial Release  November 2004    Revision B  August 2005    Chapter 1     Introduction Revised    Document Conventions        When To Use This Guide     E   gt      Touchscreen and Mouse    and    Accessories    sections     Specified the proper USB adapter cable to use in    Connect    section     Chapter 2     Physical Added    Identifying Your VX6        USB Keyboard Mouse    and  Description and Layout    Touchscreen Heater    sections   Updated    The Keyboards        CAPS LED        On Off Switch        General  Windows CE  NET Keyboard Shortcuts    and    Ethernet USB Dongle  Cable    sections   Replaced    CapsLock  Scroll Lock and the VX6    section with    CapsLock  and the VX6    and    Scroll Lock and the VX6    sections     Replaced    Antenna Connector    section with    Antenna Connections       section     Chapter 4     System Revised    About        administrator Control        LAUNCH EXE        Reflash the  Co
36.   a latency to allow the thread loading the driver to finish installation   The  default value of 0 means the slot is not powered on  The default values for the default wireless  client drivers  listed below  is 1  meaning one second elapses between the CAB file loading and  the slot powering up     Note that the auto launch process can also launch batch files    BAT   executable files    EXE    registry setting files     REG   or sound files     WAV   The mechanism is the same as listed  above  but the appropriate CE application is called  depending on file type     Registry information is already in the default image for the following     5         autoexec batch file   for users convenience   HKEY LOCAL _MACHINE SOFTWARE LXE Persist AUTOEXEC    FileName     System  Autoexec bat    Installed  dword 0   FileCheck   ALWAYSEXEC    Order  dword 50     The file name  ALWAYSEXEC  or    dummy    does not really matter as long as there is     no file of that name in the directory  You can use any name that you want for this entry     as long as it is a non existent file name  The purpose of this value is that if someone    wants to only execute this file one time then you would replace the value of FileCheck    with the name of a file that would exist the next time a warm boot occurs   3           RFTerm support   HKEY LOCAL _MACHINE SOFTWARE LXE  Persist LXE TE    FileName     System  RFTERM CAB    Installed  dword 0   FileCheck     WINDOWS  LXE  RFTERM EXE    Order  dword 11    r
37.   as  CAB files in the System directory are loaded by Launch     A cold boot is initiated by running the Coldboot application in the Windows directory  This  application automatically cold boots the VX6  erasing any customer applied registry changes and  returning the VX6 to its factory settings     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    294 Installed Software    Installed Software    When you order a VX6 you receive the software files required by the separate programs needed  for operation and radio communication  The files are loaded by LXE and stored in subdirectories  in the VX6     This section lists the contents of the subdirectories and the general function of the files  Files  installed in each VX6 are specific to the intended function of the VX6     Files installed in each VX6 configured for an RF environment contain PCMCIA card radio  specific drivers     the drivers for each type of radio are specific to the manufacturer  e g  Summit   Cisco  Symbol  for the radios installed in the RF environment and are not interchangeable     Software Load    The software loaded on the mobile computer consists of Windows CE  NET 4 2 hardware specific  OEM Adaptation Layer  device drivers  Internet Explorer 6 0 for Windows CE browser and  utilities  The software supported is summarized below     Operating System    e Full Operating System License  Includes all operating system components  including  Windows CE  NET 4 2 kernel  file system  communications  connectivity  for remote  AP
38.   ms  m        Left Port Right Port    Figure 2 36 Cisco Antenna Cable Connections    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    66 PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots    Symbol 11Mb Radio Card    Hold the radio card with the Symbol logo label facing up  Connect the antenna cable s  as  follows     e Single antenna     Connect antenna cable to Port A  left port   as shown below     e Dual antennas     Connect antenna cables to both ports        Port A Port B    Figure 2 37 Symbol 11Mb Antenna Cable Connections    4    Now complete the insertion of the Type II PCMCIA Radio into the slot     Note  When this process is complete  reattach the access cover screws using a torque  wrench capable of measuring to 9 1 inch pounds  1 016411 N m   The screws  must be fastened to 9 inch pounds each  The screws require a Phillips size 1  driver head     5   Re connect the power cord cable and turn the VX6 on   6  For VX6   s with a Summit radio  review RX Diversity and TX Diversity on the Global    Settings tab of the Summit Client Utility to ensure these settings correspond to the VX6   s  antenna configuration     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots 67    CF Card Slot  This slot contains the Compact Flash  CF  hard drive     The operating system and settings are stored on the CF card  The VX6 cannot       operate without this card  Cards in this slot CANNOT be hot swapped     Replace a CF Card  1  Turn the VX6 off and detach the power cable   2  Loosen the three  3  Phillips head sc
39.  5 25 WPA LEAP Credentials          Enter the Domain Username  if the Doman is required   otherwise enter the Username     Enter the password     Click OK then click Commit  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the Main tab and    warmboot  The SCU Main tab shows the device is associated after the radio connects to the  network     VX6 Reference Guide    214 Summit Radio    EAP FAST  To use EAP FAST  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to EAP FAST  e Set Encryption to WPA TKIP  e Set Auth Type to Open    The SCU supports EAP FAST with automatic or manual PAC provisioning  With automatic PAC  provisioning  the user credentials  whether entered on the saved credentials screen or the sign on  screen  are sent to the RADIUS server  The RADIUS server must have auto provisioning enabled  to send the PAC provisioning credentials to the client device  Please refer to the    LXE Security  Primer    for more information on the RADIUS server configuration                   Summit Client     Main   Profile    cars   E ES     wea TKIP y   EAP FAST    WEP keys PSKs   Credentials             Figure 5 26 EAP FAST Configuration    For automatic PAC provisioning  once a username password is authenticated  the PAC  information is stored on the computer  The same username password must be used to authenticate  each time  See the note on the next page for more details     For manual PAC provis
40.  8800A051POWERCORD  8800A301ACPS  8800A302DCPS  8800A052DCPWRCABLE  8500A051CBL9DA9F  8800A005STAND  8800A376BATTERY  8800A377CHGRADPTRCUP  8800A378CHGRISLOT  8800A379CHGRBASE  8200A501HOLSRBELT  8000A501INDREEL  8500A505STANDSMT  9000A411 SCNRSTRAP    E EQ VX6RG J    Chapter 2 Physical Description and Layout    Identifying Your VX6    Some features discussed in this document may not be available for all VX6   s  Additionally  some  features require a certain revision level of system software     Any feature that is not identified as platform specific or requiring a certain level of system  software is available to all VX6   s     Hardware Platforms    To determine the platform level of your VX6  please refer to the VX6 serial  number decal     Platform 1 VX6    V X6 s identified as Platform 1 by a P1 notation on the serial number decal  and VX6 s with no  platform identification on the serial number decal  are referred to as Platform 1 VX6   s  These  VX6   s DO NOT support the features identified as    Platform 2    throughout this manual     Note  If software revision IED or greater is installed     LXE VX6 Platform 1    is displayed  during boot up  See    Software Revisions     below  to determine the software revision  installed on the VX6  If no software revision is displayed during bootup  the VX6 is a  Platform 1 type as all Platform 2 VX6 s ship with software revision IED or greater     Platform 2 VX6  VX6 s identified as Platform 2 by a P2 notation on the serial nu
41.  9   OR enter 5 or 13 ASCII characters     Tx Key    e  o123456789abcdef0 123456789    O2  o123456789  O3    O4     O         Figure 5 15 WEP Keys       205       Valid keys are 10  for 40 bit encryption  or 26  for 128 bit encryption  hexadecimal characters     Enter the key s  and click OK     Once configured  click the Commit button  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the  Main tab and warmboot  The SCU Main tab shows the device is associated after the radio    connects to the network     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    206 Summit Radio    LEAP without WPA Authentication  To use LEAP  without WPA  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to LEAP  e Set Encryption to Auto WEP  e Set Auth Type as follows     o Ifthe Cisco CCX certified AP is configured for open authentication  set the  Auth Type radio parameter to Open     o Ifthe AP is configured for network EAP only  set the Auth Type radio  parameter to LEAP     Please see    WPA LEAP    later in this section to configure the radio for WPA LEAP     Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 16 LEAP Configuration    Please review    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials     earlier in this chapter     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    E EQ VX6RG J    207    To use Stored Credentials  click on the Credentials button  No entries are necessary for Sign On    Credentials as the user will be prompted for the User
42.  A IIA 16  A                                          17  O A MEUS REDE 17  Settings Tab  Bluetoothi Oe rinitis 18  R  pott Wen connecuon I08U sce sonatas E CSAS 18  Report when recomendais 18  Report Fane AO TOCDDHCL es a T ETUR A E A S Iud rA SPUR 18    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    ii Table of Contents    Computer is comnectable aer A 18  Computer 1s disco dori  18  Prompt 1f devices Tequest to Pair iii lalala 18  Continuous Sarli pila 19  e A                          X      9                                                19  Bluetooth DNS iii tM CRM i LE GS DUE 20  Bl  sicoth Barcode Reader Son ii 21  NT 21  WO a aed asset feces pd ia ai 21   M XO without Ladino 22  Bluetooth Beep and LED Indications  zo pee Etre er roe ER eti eet ueste beso bb ue eei paese by eet ed 23  Saving Changes to the Registry iie nnb kx RRER B Vn RREEIFEN ERU RAE KE KON GERA KRRN EAR REA d ES 24  Gening PI ci EE DUET ERMA A US QU MICUAM AUR A AVIA VET QUAM ERR AQ AA M RR 25  Manuals and ACCESSOrIOS     25  Mantal A A A       A    U                                25  NEE A A E 25  CHAPTER 2 PHYSICAL DESCRIPTION AND LAYOUT 29  ea Your FG MMM r n E A r E r EEE r A r r aE r a r i 29  Hardware Platforms A iaa nA a EET E EANA Mei e 29  Software Revisions oie 29  Hardware ConBguraliohi ssicsesisisspicscdcannsanssisacinidbensinaaupansiienpiieionsiaianadusadseadduniinadnaddin 30  System gerit E e E EEN RI Re 30  Central A S 31  ICAA iii lidia 31  System Memory AAA A         31  A nati  31  Power or
43.  Background                                           Factory Default Settings   Background Windowsce   Tile Disable  Appearance   Scheme  Windows Standard  Backlight   Battery Auto Turn Off Enabled   Idle Time 30 seconds  External Auto Turn Off   Enabled   Idle Time 2 minutes       There is no change from general desktop PC Display Properties   Background options  Adjust the  settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     Appearance    No change from general desktop PC Display Properties   Appearance options  Adjust the settings  and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately  The default is  Windows Standard     Backlight       Display Properties      ok x           Background   Appearance Backlight          To save battery life  you can adjust when the backlight  automatically shuts off         Automatically turn off backlight while on battery power    Turn off after fac seconds  gt   of continuous idle time         Automatically turn off backlight while on external power    Turn off     E minutes  gt   of continuous idle time     Figure 3 17 Display Properties   Backlight Tab       Adjust the settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect  immediately  When the backlight timer expires  the display  display backlight and keyboard  backlight are all turned off     Note     VX6 Reference Guide    The display can also be configured to turn off when the vehicle to which the V
44.  Battery Pack Output Conectar   cacumen ate ttt De TO EHI EH 48  The UPS Battery Extension Cable Input Connector   ecce rit eerie ice bern endete ipee tonto GES 49  Th   UPS Battery Extension Cable Output Comicos 49  Extemal Antentiys uis p nino EO ied HS ais 50  RF Antenna SS CODDGGIOE  inier erii ep ae idee PEE Fa vce causes E ER ete he FPE tab csbacisecoscedesaetanseiases 50  ternal Antenna Cables uns uniera 51  OWERTY Keyboard Standard  anoo e arreter E REED an 52   QWERTY Keyboard with IBM 3270 Overlay nissan ie ae 52  QWERTY Keyboard with IBM 5250 Overlay      5 2  e ttr re I ies 52  Keyboard LEDS  iris 54  The CapsLock Keyes nao n toe t ei stb aya e red EHE E e RECTE CR 54  The Secondary Rovira ondaa Basa CS 55  The VMT Rey board Display Cohttol di con iciteu et i iuri ore PEN wick enced ssbane tsi tonos euet 56  Small and Large Virtual Keyboards  iii 58  InputBanel PrOpetlioS ci oii Hv ee Reit Een ioo hes hes EAA E ee xp ARP ar ERE ARP EAE 59  The PONICDA dnd TAS tS a tea beds 61  Insertmp the Typs II PCMCIA RAadlO  nttieziectis se titio ertt pre ram erra aed 63  Summit 802 11    b s Antenna Cable COnfiectlolis           oo eoeceote repens peo nce Pte Ep tapete a EEO 64  Summit 302 11b g Antenna Cable Connections css ei netter t HT TA eden 65  Cisco Antenna Cable Connections cie abe rere PRETEREA obe bible 65  Symbol 11Mb Antenna Cable Connections    uiu tte eripe er eds 66    Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents XV    Figure 2 38  Figure 2 39  Figure 2 40  Figure 
45.  Bin     At the bottom of the screen is the Start button  Clicking the Start Button causes the Start Menu to  pop up  It contains the standard Windows menu options  Programs  Favorites  Documents   Settings  Help  and Run     Desktop Icon Function             My Computer Access files and programs    Recycle Bin Storage for files that are to be deleted    Internet Explorer Connect to the Internet intranet  requires radio card and  Internet Service Provider     ISP enrollment is not available  from LXE     Wireless Configuration Icon Used for accessing the appropriate wireless configuration    utility  either the SCU  Summit Client Utility  or ACU   Cisco Aironet Client Utility               Bluetooth Discover and then pair with nearby discoverable Bluetooth  devices    My Documents Storage for downloaded files   applications    Start Access programs  select from the Favorites listing     documents last worked on  change view settings for the  control panel or taskbar  on line help or run programs                 E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    298 Desktop    Folders Copies at Startup  The following folders are copied on startup     System Desktop   gt  Windows Desktop  System Favorites   gt  Windows Favorites  System Fonts   gt  Windows Fonts  System Help   gt  Windows Help  System Programs   gt  Windows Programs    This function copies only the directory contents  no sub folders   The following folders are NOT copied on startup     Windows AppMer  Windows Recent  Windows 
46.  CA certificates are required for PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC  and EAP TLS  Two options  are offered for storing these certificates  They may be imported into the Windows certificate store  or copied into the Certs Path directory     How To  Use the Certs Path    1  Follow the instructions later in this chapter for    Downloading a Root CA Certificate to a PC        2  Copy the certificate to specified directory on the mobile device  The default location for  Certs Path is  System  A different location may be specified by using the Certs Path global  variable  Please note the location chosen for certificate storage should persist after warmboot     3  When completing the Credentials screen for the desired authentication  do not check the Use  MS store checkbox after checking the Validate server checkbox     4  Enter the certificate name in the CA Cert textbox     5  Click OK to exit the Credentials screen and then Commit to save the profile changes     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    202    Summit Radio    How To  Use Windows Certificate Store    de  Ze    Follow the instructions later in this chapter for    Downloading a Root CA Certificate to a PC        To import the certificate into the Windows store  follow the instructions for    Installing a Root  CA Certificate on the Mobile Device    later in this chapter     When completing the Credentials screen for the desired authentication  be sure to check the  Use MS store checkbox after checking the Validate server checkbox    
47.  Connector  COM3     The serial connector  labeled    COM2 3     is an industry standard RS 232 9 pin    D    connector   The connector and its pin assignments are shown below  By default  Pin 9 provides RI  Pin 9  may also be configured to supply  5 VDC at 0 4A  max  for an external bar code scanner  Refer  to Chapter 4     Scanner     section titled    Serial Port Pin 9    for more information on configuring Pin  9        Figure 2 4 Printer PC Serial Connector  COM3     Note    Power the VX6 off before attaching a cable or device to the COM3 serial port     Pinout  Pin Signal Description  1 DCD Data Carrier Detect     Input  2 RXD Receive Data     Input  3 TXD Transmit Data     Output  4 DTR Data Terminal Ready     Output  5 GND Signal Power Ground  6 DSR Data Set Ready     Input  7 RTS Request to Send     Output  8 CTS Clear to Send     Input  9 RI Ring Indicator     Input  default   or or   5VDC Bar Code Scanner Power     400mA max  Shell CGND Chassis Ground    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors 39    Technical Specifications     Connection Cable    The exact serial cable is crucial  Many commercial null modem cables will not work  LXE  recommends the following cable                                   Serial cable   9000A054CBL6D9D9  5 1  9 6  Pinout   DB9 female DB9 female  1 7  2 3  3 2  4 6  8  5 5  6  8 4  7 1  9 no connection                Figure 2 5 Pinout     Serial Cable    Some laptop devices do not properly implement all control lines on the
48.  D15 to USB H  USB C and Ethernet Adapter  Cable  Printer PC  D9 to D25    Cable  PC  D9 to D9  Power Cables    Cable  Input Power  12 FT  VX5 VX6 VX7  Adapter Cable  VX1 VX2 VX4 Power Cable to VX5 VX6 VX7    E EQ VX6RG J    9000A021UBRACKET R  9000A022BRKTADPTKIT R  9000A023BRKTRAMMOUNT R  9000A028RAMPLATEBALL R  9000A031BRKTRAMSQZMT R  9000A033BACKUPPLATE    9000A071CBLDISUSBETH  9000A075CBLUSBHCETH    9000A053CBL6D9D25   above part is not RoHS compliant     9000A054CBL6D9D9    9000A073CBLPWRI2FT R  9000A077CBLPWRADPTR    VX6 Reference Guide    26    Power Supplies   Power Supply  External  AC  W US Power Cord VX5 VX6 VX7  Power Supply  External  AC  No Power Cord VX5 VX6 VX7  UPS Battery and Cables   Battery  UPS Lead Acid  VX5 VX6 VX7   Cable  UPS Battery  Remote Mount Extender  6 Ft  Antenna and Antenna Mount Kits   Replacement antenna  2 4GHz   Remote Mount Antenna Kit  8 Ft Cable  b g   Remote Mount Antenna Kit  8 Ft Cable  a b g   Remote Mount Antenna Kit  6 Ft Cable  b g   Remote Mount Antenna Kit  6 Ft Cable  a b g   Right Angle Remote Mount Antenna Kit  6 Ft Cable  b g  Right Angle Remote Mount Antenna Kit  6 Ft Cable  a b g  Right Angle Remote Mount Antenna Kit  15 Ft Cable  b g  Right Angle Remote Mount Antenna Kit  15 Ft Cable  a b g  Miscellaneous   Stylus  with Tethers and Sleeves  5 Pack   Protective Film  Touchscreen  10 Pack  VX6   Voice Recognition Accessories    Headset coiled adapter cable  with quick disconnect connector to a  2 5 mm audio jack  A heads
49.  EEEE A EE A S A A E E A EE A ae een 303  Windows A RS 303  I E M E EE E ERE AE SEA eer ne A E        Y 304  Advanced TAD rd A E E e  304  Control Panel OPS miii did iii 305  AI aa 306  Languase amd FONTS e A A ERN UN cU SUM RETI LRQ 307  Identifying q o MA e cde NER Desa ded nbl bs dd Inm usa een s 308  Radio MAC Oni Tr                 308  eec O a h 309  Administrator A a T 310  A A A pana dae aiaeeen ana M RPM MM IE 310  A A eee ca 310  Datel VIG pad M  311  A c                                       I       8 312   l o m                                                  S 313  A O r raia 313  A E O On dic ndi o rer 313  A a eee eee MM REED E MM E ME EE 313  laput Panel EM EDEN 314  Te rH EOD BIB oo eost ene k a a en ee a 315  DS ono o MTTC                         S     315   j o P                                             316  DURO                       COUPER EN 317  Network and Dialup Commie ti 08 sc avecessacincraicasensntiastaaictmatisiassabenedenncmatiniacsrenieaeins 317  d 0l e c                                  Y        318  A UR A AA ene  Ue Aner emer ee Nee ene rer  eRe 319  PC Conn o M     320  PONE aci 321  POWER iia 322  RETO SO DOS ii 323  Remove PEO A es 323  ACI NR RR                     323  Storage Mana MT P PI   X                               323  A A OMe ee Ce EE ners 324  A Eo eee ditor dido eniti M mpm utu rr alite d EUM 324  A HT                          324  A E E E 325  ai AN E 325  A A NO RA 326    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Con
50.  Extended  e All  Save As    When the  Save As     button is selected  a standard  Save As  dialog screen is displayed  Specify  the path and filename  If the filename exists  the user is prompted whether the file should be  overwritten  If the file does not exist  it is created     See Also  Error Messages    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    280 Troubleshooting AppLock    Troubleshooting AppLock    The mobile device won t switch from Administration mode to end user mode     e Ifthe configuration is valid for one application but not the other  the switch to end   user mode fails  AppLock stays in Administration mode and is stopped until the  Administrator password is entered     e If two copies of the same application are configured  but the application only allows  one copy to run at a time  for example Microsoft Pocket Word and LXE RFTerm   the switch to end user fails  AppLock stays in Administration mode and is stopped  until the Administrator password is entered     The hotkey sequence needed is not allowed  What does this mean     When the Administrator is selecting a hotkey sequence to use when switching user modes  they  are not allowed to enter key combinations that are reserved by installed software applications   LXE has validated RFTerm key combinations ONLY     When RFTerm is installed on the mobile device and an RFTerm restricted key sequence is  specified as a hotkey sequence by the Administrator  the following error message is displayed in a  message box   
51.  List rules                   essen 167  Media Pl  yet      c is 84  302  hun  31  121  325   allocate for programs or storage                 122  326   installed    ooooonnnncnnnonnnonononconncononancnnncnnocnnoon 121  325  Menu Options   NI MED 81  299  Modes   AppLock irem e 267  Mouse  USB        ccccccccccecsessaeteceeeesesseeeeeesceesenssaeeeeees 11  Multi Application AppLock                                    264  My Computer   Folders iii ia 80  298  O  On Off  VX6 Reference Guide    Index   condition of CapsLock                           sess 281   SWICh oe cnet dris 35  287  Operating Temperature  Specifications                   288  Optional Power Supply                       eese 69  Owner   Identification sa 114 318   hc                     114  318  P  P  rity  aaa 119  157  323  PassWOt  ree rt rct dete eese 115 319   AppLock  inire tied 268   AppLock Save As               sssssseee 279   lost at cold boot                    sse 133  PC Card Slots  Location                   eeene 6 8  PC Cards   Plug and Plains 32  PCMCIA Cards   Plug and Play x eoe np daten 32   Types  Specifications    287  PCMCIA Slots                      eese 61   Disable Enable                             sseees 117  321  PEAP GTC   Cisco Radio    232   Summit Radio    oooocoonccccnonoccnononcncnonancnrnnnnos 210  216  PEAP MSCHAP   Cisco R  dio   ueri a RR Reds 229   Summit Radio                 ssssssssseeeeee 208  SA uetus DD Es 10  60  Permanent storage of drivers and utilities    
52.  Network Properties  Network name  SSID    peapTest       This is a computer to computer  ad hoc     Wireless network key  WEP   This network requires a key for     Encryption   TKIP     Authentication   we A  y      network  wireless access points are not used    Network key    Key index  fr Key provided automatically    IEEE 802 1X Authentication  Enable 802 1X authentication on this network    EAP type   PEAP y     Figure 5 44 PEAP MSCHAP Wireless Network Properties       With the radio parameters configured  see    Wireless Network Configuration     earlier in this  chapter  set the EAP type to PEAP as shown above     If the EAP type box text is not exactly as shown see    Installing Radio Drivers     earlier in this  chapter  to change the radio cab file     Click the Properties button     Authentication Settings    User Certificate  Issued to    Issued by          Validate Server       Figure 5 45 Authentication Settings  When first configuring and authenticating  do not validate the server certificate  This allows the    user authentication to be tested  When that works  come back to this screen and validate the  server certificate     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    230 Cisco Radio    The login screen appears for logging into the wireless network     Enter Network Password                   Figure 5 46 Wireless Network Login    Once authenticated  click the IP Information tab     CISCO1       Figure 5 47 IP Information Tab    If the network is set to use DHCP  the
53.  R  ww  Certificates    Select    My Certificates    from the pull down list     Certificates             Figure 5 96 Certificates    Click the    Import    button     Import Certificate or Key       Figure 5 97 Import Certificate    Make sure    From a File    is selected and click OK     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 259    Select a Certificate File EE  z     QJ  My Documents     Shortcut to Office Templates Ink   a  vx6user cer    Name    Type   Certificates      Figure 5 98 Browsing to Certificate Location       Using the explorer buttons  browse to the location where you copied the certificate  select the  certificate desired and click OK     The certificate is now shown in the list     Certificates    Lists your personal digital  certificates       Figure 5 99 Certificate Listing    With the certificate you just imported highlighted  click View     From the Field pull down menu  select    Private Key     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    260 Certificates         Certificate Details    Friendly Mame      Field          Not Present       Figure 5 100 Private Key Not Present    e Ifthe private key is present  the process is complete   e Ifthe private key is not present  import the private key     To import the private key  click OK to return to the Certificates screen   Click import        Select a Certificate File    Ef  mu  _    ex   OJ  My Documents     Shortcut to Office Templates Ink  laa  vx6user pvk           Name    Type   Private Keys         
54.  The default is to use all certificates in the store  If this is OK  skip to Step  8     Otherwise  to select a specific certificate click on the Browse       button        Choose certificate E    Use full trusted store        Issued By    Thawte Server CA  Thawte Premium Server CA  Secure Server Certification Authority    GTE CyberTrust Root  GTE CyberTrust Global Root of    Figure 5 11 Choose Certificate                      Uncheck the Use full trusted store checkbox     Select the desired certificate and click the Select button to return the selected certificate to the  CA Cert textbox     Click OK to exit the Credentials screen and then Commit to save the profile changes     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 203    Summit Wireless Security    Use the instructions in this section to complete the entries on the Profile tab according to the type  of wireless security used by the network  The instructions that follow are the minimum required  to successfully connect to a network  Your system may require more parameters than are listed in  these instructions  Please see your system administrator for complete information about your  network and its wireless security requirements     To begin the configuration process   e On the Main tab  click the Admin Login button and enter the password     e LXE recommends editing the default profile with the parameters for your network   Select the Default profile from the pull down menu     Summit Client Utility    profe   
55.  Tools Help   ay   Que      x wi   J search    Folders E    Address O  System LXEConnect    kd so  mm   19 LXEConnect msi SETUP EXE   E  System      My Documents      My Network Places       2 object  s  TB Mobile Device       Figure 1 8 LXEConnect Installation Files  7  Select and copy the LXEConnect msi and Setup exe files from the VX6 to the user PC  Note  the location chosen for files    8  Close the ActiveSync explorer dialog box  Do not disconnect the VX6 ActiveSync  connection     9  Execute the setup exe file that was copied to the user PC  This setup program installs the  LXEConnect utility        fi LXEConnect Bika    Welcome to the LXEConnect Setup Wizard ex     The installer will guide you through the steps required to install LXE Connect on your computer        WARNING  This computer program is protected by copyright law and international treaties   Unauthorized duplication or distribution of this program  or any portion of it  may result in severe civil  or criminal penalties  and will be prosecuted to the maximum extent possible under the law           Figure 1 9 LXEConnect Setup  10  Follow the on screen installation prompts  The default installation directory is C  Program  Files LXE LXEConnect     11  When the installation is complete  create a desktop shortcut to the following file  C  Program  Files LXE LXEConnect LXEConnect exe  If a different directory was selected during  installation  please substitute the appropriate directory     12  LXEConnect is no
56.  Transcriber    Access  Start   Programs   Remote Desktop Connection    There are few changes in the Windows CE version of Remote Desktop Connection as it relates to  the general desktop Windows PC Microsoft Remote Desktop Connection options     Select a computer from the drop down list or enter a host name and tap the Connect button   Tap the Options  gt  gt  button to access the General  Display  Local Resources  Programs and    Experience tabs  Click the         button to access Remote Desktop Connection Help     Note  VX6 and Custom Key Maps  before connecting to a host using Remote Desktop  Connection  go to Start   Settings   Control Panel   Keyboard and select Preload or 0409   depending on system software revision  from the keymap popup  Click OK     Access  Start   Programs   Transcriber    Select Transcriber on the Start   Programs menu  To make changes to the Transcriber  application  enable or disable the current Transcriber session  etc   click the    hand with a pen     icon in the toolbar  Click the         button or the Help button to access Transcriber Help     Windows Explorer    Access  Start   Programs   Windows Explorer    There are a few changes in the Windows CE version of Windows Explorer as it relates to the  general desktop PC Windows Explorer options  Click the         button to access Windows Explorer  Help     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    86    Taskbar    Start Menu Program Options    Access  Start   Settings   Taskbar and Start Menu       
57.  VIEW   arrepto n reae HORT rari at 7  WG Cotitrol Panel n                                                  8  A ciue EE 8  ActiveSync EXP lOve PCI tii 13  LXE Connect Installation Files tinas enr r eese Asar E aR Eea OAE TEE s 14  ID Me UE M 14  LXECOBnDECE NUBOE e ene al e tE 15  i quadr 15  Bluetooth Devices Display     Before Discovering Devices                   sse 17  Sample Bluetooth Address Barcode Label  ion iet n bre recie renda 2   Abouttab a  d Bluetooth AMOS Si ss ai io pan EXER RUP ebbe SEAFARERS 22  V Xo Hardware Configuration  2 terit Ht rrt rb per rp n rtr artes 30  Th   Power  Om Oil  SWITCH REI ERAI UTER RH EIE FUR LOUP RE UTI 35  Scanner Serial Connector  COM Divina aaa 37  Printer PC Serial Connector  COM unitarias RE A AE ERA 38  Pinqut  Serial Cable cuasi loa 39  Pinout   Screen Blanking Cable ii aliado 40  Sample Cable Tor Sereen Blanlat   uicit dr p Or cpi o RR WEE ae ERE AFER VER UE ERE PU Ceu ea Ud 40  VX6 USB Connector and External USB Adapter Cable Connector                        eee 41  VX6 Ethernet  USB Dongle Cables  ont pati cds 42  DIS Female Connector  uni 43  Dongle Cable USB  Host Poltica pro ae o na rU E Ero 44  Dongle Cable USB Client POP  tiere ey toner p i Ore ts 44  Dongle Cable Ethernet noir ERR                             REEE 45  VX6 Audio Jack for External Speaker or Headphones              5 ierit 46  The Power COn io 47  The UPS Battery Pack Input Conve ctor  1 14  nope peior rep te Erste e eee eoe etr Ree pep AERE 48  The UPS
58.  VX6 displays the IP address given by the DHCP server     Now go back and authenticate the server     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 231    Server Authentication    To validate the server certificate install the root CA certificate  For instructions for installing  see     Root Certificates     later in this chapter     Authentication Settings    User Certificate  Issued to    Issued by      Validate Server       Figure 5 48 Authentication Settings  Validate Server    Navigate to the Wireless Network Properties configuration screen   Click the Properties button   Check the Validate server    Click OK to dismiss the configuration boxes     Advanced Wireless Settings    Use Windows to configure my wireless settings  Preferred Networks    Y Add New         peapTest  preferred        Automatically connect to Networks to only access points y   non preferred networks    access     Figure 5 49 Advanced Wireless Settings  Authenticated SSID       Once the authentication completes  the status changes to show the VX6 has authenticated to the   lt SSID gt   as shown in the figure above     Click on the IP Information tab and make sure there is a valid IP address as shown in the figure  labeled    IP Information Tab     earlier in this chapter     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    232 Cisco Radio    PEAP  GTC Authentication Configuration  The Microsoft supplicant authenticates a user with the PEAP GTC protocol     Configuring the PEAP   GTC Supplicant  With the radio p
59.  access password properties    PC Connection Control the connection between the VX6 and a local desktop or laptop  computer    PCMCIA Manage PCMCIA cards    Power Displays the status of all power managed devices    Regional Settings Set appearance of numbers  currency  time and date based on regional  and language settings    Remove Programs Remove user installed programs in their entirety              E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    306    About    Control Panel Options    Option Function    Scanner Set scanner keyboard wedge  scanner icon appearance  active scanner  port  and scan key settings  Assign baud rate  parity  stop bits and data  bits for available COM ports   See Chapter 4     Scanner            Stylus Set double tap sensitivity properties and or calibrate the touch panel        System Review System and Computer data and revision levels  Adjust Storage  and Program memory settings        Volume and Sounds   Set volume parameters and assign sound wav files to Windows CE  events        Wi Fi Set the parameters for a Summit radio  See Chapter 5     Wireless  Network Configuration    for details on the SCU                 Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   About    Displays hardware and software details        Tab Title Contents    Software GUID  Windows Windows CE version  OAL Version  Bootloader Version   Compile Version  FPGA Version and Language          Hardware CPU Type  Codec Type  FPGA Version  Scanner type  Display  Flash memory   and DRAM memory
60.  adapter is selected for Current Adapter     e To disable the internal network adapter  create a file in the System directory named  NoEther tag  The contents of the file are unimportant  but the file must be named  NoEhter tag and it must be in the system directory   If the system directory  contains a file named Ether tag  you can rename this file to NoEther tag instead of  creating a new file   After creating the file  coldboot the VX6  After the VX6  finishes booting  the internal Ethernet adapter is disabled  The restore the adapter   delete the NoEther tag file and coldboot and the VX6     Enabler Uninstall Process  To remove the LXE Avalanche Enabler from a Windows CE mobile device   e Delete the Avalanche folder located in the System folder   e Warm boot the mobile device     The Avalanche folder cannot be deleted while the Enabler is running  See Stop the Enabler  Service  If sharing errors occur while attempting to delete the Avalanche folder  warm boot the  mobile device  immediately delete the Avalanche folder  and then perform another warm boot     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 139    Stop the Enabler Service  To stop the Enabler from monitoring for updates from the Management MC Console   1  Open the Enabler Settings Panels by tapping the Avalanche icon on the desktop   Select File   Settings  Enter the password   Select the Startup Shutdown tab     ee do    Select the    Do not monitor or launch Enabler    paramete
61.  and 4831 Type II PCMCIA radios  Substitution of    other PCMCIA radios will void the FCC  Industry Canada and other  international radio certifications for the Model VX6 Vehicle Mount Computer  and is strictly prohibited        1  Turn the VX6 off and detach the power cable     2  Loosen the three  3  Phillips head screws securing the access panel cover so the cover can  be removed  The screws are a captive part of the cover and cannot be removed     Partially insert the Type II PCMCIA Radio into Slot A  the upper right slot      Caution Slot A MUST BE used for the radio card  Installing a radio card in Slot B can    result in pinching or other damage to the internal antenna cable           Radio Card z       Figure 2 33 Inserting the Type Il PCMCIA Radio    Note  The tethered access panel cover is not shown in the illustration above     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    64    PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots    Before completely inserting the radio  connect the Antenna Cable s  to the radio  using the  port s  indicated below     Note  Radio cards for single antenna units may have the unused antenna port covered  with tape     The internal antenna is a dual  diversity  antenna     Summit CF 802 11a b g Radio Card    The Summit 802 11a b g radio has four antenna ports  two ports are for the    a    portion   5 0GHz  of the radio and two ports are for the    b g    portion  2 4 GHz  of the radio     CF radio is installed on a PCMCIA adapter  Hold the radio card with the antenna port
62.  applies     Revision Notice    VX6 Reference Guide  Upgrade From Revision H to Revision J    Chapter 5     Wireless Network Added sections     Auto Profile    and    Auth Server       Configuration            8 Revised sections     Main Tab        Radio Mode    and    Hide Password           Note  A complete revision history is included in Appendix C     Reference Material        Table of Contents    CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION 1  A A 1  When to Use ihis GUIO cusincurcniicnaciicna id 2   Document Conveni ONS ERE RE 3   Bie 4o  irri a a 4  Troubles NI in 4  Entering the Multi AppLock Activation Key noni 5  Hotkey  Activation hotk  y ta 5  A hegre e           n           I     5  Deal  ji       A OUEe                            6   o NI q                                                   HP 9  Keyboard Data EMI Leinen did dioit n rU EP Ep Ud DE PD m UM 9  Tethered ACA iii 9  Bl  uetoothi conidios EAEE EEE G 9  RS 232 Data PU A     M 9  Eie eal cii IET 10  o PME MC DV cc        10  Input East 10  is A A A 11  Setup the Radio and Network iiiciciiinncin ca cR ER DRE R Eb LERER EAE RR RR REPE DEAKEE LUN nnmnnn 12  Setup Terminal Emulation Parameters                                   eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeennennnnnnn 12  Configuring the VX6 with LXEConnect                                  eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenenn nnn 13  NULA n  MD 13  Usine LXECONNE C m TD a 15  AcliveSyno   Intal Setup siii    A                       m 16  A A TI EL 16  A A Pu REM E EEA 16   80 1  Mec acca ste A eases 16  A
63.  been pressed and trapped by the LOG_EX  HotKey processing   Ctrl Processing the hotkey and backdoor entry  LOG_EX  Decrypt acquire context failure Unable to decrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Decrypt acquired context OK Decryption process ok  LOG_EX  Decrypt create hash failure Unable to decrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Decrypt created hash OK Decryption process ok  LOG_EX  Decrypt failure Unable to decrypt password  LOG_ERROR  E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide                                                                      332 AppLock Error Messages  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Decrypt import key failure Unable to decrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Decrypt imported key OK Decryption process ok  LOG_EX  Encrypt acquire context failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt acquire encrypt context Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  failure  Encrypt acquired encrypt context Encrypt password process successful  LOG_EX  OK  Encrypt create hash failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt create key failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt created encrypt hash OK Encrypt password process successful  LOG_EX  Encrypt export key failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt export key length failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt exported key OK Encrypt password process successful  LOG_EX  Encrypt failure The password encryption failed  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt gen key failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  E
64.  cable to the PC and to the  dongle cable on the VX6  The VX6 connects automatically     2  Click the Syne Now button to synchronize with the PC    3  Click the Disconnect button or remove the cable to disconnect    4  To modify the Synchronization settings  see the Options icon on the ActiveSync window on  the desktop PC    Synchronizing from the VX6 using Serial or RF connection     You must have set up ActiveSync on your desktop computer and completed the first  synchronization process before you initiate synchronization from your device     1  To initiate synchronization from your device  tap Start   Programs   Communication    ActiveSync to begin the process     Click the Connect button   Tap the Syne Now button to synchronize with the PC     Tap the Disconnect button to disconnect     Gi a  ae    To modify the Synchronization settings  see the Options icon on the ActiveSync window on  the desktop PC     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Start Menu Program Options 83    Connect    Connect is used to initiate a hardwired connection to a host  Several pre defined connect setups  are included in the factory setup     e COMI direct connect at 57600 or 115200 baud  e COM3    direct connect at 57600 or 115200 baud  e USB direct connect   The default connect setup is USB direct connect     After a connect setup is selected  Start   Programs   Communication   Connect will start to  connect to a host  After this connection is made and an ActiveSync relationship established  the
65.  changing and removing items from the Custom IDs list  tap the OK button to save  changes and return to the Barcode panel     Parameters    Name text box    ID Code text box    Buttons    Name is the descriptor that is used to identify the custom Code ID  Names  must be unique from each other  however  the Name and ID Code may have  the same value  Name is used in the Symbology drop down box to identify  the custom Code ID in a user friendly manner  Both Name and ID Code must  be specified in order to add a custom Code ID to the Custom IDs list     ID Code defines the data at the beginning of a barcode that acts as an  identifier  the actual Code ID   Both Name and ID Code must be specified in  order to add a custom Code ID to the Custom IDs list        Add Entering data into both the Name and ID Code fields enables the Add button   Tap the Add button and the data is added to the next empty location in the  Custon ID list        Insert Tap on an empty line in the Custom ID list  The Add button changes to Insert   Enter data into both the Name and ID Code fields and tap the Insert button  The  data is added to the selected line in the Custom IDs list        Edit Double tap on the item to edit  Its values are copied to the text boxes for  editing  The Add button changes to Replace  When Replace is tapped  the  values for the current item in the list are updated        Clear All When no item in the Custom IDs list is selected  tapping the Clear All button    clears the Custom ID
66.  chapter  Please contact your LXE  representative for details           There are two Summit radios offered in the VX6     an 802 11g radio  capable of both 802 11b and 802 11g data rates   an 802 11a radio  capable of 802 11a  802 11b and 802 11g data rates    These radios support no encryption  WEP  LEAP or WPA  PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC   WPA LEAP  EAP TLS  EAP FAST and WPA PSK         A          When using the 802 1 1a radio  the U NII 1 band is the preferred band for indoor  operation  For regulatory domains in which the U NII 3 band is allowed  the  following channels are supported  149  157 and 161  The AP must be configured  accordingly           VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 181    Summit Client Utility    Note  When making changes to profile or global parameters  the VX6 should be warmbooted  afterwards     Access  Start   Programs   Summit   SCU or  Summit Icon on Desktop or  Summit Tray Icon  if present  or  Wi Fi icon in the Windows CE Control Panel  if present     Summit Client Utility ke    OK  3    Main  Profile   Status   Diags   Global    Active Profile   Default        SUMMIT Status  Associated    DATA COMMUNICATIONS Radio Type  BG    Auto Profle   on   of List    Admin Login Reg  Domain  FCC    Driver  v2 01 22    Disable Radio SCU   v2 D1 12 About SCU                     Figure 5 1 Summit Client Utility    The Main tab provides information  admin login and active profile selection     Profile specific parameters are found on the Profile 
67.  data bytes unconditionally    4 Strip trailing data bytes unconditionally    5 Parse for  and strip if found  Barcode Data strings    6 Replace any control characters with string  as configured    7 Add prefix string to output buffer    8 If Code ID is  not  stripped  add saved code ID from above to output buffer    9 Add processed barcode string from above to output buffer    10 Add suffix string to output buffer    11 Adda terminating NUL to the output buffer  in case the data is processed as a string    12 If key output is enabled  start the process to output keys  If control characters are  encountered     e If Translate All is set  key is translated to CTRL   char  and output   e If Translate All is not set  and key has a valid VK code  key is output   e Otherwise  key is ignored  not output      The data is ready to be read by applications     See    Barcode Processing Examples    at the end of the    Barcode Manipulation    section     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    158 Barcode Manipulation    Barcode Manipulation    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner    If your scanner applet has an    Advanced    tab instead of a    Barcode    tab  please see section titled     Advanced    at the end of this chapter                                                                                      Factory Default Settings   Main   Port 1 Disabled   Port 2 COMI   Power Port 1 while asleep Disabled   Enable Internal Scanner Sound Enabled   Send Key Messages  WED
68.  end of the list is reached   If the wildcard   is not specified  the string is assumed to strip from the beginning of the  barcode data  The string ABC  strips off the prefix ABC  The string  X YZ will strip off  the suffix XYZ  The string ABC XYZ will strip both prefix and suffix together  More than  one   in a configuration string is not allowed   The user interface will not prevent it  but  results would not be as expected  as only the first   is used in parsing to match the string    The question mark wildcard   may be used to match any single character in the incoming  data  For example  the data AB D will match ABCD  ABcD  or ABOD  but not ABDE  It  is valid to have more than one   in a string to match multiple characters    The Barcode Data is saved per symbology configured  The Symbology selected in the  Symbologies dialog defines the symbology for which the data is being configured    Note that the Code ID  if any are configured  is ignored by this dialog  regardless of the  setting of Strip  Code ID in the Symbologies dialog  If Strip Code ID is disabled  then the  barcode data to match must include the Code ID  If Strip Code ID is enabled  the data  should not include the Code ID since it has already been stripped     VX6 Reference Guide    168 Barcode Manipulation    Add Prefix Suffix Control    See Also  Barcode Processing Overview earlier in this chapter        Symbology  fan y  Strip   M  Enable Min    Max  ang     Leading      Add  Trailing          Prefix   
69.  gt  Name of the application being locked LOG PROCESSING  dwProcessID   lt   gt  Device ID of the application being locked LOG EX  Encrypt exported key len  lt  gt  Size of encrypt export key LOG EX  Encrypt password length   lt  gt  The length of the encrypted password  LOG EX  Encrypted data len  lt  gt  Length of the encrypted password LOG EX  hProcess   lt   gt  Handle of the application being locked LOG EX  Key pressed    lt  gt  A key has been pressed and trapped by the hotkey LOG EX  processing   EEE ERNE ES The status information is being saved to a file and the LOG_EX  file has been opened successfully   Address of keyboard hook AppLock found the kbdhook dll  but was unable to get LOG_ERROR  procedure failure the address of the initialization procedure  For some  reason the dll is corrupted  Look in the  Windows  directory for kbdhook dll  If it exists  delete it  Also  delete AppLock exe from the  Windows directory and  reboot the unit  Deleting AppLock exe triggers the  AppLock system to reload   Address of keyboard hook AppLock successfully retrieved the address of the LOG_EX  procedure OK keyboard filter initialization procedure   VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J                                                                         AppLock Error Messages 331  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Alt pressed The Alt key has been pressed and trapped by the LOG_EX  HotKey processing   Alt Processing the hotkey and backdoor entry LOG_EX  Application 
70.  host type    that you  require  This will depend on the type of host system that you are going to connect to  1 e   3270 mainframe  AS 400 5250 server or VT host     4  Enter the    Host Address    of the host system that you wish to connect to  This may either be a  DNS name or an IP address of the host system     5  Update the telnet port number  if your host application is configured to listen on a specific  port  If not  just use the default telnet port     6  Select OK    7  Select Session   Connect from the application menu or tap the    Connect    button on the  Command Bar  Upon a successful connection  you should see the host application screen  displayed     To change options such as Display  Colors  Cursor  Barcode  etc   please refer to the    RFTerm  Reference Guide    on the LXE Manuals CD     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Configuring the VX6 with LXEConnect 13    Configuring the VX6 with LXEConnect    Requirements  ActiveSync version 3 8  or higher  must be resident on the host  desktop laptop   computer  Please see the following section ActiveSync     Initial Setup for more  details on ActiveSync     ActiveSync is already installed on the VX6  The VX6 is preconfigured to establish a USB  ActiveSync connection to a PC when the proper cable is attached to the VX6 and the PC  If The  VX6 uses a serial port for ActiveSync  it is necessary to configure the VX6 to use the serial port   Complete details on the proper cables and port configuration are included 
71.  ia 112  A O E 112  dco disable inn 112  Touch Serena Disable  AN 112  Touch Sireen Heater Disable carito rocio pM M ENS 112  Network and Dialup Lane pi em 113  a O SEI LARUM 114  A ev TERE EOE TORE REE DT REACHED e 115  A Lo oos tst MEME M MED M E MM MEME 116  POUR Dionis Mui A A 117  POWDER Mtm UID ELE UM IL erc nes 118  Regional SOEUR  oso 119  Remove Protein iii 119  CAMEL RNC ITE TETTE OL STENT 119  A RI re ERN 120  IUE disse A aU eM Cp MM LR UU E C MM I MM MMC 120  E adeat hectare es RL Net n caa at duxi duis Ei EE DUE 120  Li                                     121  General ROUEN A cepere PRSE qt 121  Memory de                                      M          122  Device A A A un GL cU a M A CURL RE 122  o o A Oe tee te 122  Terminal Server Client Licenses i   123  Voume and ECT NEU ER 123  Doi A A NEN 123  CF Flash Cards  CAB Files and Programs                                  eese 124  Access Filegon the Pl La dato 124  Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync                                         esses eese esses eee eeeees 125  O M EM M RUN 125  Y X6 und ActiveSync Partnership A 125  Senal Port DESEE oss od obe Mud Peu A Ne DEN ALES DI SUE 125  UR LER s c AAA A HR PO 126  o e pe iur eL LL IM E E 126  A A o 126  A O A A AE EE 127  A UMEN EMT INDU  N MM isons a M NEUE 127  USB   D MA A O PECON 127  dU EA I e D PITE 127  Important Information     Cold Boot and Loss of Host Re connection                           ss 127  Troubleshooting iain cdi licitis qupl Ves gu pb Rs Fn 
72.  is shipped from LXE  The installation files are located in the System folder on CE  devices  The installation application must be run manually the first time Avalanche is used     After the installation application is manually run  a reboot is necessary for the Enabler to begin  normal performance  Following this reboot  the Enabler will by default be an auto launch    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    296 Installed Software    application  This behavior can be modified by accessing the Avalanche Update Settings panel  through the Enabler Interface  The designation of the mobile device to the Avalanche CE Manager  is LXE_VXC        LXE CE devices manufactured before October 2006 must have their drivers and system files  upgraded before they can use the Avalanche Enabler functions  Please contact an LXE  representative for details on upgrading the mobile device baseline     If the user is NOT using Wavelink Avalanche to manage their mobile device  the Enabler  should not be installed on the mobile device s      VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Desktop 297    Desktop    For general use instruction  please refer to commercially available Windows CE     A user s guides or the Windows on line Help application installed in the mobile  device     The VX6 Desktop appearance is similar to that of a desktop PC running Windows 2000 or XP     At a minimum  it has the following icons that can be double tapped with the stylus to access My  Computer  Internet Explorer  and the Recycle
73.  level  There are no user  options on this screen   VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 323    Regional Settings    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Regional Settings  Set the appearance of numbers  currency  time and date based on regional and language settings   Adjust the settings and tap the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     Options  and defaults  for the regional settings depend on the fonts included in the OS image   Please refer to the section on the About control panel earlier in this chapter for more details                             Factory Default Settings   Regional Setting   English  United States    Number 123 456 789 00    123 456 789 00 neg  Currency  123 456 789 00 pos     123 456 789 00  neg  Time h mm ss tt  tt AM or PM    Date M d yy short   dddd MMMM dd yyyy long          Tap the Customize button to set Number  Currency  Time and Date format for the selected  Locale     Remove Programs    Scanner    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Remove Programs    No change from general desktop Remove Programs options  Select a program and click Remove   Follow the prompts on the screen to uninstall user installed only programs  The change takes  effect immediately     Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner    Set scanner keyboard wedge  scanner icon appearance  active scanner port  and scan key settings   Assign baud rate  parity  stop bits and data bits for available COM ports  
74.  list and any text written  and not yet added or inserted  in  the Name and ID Code text boxes        Remove          The Clear All button changes to a Remove button when an item in the Custom  IDs list is selected  Tap the desired line item and then tap the Remove button to  delete it  Line items are Removed one at a time  Contents of the text box fields  are cleared at the same time        E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide       172 Barcode Manipulation    Control Code Replacement Examples      Example  Configuration Translation Control Example Translated    data Character configuration data    Ignore drop  The control    Ignore  drop     Ox1B in the  character is barcode is  discarded from discarded   the barcode data   prefix and suffix    Printable text Text is Start of TeXt      STX    0x02 ina  substituted for barcode is  Control converted to  Character  the text    STX      Hat encoded text The hat encoded   Carriage    AM    Value 0x0d in  text is translated   Return a barcode is  to the equivalent converted to  hex value  the value  Ox0d   Escaped hat  The hat  Horizontal ar Value 0x09 in  encoded text encoding to pass   Tab a barcode is  thru to the converted to  application  the text    TP   Hex encoded text   The hex  Carriage    Ox0A    Value 0x0D in  encoded text is Return a barcode is  translated to the converted to a  equivalent hex value Ox0A   value   Escaped hex  The hex  Vertical Tab       0x0A    or Value 0x0C is  encoded text encoding to pass    O x0A
75.  lockup Det a   idu dat tis network  authorization for Voxware enabled applications complete   dnmibaoted Wavelink Avalanche management of the VX6 startup completes  and     TRES Bluetooth relationships establish or re establish   VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Quick Start 5    Entering the Multi AppLock Activation Key  See Also  Chapter 6    AppLock        Hotkey  Activation hotkey     If the mobile device uses LXE   s Multi AppLock to allow the user to switch between applications   the default Activation key is Ctrl Spc  The key sequence switches the focus between one  application and another  Data entry affects the application running in the foreground only  Note  that the system administrator may have assigned a different key sequence to use when switching  applications     Touch    Note  The touch panel must be enabled     Tap the taskbar icon to place the popup menu on screen  Tap one of the application icons in the  popup menu  The selected application is brought to the foreground while the other application  continues to run in the background  Stylus taps affect the application running in the foreground  only     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    Components    4    2       Figure 1 1 VX6 Components  Top View    aro N o o Mos os   wv A UV W U U o d UD Y uu 3  SHSCSCHSTCHRHSLE   E   e 4     1    VX6       Components    Access Panel Cover  See  Following Illustrations for  Detail     Antenna Connectors or  Hole Plugs    Speakers   Control Panel    See Following  I
76.  mode is selected  the radio attempts to connect to another client radio   Both client radios must be in Ad Hoc mode and have the same SSID specified     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    190 Summit Radio    Auth Type  802 11 authentication type used when associating with AP    Options  Open  Shared key  LEAP    Default  Open    Note  Set the Auth Type radio parameter is set to    Open    for all configurations unless using  LEAP  not WPA  and the AP is configured for network EAP only  In this case  set the  Auth Type radio parameter to    LEAP        EAP Type  Extensible Authentication Protocol  EAP  type used for 802 1x authentication to AP  Options  None  LEAP  EAP FAST  PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC  EAP TLS  Default  None    Note  The EAP type chosen determines if the Credentials button is active  Available entries on  the Credentials pop up window vary by EAP type chosen     Security    Type of encryption used to protect transmitted data  This parameter was labeled as Encryption in  some versions of the SCU     Options  None   Manual WEP  Auto WEP  WPA PSK  WPA TKIP  WPA2 PSK  WPA2 AES  CCKM TKIP  CKIP Manual  CKIP Auto    Default  None  Note  The Encryption type chosen determines if the WEP PSK Keys button is active     Available entries on the pop up window vary by encryption type chosen     IMPORTANT   The settings for Auth Type  EAP Type and Encryption depend on the security  type chosen  Please refer to    Summit Wireless Security     later in this chapter  to  determine
77.  new bootloader image  eboot nb0  into the  boot flash  The tag file is deleted and the VX6 is rebooted to begin using the new boot loader   If there is no  nbO file it does not re flash and deletes the REFLASH TAG     The VX6 automatically reboots after flashing the bootloader     Loading OS Image    is  displayed on the screen and when the new OS finishes loading  all software upgrades are  complete    Secure the user access cover using the captive screws     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Clearing Persistent Storage 137    Clearing Persistent Storage    The coldboot utility sets all registry settings back to LXE factory defaults  No other clearing is  available or necessary     Network Configuration    There are two networking options available for the VX6   e Wireless radios    e Ethernet  RJ 45  connector     Wireless Radios  Please refer Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration    for information on configuring the  Summit  Cisco or Symbol radio    Ethernet Connector    When the VX6 is networked using the Ethernet connector  the VX6 s networking options are set  via the Microsoft Windows CE Control Panel     EA For more information on configuring the Microsoft Windows CE network  settings  please refer to the Windows CE Help feature or commercially available  Windows networking literature     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    138 Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    A VX6 device manufactured before October 20
78.  normal operation  so AppLock   s control of the taskbar  should be removed   Unhooking wndproc When the administrator leaves user mode  the device is LOG_EX  fully operational  therefore  AppLock must stop  monitoring the locked application   WM SIZE adjusted This message denotes that AppLock has readjusted the LOG EX  window size   X after Ctrl L Processing the backdoor entry  LOG EX  Ret from password  lt   gt  Return value from password dialog  LOG EX  Decrypt data len  lt   gt  Length of decrypted password  LOG EX  Window handle to The window handle that is passed to the enumeration LOG EX  enumwindows  x function  This message can be used by engineering with  other development tools to trouble shoot application  lock failures   WM_WINDOWPOSCHG Output the window size after it has been adjusted by LOG_EX  adjusted  x AppLock                   VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    AppLock Registry Settings 339    AppLock Registry Settings    This system application runs at startup via the    launch    feature of LXE Windows CE devices   When the launch feature is installed on the device  the following registry settings are created  The  launch feature registry settings are embedded in the mobile device OS image   HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE  Software  LXE  Persist  Filename AppLock exe    HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE  Software  LXE  Persist  Installed   HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE  Software  LXE  Persist  FileCheck                             AppLock registry settings identify the application that i
79.  not being ignored  Once the user types any character into the  Replacement edit control  reselecting the character from the Character drop  down box redisplays the default Ignore  drop  in the Replacement edit control                 E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    170    Barcode Manipulation       Replacement    The edit control where the user types the characters to be assigned as the  replacement of the control character  Replacements for a control character are  assigned by selecting the appropriate character from the Character drop down  box  typing the replacement in the Replacement edit control  according to the  formats defined above  and then selecting Assign  The assigned replacement is  then added to the list box above the Assign button     For example  if    Carriage Return    is replaced by Line Feed  by specifying    PJ     or    0x0A     in the configuration  the value Ox0d received in any scanned  barcode  or defined in the prefix or suffix  will be replaced with the value  0x0a     The Wedge then sends Ctrl J to the receiving application  rather than Ctrl M        List Box    The list box shows all user defined control characters and their assigned  replacements  All replacements are enclosed in single quotes to delimit white  space that has been assigned        Delete          This button is grayed unless an entry in the list box is highlighted  When an  entry  or entries  is highlighted  and Delete is selected  the highlighted  material 1s deleted from
80.  of the barcode data for the type of ID  specified in the Barcode tab     Enable Code ID field  AIM or Symbol  plus any  custom identifiers     When a code ID match is found as the scanner driver processes incoming barcode  data  if the symbology is disabled  the barcode is rejected  Otherwise  the other  settings in the dialog are applied and the barcode is processed  If the symbology is  disabled  all other fields on this dialog are grayed     When there are no customized settings  and the Enable checkbox is unchecked  All  1s selected and no other settings are customized  a confirmation dialog is presented  to the user    You are about to disable all scan input     Is this what you want to do       Tap the Yes button or the No button  Tap the X button to close the dialog without  making a decision     If there are customized settings  uncheck the Enable checkbox for the All  symbology  This results in disabling all symbologies except the customized ones        This field specifies the minimum length that the barcode data  not including Code  ID  must meet to be processed  Any barcode scanned that is less than the number  of characters specified in the Min field is rejected  The default for this field is 1              This field specifies the maximum length that the barcode data  not including Code  ID  can be to be processed  Any barcode scanned that has more characters than  specified in the Max field is rejected  The default for this field is All  If the value  entered 
81.  on the  manufacturer   s web site  Contact your LXE representative for Bluetooth product assistance     LXE supports several different types of barcode readers  This section describes the interaction and  setup for a mobile Bluetooth laser scanner or laser imager connected to the VX6 using Bluetooth  functions     e The VX6 must have the Bluetooth hardware and software installed  An VX6 operating  system upgrade may be required  Contact your LXE representative for details     e Ifthe VX6 has a Bluetooth address identifier barcode label affixed  then Bluetooth  hardware and software is installed     e The mobile Bluetooth laser scanner   laser imager battery is fully charged     e The barcode numbering examples in this segment are not real and should not be created  nor scanned with a Bluetooth scanner     e To open the LXEZ Pairing program  tap Start   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth or  tap the Bluetooth icon on the desktop or tap the Bluetooth icon in the taskbar     TET Tl           ll        Figure 1 13 Sample Bluetooth Address Barcode Label                Locate the barcode label  similar to the one shown above  attached to the mobile device  The label  is the Bluetooth address identifier for the VX6     The mobile Bluetooth scanner   imager requires this information before discovering  pairing   connecting or disconnecting can occur           Important  The VX6 Bluetooth address identifier label should remain protected from damage   rips  tears  spills  soiling  e
82.  password is  entered  the Administration Control panel is displayed  When a valid password is not entered  within 30 seconds  the user is returned to the System Control Panel     If a password has not been configured  the Administrator Control panel is displayed     Important  Before setting up multiple instances of the same application  make sure the  targeted software application will allow two instances to run at the same time     Application Panel    Note    Users of Single Application AppLock have a Control tab instead of an Application tab   Some of the options in this section do not apply to the Control tab        Administrator Control       Application Security   Options Status    Filename  PO E Icom  E  Title  D 7  Order  bo    Arguments        Internet  4 Menu Status Launch        Clear        gt      Global    Key   ctrl Spa y  Input Panel   APLCKPNET2Cn                   Figure 6 4 Application Panel    Note  If your Application Panel does not look like the figure shown above  you may have the  Single Application version   Single Application version     Use the Application tab options to select the applications to launch when the device boots up in  End user Mode     If no application is specified when the Administrator Control Panel is closed  the mobile device  reboots into Administrator mode  If a password has been set  but an application has not been    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Application Configuration    specified  the user will be prompted for th
83.  perform other security  tasks     You can also use this Web site to dowmload a certificate authority  CA  certificate  certificate chain  or  certificate revocation list  CRL   orto view the status of a pending request     For more information about Certificate Services  see Certificate Services Documentation     Select a task   Request a certificate  View the status of a pending certificate request  Download a CA certificate  certificate chain  or CRL       Figure 5 80 Certificate Services Welcome Screen    Click the Download a CA certificate  certificate chain or CRL link     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    250 Certificates    Make sure the correct root CA certificate is selected in the list box     Microsoft Certificate Services    johndoe       Download a CA Certificate  Certificate Chain  or CRL    To trust certificates issued from this certification authority  install this CA certificate chain     To download a CA certificate  certificate chain  or CRL  select the certificate and encoding method     CA Certificate                 Encoding method     ODER  OBase 64    Download CA certificate  Download CA certificate chain  Download latest base CRL  Download latest delta CRL    Figure 5 81 Download CA Certificate Screen    Click the DER button     To download the CA certificate  click on the Download CA certificate link     File Download   Security Warning x     Do you want to open or save this file     Name  certnew cer    Type  Security Certificate  1 10 KB  From  
84.  process will be started  and then  Launch will continue  leaving the loading process to run independently  For other persist keys   including  CAB files   Launch will wait for the loading process to complete before continuing   This is important  for example  to ensure that a  CAB file is installed before the  EXE files from  the  CAB file are run     The Order field is used to force a sequence of events  Order 0 is first  and Order 99 is last   Two items which have the same order will be installed in the same pass  but not in a predictable  sequence  Note  If the order of loading is not critical  it may be easier to use the  System Startup  folder instead  see below     The Delay field is used to add a delay after the item is loaded  before the next is loaded  The delay  is given in seconds  and defaults to 0 if not specified  If the install fails  or the file to be installed  is not found   the delay does not occur     The PCMCIA field is used to indicate that the file  usually a CAB file  being loaded is a wireless  client driver  and the PCMCIA slots should be started after this file is loaded  By default  the    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    132 VX6 Utilities    PCMCIA slots are off on powerup  to prevent the    Unidentified PCMCIA Slot    dialog from  appearing  Once the drivers are loaded  the slot can be turned on  The value in the PCMCIA field  is a DWORD  representing the number of seconds to wait after installing the CAB file  but before  activating the slot
85.  radio connects to the  network     Note  When using Automatic PAC Provisioning  once authenticated  there is a file stored in the   System directory with the PAC credentials  If the username is changed  that file must be  deleted  The filename is autoP 00 pac     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    216 Summit Radio    EAP TLS  To use EAP TLS  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to EAP TLS  e Set Encryption to WPA TKIP  e Set Auth Type to Open    Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 28 EAP TLS    Please review    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials     earlier in this chapter   Click the Credentials button     e Noentries except the User Certificate Filename and the CA Certificate Filename are  necessary for Sign On Credentials as the user will be prompted for the User Name  and Password when connecting to the network     e For Stored Credentials  User  Password and the CA Certificate Filename must be  entered     Enter these items as directed below     Credentials                Figure 5 29 EAP TLS Credentials    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    217    Enter the Domain Username  if the Doman is required   otherwise enter the Username    Leave the certificate file name entries blank for now    Click OK then click Commit  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the Main tab   Once successfully authenticated  import the user certificate into the Windows cert
86.  radio goes out of range from the currently selected profile  the  radio then begins to attempt to connect to the profiles listed under Auto Profile     The search continues until     e the SCU connects to and  if necessary  authenticates with  one of the specified  profiles or    e until the Off button is clicked to turn off Auto Profile     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    186 Summit Radio    Profile Tab    Notes  If the Admin password is not entered  the user can view the Profile parameter settings  but cannot make any changes  The buttons on this tab are grayed out if the user is not  logged in     The Profile tab was previously labeled Config     Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 5 SCU   Profile Tab    When logged in as an Admin  see the Main tab   use the Profile tab to manage profiles     e Rename      Gives the profile a new  unique name  If the new name is not unique  an  error message is displayed and the profile is not renamed     e Delete     Deletes the profile  The current active profile cannot be deleted  In that  case  an error message is displayed and the profile is not deleted     e New   Creates a new profile with the default settings  see the list below  and  prompts for a name  The name must be unique  If not  an error message is displayed  and the profile is not created     e Scan     Scans for and displays a list of available APs  Can be used to create a profile  from the APs listed     e Commit  Ensures that the profile settings made on thi
87.  serial port     the laptop  connection will not work     RTS CTS Handshaking and the Serial Port                   RTS Ready to Send CTS Clear to Send  DTR Data Terminal Ready DSR Data Set Ready  Remote Side The device sending data to and receiving data from the VX6    through the LXE serial cable connected to the RS 232 ports on  both devices     LXE Serial Cable 9000A054CBLD9D9                   The VX6 serial port supports four types of handshaking via the LXE serial cable  None  standard  Xon Xoff  standard DTR DSR  and a form of RTS CTS     To use RTS CTS  the remote side computer must clear the DTR line which sets the VX6 CTS line  and allows the VX6 to send data to the remote side     This allows signals and data to travel smoothly between both devices     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    40 External Connectors    Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable    The customer must supply their own cable  The cable must be designed so that pin 7  RTS      Request to Send Output  and pin 8  Clear to Send Input  of a D9 female connector provide  continuity only when the vehicle is stopped  for example  via a switch on the accelerator pedal of  the fork truck   All other pins on the connector must be left unconnected  If pins 7 and 8 do not  provide continuity  or the cable is removed   the VX6 screen remains blank     Serial cable     Customer built cable with the following specifications     oo C1            Pinout        DB9 female Function   1 Not Used  Not Use
88.  terminal to install the new driver with the registry     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    226 Cisco Radio    Wireless Network Configuration    Use the following instructions for all authentication protocols to configure the Microsoft Wireless  Network configuration utility unless WPA LEAP is used  WPA LEAP is configured with the  Cisco ACU  see Section    WPA LEAP Authentication Configuration         Click the ACU icon on the desktop     Select Active Profile     Profiled     External Settings  gt  y     350 Series Radio is Not    iated  B      Figure 5 38 Cisco ACU Profile Selection       From the    Select Active Profile    pull down list  select   External Settings     Click OK and warmboot     Please remove and re insert the adapter to have this change take effect     Alternatively  turn the device off and on        Figure 5 39 Cisco ACU Reboot Message    After booting up  the Microsoft Zero Config tool should start  If it does not  start configuring the  wireless connection by clicking on the icon on the task bar shown in below     EX    Figure 5 40 Microsoft Wireless Connection Icon    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 227    The Wireless Network Connection screen appears           Figure 5 41 Wireless Information Screen    Make sure the    Notify me when new wireless networks are available    box is not checked     Click the Advanced    button     Advanced Wireless Settings       Only access points          Figure 5 42 Advanced Wireless Settings    Ma
89.  the  lt F10 gt  key is not used as the display backlight timer also controls  the keyboard backlight     1  Display Brightness  Control Keys  Not  used     2  Display Contrast  Control Keys  Not  used     3  Speaker Volume  Control Keys  Not  used     4  Backlight Control  Key  See above        Figure 2 29 The VMT Keyboard Display Controls    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    The QWERTY Keyboard 27    General Windows CE Keyboard Shortcuts    Use the keyboard shortcuts in the chart below to navigate with the VX6 keyboard  These are  standard keyboard shortcuts for Windows CE applications                                Press these keys     To      CTRL C Copy  CTRL  X Cut  CTRL V Paste  CTRL Z Undo  DELETE Delete       Select more than one item in a window or on the    A ro desktop  or select text within a document                    CTRL A Select all    ALT ESC Cycle through items in the order they were opened   CTRL ESC Display the Start menu    ALT Underlined letter in a menu       am   Display the corresponding menu        Underlined letter in a command    Carry out the corresponding command   name on an open menu       ESC Cancel the current task        The touchscreen provides equivalent functionality to a mouse   e A touch on the touchscreen is equivalent to a left mouse click     e Many items can be moved by the    drag and drop    method  touching the desired item   moving the stylus across the screen and releasing the stylus in the desired location     e A double s
90.  the ACS server name is correct  click the OK button and the server name field will be filled in  with the correct server name     The other option is to fill in the correct name    IP Information   IPv6 Information   Wireless Information    Select a network and press connect or right click for more options     Y Add New     Y peapTest  preferred     Status  Authenticated to peapTest    Signal Strength  Excellent      Notify me when new wireless networks are available       Figure 5 59 Wireless Information  Authenticated    Once the authentication completes the status will change to Authenticated to  lt SSID gt  as shown   Click on the IP Information tab and make sure there is a valid IP address as shown previously in    this section     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 237    WPA LEAP    LEAP is a Cisco proprietary authentication protocol and is not supported by the Microsoft  supplicant  To configure the VX6 for WPA LEAP  use the Cisco ACU installed during normal  installation of the Cisco radio driver     Cisco ACU    Start the Cisco ACU by clicking the icon on the desktop or navigate to Start   Programs   Cisco    ACU     Click on the Profile tab     Select Active Profile   ProfileO Profile    350 Series Radio is Mot  Associated    Figure 5 60 ACU Profile Tab       Click the Rename button     Name the profile    Select Active Profile   LEAP WPA LEAP WPA    350 Series Radio is Not  Associated    Figure 5 61 Renaming Profile       Click the Edit button     E 
91.  the ActiveSync window on  the desktop PC     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Start Menu Program Options 301    Connect    Connect is used to initiate a hardwired connection to a host  Several pre defined connect setups  are included in the factory setup     e COMI direct connect at 57600 or 115200 baud  e COM3   direct connect at 57600 or 115200 baud  e USB direct connect   The default connect setup is USB direct connect     After a connect setup is selected  Start   Programs   Communication   Connect will start to  connect to a host  After this connection is made and an ActiveSync relationship established  the  ActiveSync menu item can be used to establish the connection over the radio link     See Also     Important Information     Cold Boot and Loss of Host Re connection       Start FTP Server   Stop FTP Server    These shortcuts call the Services Manager to start and stop the FTP server  The server defaults to  Off  for security  unless it is explicitly turned on from the menu        12 The COM3 port is labeled    COM2 3        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    302 Start Menu Program Options    Command Prompt    Access  Start   Programs   Command Prompt    x     Pocket CMD v 4 20  y  gt           Figure C 1 Pocket CMD Prompt Screen    Type help at the command prompt for a list of available commands     Exit the Command Prompt by typing exit at the command prompt or select File   Close     Internet Explorer    Access  Start   Programs   Internet Explorer    This opt
92.  the SoundSentry option is selected  please note that Scroll Lock does not produce a visual    warning as the CapsLock and NumLock keys do  This is due to a limitation in the Microsoft  Windows CE operating system     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    92 Control Panel Options    Administrator Control    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PC Connection    Use this option to set parameters for computers intended to be used as dedicated  single  or multi   application devices  In other words  only the application s  or feature s  specified in the AppLock  configuration by the Administrator are available to the user     LXE devices with the AppLock feature are shipped to boot in Administration mode with no  default password  thus when the device is first booted  the user has full access to the device and no  password prompt is displayed  After the administrator specifies an application to lock  a password  is assigned and the device is rebooted or the hotkey is pressed  the device switches to end user  mode     AppLock also contains a component which sets configuration parameters as specified by the  Administrator     To set the AppLock parameters  please see Chapter 6     AppLock    for details     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 93    Bluetooth    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth    Discover and manage pairing with nearby Bluetooth devices                                      Factory Default Settings   Discovered Devices N
93.  the device properties menu   Tap Pair as Scanner to set up the VX6 to receive scanner data    Tap Pair as Printer to set up the VX6 to send data to the printer     Tap Disconnect to stop pairing with the device  Once disconnected  tap Delete to remove the  device name and data from the VX6 Bluetooth Devices list  The device is deleted after the  user taps OK      Upon successful pairing  the selected device may react to indicate a successful connection   The reaction may be an audio signal from the device  flashing LED on the device  or a dialog  box is placed on the VX6 display       Whenever the VX6 is turned On  all previously paired  live  Bluetooth devices in the vicinity    are paired  one at a time  with the VX6  If the devices cannot connect to the VX6 before the  re connect timeout time period expires  default is approximately 20 seconds for each paired  device  there is no indication of the continuing disconnect state if Report Failure to  Reconnect is disabled     See Also  Chapter 3     System Configuration  section titled Bluetooth     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    20 Bluetooth    Bluetooth Devices    Assumption  The System Administrator has Discovered and Paired targeted Bluetooth devices  for each VX6  The System Administrator has also enabled   disabled Bluetooth  settings and assigned a Computer Friendly Name for each VX6  See Chapter 3  System Configuration  Bluetooth control panel applet and supported Bluetooth  printers and scanners     The Bluet
94.  the list box           Barcode     Custom Identifiers    Code IDs can be defined by the user  This allows processing parameters to be configured for  barcodes that do not use the standard AIM or Symbol IDs or for barcodes that have data  embedded at the beginning of the data that acts like a Code ID     These are called    custom    Code IDs and are included in the Symbology drop down box in the  Symbology dialog  unless Enable Code ID is set to None  When the custom Code ID is found in  a barcode  the configuration specified for the custom Code ID is applied to the barcode data  The  dialog below allows the custom Code IDs to be configured     It is intended that custom code IDs are used to supplement the list of standard code IDs  if Enable  Code ID is set to AIM or Symbol   or to replace the list of standard code IDs  1f Enable Code ID  is set to Custom      When Enable Code ID is set to None  custom code IDs are ignored     Note    Custom symbologies will appear at the end of the list in the Symbology dialog  and are  processed at the beginning of the list in the scanner driver itself  This allows custom IDs  based on actual code IDs to be processed before the code ID itself     Note  When Strip  Code ID is enabled  the entire custom Code ID string is stripped  i e    treated as a Code ID      VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation    171                Nam  code    00    ID Code     x    Figure 4 9 Barcode Tab     Custom Identifiers    After adding 
95.  the proper settings for the security type implemented on the wireless LAN     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    Status Tab    191    Summit Client Utility          Figure 5 7 SCU   Status Tab    This screen provides information on the radio     The profile being used  The status of the radio card  down  associated  authenticated  etc    Client information including device name  IP address and MAC address     Information about the Access Point  AP  maintaining the connection to the network  including AP name  IP address and MAC address     Channel currently being used for wireless traffic  Bit rate in Mbit   Current transmit power in mW    Beacon period     the time between AP beacons in kilomircoseconds   one  kilomicrosecond   1 024 microseconds     DTIM interval     A multiple of the beacon period that specifies how often the beacon  contains a delivery traffic indication message  DTIM   The DTIM tells power  saving devices a packet is waiting for them  For example  if DTIM   3  then every  third beacon contains a DTIM     Signal strength  RSST  displayed in dBm and graphically    Signal quality  a measure of the clarity of the signal displayed in percentage and  graphically     There are no user entries on this screen     Note  After completing radio configuration  it is a good idea to review this screen to verify the  radio has associated  no encryption  WEP  or authenticated  LEAP  any WPA   as  indicated above     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide  
96.  though the application name is saved   Enter the desired parameters in the  appropriate text box     Click OK to save the result and close the Keypad Control     If the KeyMap tab is accessed again  the application  plus any specified parameters  is  displayed in the Key Sequence text box when the remapped key is again selected     How To  Remap a Command    I    Qv Uu BA d    E EQ VX6RG J    On the KeyMap tab  select the modifier key from the Modifier Mode options   Select the key to be remapped from the Key pulldown list    Select RunCmd 1 4 from the remapped key from the Remapped Key pulldown list   Click on the RunCmd tab    Make sure the FILE radio button is selected     In the text box  Cmd1 4  corresponding to the number selected for RunCmd1 4  enter the  desired command     If any parameters are needed for the command  click on the PARM radio button  This clears  the text box  though the command is saved   Enter the desired parameters in the appropriate  text box     Click OK to save the result and close the Keypad Control     If the KeyMap tab is accessed again  the command  plus any specified parameters  is  displayed in the Key Sequence text box when the remapped key is again selected     VX6 Reference Guide                                     Sidetone    a   12 0dB    BA  34 5dB     12 0 dB    Figure 3 22 Mixer    Control Panel Options      fox  x    Input    O None    ici    O Bluetooth     _ Input Boost       Select the Input for the mixer  Move the sliders to 
97.  to have been Discovered by the VX6 before the  pairing request is received     Click the Accept button or the Decline button to remove the dialog box from the screen     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Bluetooth    19    Continuous search    When enabled  the VX6 never stops searching for a device it has paired with once the connection  is broken  such as the paired device entering Suspend mode  going out of range or being turned    off      When disabled  the VX6 stops searching after one half hour  The search can be restarted by  putting the VX6 through a Suspend Resume cycle or accessing the Bluetooth control panel     This option is disabled by default     Subsequent Use    Note  Taskbar and Bluetooth device Icon states change as Bluetooth devices are discovered     90 m   eo vw dE    pair  connect and disconnect  A taskbar Bluetooth icon with a red background indicates  Bluetooth is active and not paired with any device  A device icon with a red background  indicates a disconnected paired device     Tap the Bluetooth icon in the taskbar or on the desktop to open the Bluetooth LXEZ Pairing  application     Tap the Bluetooth Devices tab     Tap the Discover button  When the Bluetooth module begins searching for in range  Bluetooth devices  the button name changes to Stop  Tap the Stop button to cancel the  Discover function at any time     The discovered devices are listed in the Bluetooth Devices window    Doubletap a Bluetooth device in the Discovered window to open
98.  weak  the radio scans for available  APs more aggressively  Aggressive scanning work with standard scanning  set through Roam  Trigger  Roam Delta and Roam Period   Aggressive scanning should b set to On unless there is  significant co channel interference because of overlapping APs on the same channel     Options  On  Off  Default  On    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 195    CCX Features    Use of Cisco Compatible Extensions  CCX  radio management and AP specified maximum  transmit power features     Options  Full or On  Use Cisco IE and CCX version number  support all CCX features   Optimized  Use Cisco IE and CCX version number  support all CCX features  except AP assisted roaming  AP specified max  transmit power and  radio management   Off  Do not use Cisco IE and CCX version     Default  Off  for 802 11b g radio   Optimized  for 802 11a b g radio   WMM  Use of Wi Fi Multimedia extensions   Options  On  Off  Default  Off    Auth Server  Specifies the type of authentication server     Options  Type 1  ACS server   Type 2  non ACS server     Default  Type 1    TX Diversity  How to handle antenna diversity when transmitting packets to AP     Options  Main only   Main antenna only  Aux only   Aux antenna only  On   Use diversity    Default  On  for 802 11b g radio   Main Only  for 802 11a b g radio     The value for this parameter should be set as follows                       Antenna Configuration TX Diversity  A Main and BG Main Main Only   A Main and A 
99.  with first two characters      01     strip first 2 and last 8   This 24  character barcode is CODE128     e 20 character length with first two characters      00     strip first 0  no characters  and last 4     On the Barcode tab  set Enable Code ID to AIM     Create four custom IDs  using 1 for EAN128 barcode and O for Code128 barcode     e cl Code     Cl     e c2 Code     Cl     e c3   Code       C0     24 character barcode is CODE128   e c4 Code     C1       Custom IDs    MN CE joe ES nmn              00 ci    cr E    cl    pe M ID Code     c4  ci  El    Figure 4 10 AIM Custom IDs       AIM custom symbology setup is assigned in the following manner     e cl min length   34  max length   34  strip leading 2  strip trailing 18  Code ID enabled   Barcode Data      01       e c2 min length   26  max length   26  strip leading 2  strip trailing 10  Code ID enabled   Barcode Data      01       VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Length Based Barcode Stripping 175    e c3 min length   24  max length   24  strip leading 2  strip trailing 8  Code ID enabled   Barcode Data      01      e c4 min length   20  max length   20  strip leading 0  strip trailing 4  Code ID enabled   Barcode Data      00       Add the AIM custom symbologies  Refer to the previous section Barcode     Symbology Settings  for instruction     Symbology   a    Strip  Enable Min   5 Max  p Leading k    Trailing  18    Em       Figure 4 11 AIM Custom Setup for C1    Click the Barcode Data button  Click the Add b
100.  with the Mobile  Device Server occurs  a mobile device that is in Suspend  Mode can    wakeup    and process updates        Reboot before attempt    Reboot mobile device before attempting to contact Mobile  Device Server        Require external power    Only connect when the device has external power           Use relative offset             VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    Startup Shutdown    147    LXE recommends using LXE AppLock to manage the taskbar  AppLock is resident on each  mobile device with a Windows OS  AppLock configuration instructions are located in Chapter 6        Avalanche Update Settings      Execution   Server Contact   Startup Shutdown Scan        gt         Program Startup     O Do not monitor or launch Enabler     8  Monitor For updates    O Monitor and launch Enabler   Manage Taskbar    Lan Lock    Hide    a       Program Shutdown        Stop monitoring        e Continue monitoring        Figure 3 43 Startup   Shutdown Options       Do not monitor or launch Enabler    When the device boots  do not launch the Enabler  application and do not attempt to connect to the Mobile  Device Server        Monitor for updates    Attempt to connect to the Mobile Device Server and  process any updates that are available  Do not launch  the Enabler application        Monitor and launch Enabler    Attempt to connect to the Mobile Device Server and  process any updates that are available  Launch the  Enabler applicatio
101.  your desktop  computer     Allow connection with desktop computer when device is attached    Connect using     USB Client       Figure C 16 Communication   PC Connection Tab          Please refer to the    Backup VX6 Files    section later in this chapter for parameter setting  recommendations     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 321    PCMCIA    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PCMCIA    Enable or disable the PCMCIA slots  Information on the card currently in the PCMCIA slots and  the Compact Flash slot is provided        Factory Default Settings  Disable slot now Unchecked                   The Slot 0 and Slot 1 Tabs contain the same parameters  If a card is present in the slot  a  description of the card is displayed  To disable a slot  check the Disable slot now checkbox and  tap OK  The change takes effect immediately  Slot 0 is the lower slot  labeled    PCMCIA B     Slot  1 is the upper slot  labeled    PCMCIA A        PCMCIA Control    sito   soti   se      Card  Cisco Systems 350 Series Wireless LAM Adapter 512A       Disable slot now  E Write protect slot     Power slot during sleep  3 3        Figure C 17 PCMCIA Control Tab  Slot 0 and Slot 1    The Slot 2 Tab provides information on the internal Compact Flash ATA drive  There are no user  configurable options     PCMCIA Control         seo   se    soez      Card   Internal ATA  61 MB        Figure C 18 Compact Flash ATA Control Tab  Slot 2    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    
102. 06 must have drivers and system files upgraded  before it can use the Avalanche Enabler functions  Please contact an LXE representative for  details on upgrading the mobile device baseline     If the user is NOT using Wavelink Avalanche to manage their mobile device  the Enabler  should not be installed on the mobile device     Briefly        The Wavelink Avalanche Enabler installation file is loaded on the mobile device by LXE   however  the device is not configured to launch the installation file automatically  The installation  application must be run manually the first time Avalanche is used  After the installation  application is manually run  a reboot is necessary for the Enabler to begin normal performance   Following this reboot  the Enabler will by default be an auto launch application  This behavior  can be modified by accessing the Avalanche Update Settings panel through the Enabler Interface     Enabler Install Process    Enabler Install Process  e  Doubletap the LXE VXC ENABLER CAB file in the System folder   e Warm boot the mobile device     Because the VX6 has two possible network adapters  the internal adapter for a cabled network  connection and the wireless network card   the Enabler uses the first network adapter it discovers   In order to assure the Enabler uses the wireless connection  perform one of the following actions     e Select the Adapters tab in the Enabler setup  See    Enabler Configuration     later in  this chapter  and make sure the wireless
103. 1  325  Wire Color   Cable Wiring    iuis 71  WPA   Radio Driver  Cisco  oooooccoocnconncconanoonnnconocnnncconnos 223   Supported Authenticati0MS    oooonoccccincinnommm o  179   Cisco RO eiii 223  Summit Radio                    sse 180   System Requirements  Cisco                   ssessss 223  WPA LEAP   Cisco Radio                sse 237   Summit Radio                  sss 212  214  WPA PSK   Cisco Radio         neces ncn 244   Summit Radio                 ssssseseeeeree 218    Z    Zero Config Utility  Microsoft                         sss 226    E EQ VX6RG J    
104. 100 100 100 100    Open   Save   Cancel          while files from the Intemet can be useful  this file type can  potentially harm your computer  If you do not trust the source  do not  open or save this software  What s the risk        Figure 5 82 Download CA Certificate Screen    Click the Save button and save the certificate  Make sure to keep track of the name and location  of the certificate     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 251    Installing a Root CA Certificate    Note  This section is used for Cisco radios only  Summit radios do not use the Windows  certificate store  Instead  copy the certificate to the  System folder for use with a Summit  radio     Copy the certificate file to the VX6  Import the certificate by navigating to Start   Control Panel    Certificates     3 j     bg    Certificates    Certificates    Class 2 Public Primary Certification Authority  Class 3 Public Primary Certification Authority       Entrust net Certification Authority  2048   Entrust net Secure Server Certification Authorit      Equifax Secure Certificate Authority   GlobalSign Root CA              Figure 5 83 Certificates    Click the    Import    button     Import Certificate or Key       Figure 5 84 Import Certificate    Make sure    From a File    is selected and click OK     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    252 Certificates       Select a Certificate File ES  z     QJ  My Documents           Shortcut to Office Templates Ink    Name   certnew cer Type   Certific
105. 2 41  Figure 2 42  Figure 2 43  Figure 2 44  Figure 2 45  Figure 3 1   Figure 3 2   Figure 3 3   Figure 3 4   Figure 3 5   Figure 3 6   Figure 3 7   Figure 3 8   Figure 3 9   Figure 3 10  Figure 3 11  Figure 3 12  Figure 3 13  Figure 3 14  Figure 3 15  Figure 3 16  Figure 3 17  Figure 3 18  Figure 3 19  Figure 3 20  Figure 3 21  Figure 3 22  Figure 3 23  Figure 3 24  Figure 3 25  Figure 3 26  Figure 3 27  Figure 3 28  Figure 3 29  Figure 3 30  Figure 3 31  Figure 3 32  Figure 3 33  Figure 3 34  Figure 3 35  Figure 3 36  Figure 3 37  Figure 3 38  Figure 3 39  Figure 3 40  Figure 3 41  Figure 3 42  Figure 3 43  Figure 3 44  Figure 3 45  Figure 3 46  Figure 3 47    E EQ VX6RG     Inserting the CF ATA CBE ced e rad oo Aa ie 67  Inserting the SD ATA Cardio sioe ete detenti ed ede deed n ER ET EUG 68  Optional Power Supply Cable    acies d br enit ttd ee eed s a i Er IE NER ERGO 69  Direct Vehicle Power Connection Cable  12 Et   uice berba Hoc HR ERR need ene arrar Eaei 71  Connecting the Power Cable to the V ehiCles  a scrsscvedsca cect oorr pert tr rre ins 71  Vehicle Connection Wiring Color Codes arias 71  Power Adapter Cable  V2  Ata  Vania 72  Fuse  Replacement ositos asibe 3  Pocket CNM Promoted 84  Taskbar Properti  s   50 nasus pt o pero E HEU gv EHE TOR RUE EO EE ELE oH aiii 86  Abaut Properties  SONWANE siergras D DT HE HER Et HET tbt e e ERES 89  About Properties  VerSI  DS acsi dos tin ls eet 90  About Properties  Network IP    iiiter tine eh m e eme ei 90  Accessibilit
106. 3  express Scan Desktop 60H ii GENES bass DR ER Rea sb OR ER ET 154  EX press  Scan Password Input arista Ur e rint 154  Scan Barcode  uicit raten utat tr renti n utut nre rtis 155  Scan reat IRIS BAC OCS PRINCI                                r m 135  Configuring Settings ien D anclas 156  Scanner ontrol Mart Td ticas 159  Scanner Control   COM Port Tab rin reor a t p OE lia meus 160  Scanner Control y Barcode tabo co otim rop D reat piba dial 161  Barcode Tab   Symbolopy SI unir red iS ana aE 163  Strip Leading Trailing Controls aunando dd ii 165  Barcode Data Match Taste ic 166    Add Pr SUR COMO Si li i   168  Barcode Vab  C tel  Char Mapping  iint pert teer br Cr Dre erra 169  Barcode Tab Custom MG Smt Ct qoi par EHE PR HERRERA RR IRUFRREHB pnr Gasp I rR PERRO epu 171  PANEG rU ni  as ca 174  AIM Custom Setup for C     a ainsi ie siena aiii 175  Barcode Match Data TOr CI zia nau a lidia 173  Enable Screen Blankine 5 23  pon out n EE NOTOS b pO deis 176  Summit Chent BITS REDE EE 181  oC US YA 183  Admin Password Eta dls 184  Select Profiles Tot Auto Pr Olle ii AEAEE Heb AAEE ERE OE REENE ENE SAER E 185  SCU   Profile Tab  acetone Sr rrt nen v ei eO P UE EEEE ERAS 186  elc                                                                            M A 187  SCS Sta IAD PE 191  SCU   Diags Tabarca 192  sre BEGIN dll solid 193  SICH SC D DL DL 200  Choose   yi Lele    ace t e TO EE EO HO TUER Dr EE HT IHE ina IRINE 202  Derme Profile docct ecd t e rd te rare dq Un EE EE 203  N
107. 341    The following table lists ASCII Control codes in hexadecimal and their corresponding Control key combinations                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                     Char   Hex   Control    Control Action  Key   NUL 0 Na  NULL character Ctrl Shift   VK CONTROL  0x11  down  VK A  0x41  down   SOH 1  A Start Of Heading WM_CHAR  0x1   VK_A  0x41  up  VK_CONTROL  0x11  up   STX 2    B Start of TeXt Ctrl b   ETX 3 AC End of TeXt Ctrl c   EOT 4    D End Of Transmission Ctrl d   ENQ 5 AE ENQuiry Ctrl e   ACK 6  F ACKnowledge Ctrl f   BEL 7  G BELI  rings terminal bell Ctrl g   BS 8  H BackSpace  non destructive  Ctrl h   HT 9  I Horizontal Tab  move to next tab position  Ctrl i   LF a AJ Line Feed Ctrl j   VT b  K Vertical Tab Ctrl k   FF c  L  Form Feed Ctrl 1   CR d AM Carriage Return Ctrl m   SO e AN Shift Out Ctrl n   SI f  O Shift In Ctrl o   DLE 10  P Data Link Escape Ctrl p   DCI 11  Q Device Control 1  normally XON Ctrl q   DC2 12  R Device Control 2 Ctrl r   DC3 13  S Device Control 3  normally XOFF Ctrl s   DC4 14 AT Device Control 4 Ctrl t   NAK 15  U Negative AcKnowledge Ctrl u   SYN 16  V SYNchronous idle Ctrl v   ETB 17  W End Transmission Block Ctrl w                      E EQ VX6RG J    V X6 Reference Guide    342 ASCII Control Codes                            Char   Hex E Co
108. 4  F   Extended temperature version   100     Vibration Bounce loose cargo for 0 5 hour duration  Common carrier  transportation  transit face   75G  5msec duration  100 shock impacts       VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Environmental Specifications 289    Display Specifications    800 X 320 pixels  25 lines x 80 characters     Cell Size 8 x 16 pixels   8 x 8 also supported     25 lines x 80 chars     ET    Display Dimensions 280mm x 218mm x 11mm  11 0  x 8 6  x 0 4        Viewing Area 249mm x 187 5mm  9 8  x 7 38      Active Display Area 246mm x 98 3mm  9 7  x 3 87        UPS Battery Pack Specifications    Operational to 10 000 ft   3048 meters     Operating Temperature    30   C to  50   C   22   F to  122   F     Storage Temperature  40   C to  70   C   40   F to  158   F              Water  Sand and Dust   IP66 per IEC60529  10 90  Non condensing at 40  C  104  F     Vibration Bounce loose cargo for 0 5 hour duration  Common  carrier transportation  transit face        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    290 Network Device Specifications    Network Device Specifications    Summit 802 11b g CF 2 4GHz    Compact Flash via a PCMCIA adapter    Radio Frequencies  2 4   2 4897 GHz IEEE 802 11b 802 11g DSSS  OFDM    1 2 55  6 9 11  12 18  24  36  48  54 Mbps  RF Power Level  64 mW  18dBm     Summit 802 11a b g CF 2 4 5 0GHz    Bus Interface  Compact Flash via a PCMCIA adapter    Radio Frequencies  2 4   2 4897 GHz IEEE 802 11b 802 11g DSSS  OFDM    5 x   5 x GHz IEEE 802 11
109. 6  Bluetooth Settings  Chart                       sss 97    C    CAB Files on the Flash Card                                 124  Calibration    uec orto a 120  324  CAPS LOCK Mode LED Indicator                          54  Caps Lock Mode                    seen 54  Central Processing Unit                   esses 31  Certificates  iii aida 100  310   VX6 Reference Guide    354   AO qe                                eters 249   USt csetera mme mne e ey 253  Character Recognition   Touchscreen              ssessseeeeeeene 85  303  Cisco   PEAP Suplicatit             rete s 224   WPA Radio  Diver conidios  223  Cisco Client  hin deine eee 222  Cisco Radio   WED ati 221  Cleaning   Display in ni unie 60  Clear Contents of Document Folder                 86  304  Clear persistant memory                  eee 137  CMOS  Battery A e pie 32  CMOS NiCd Battery              sss 73  Code ID transmission setting                       esses 162  Coldboot vine cis aise el cee ee ee ES 24  COLDBOOT EXE              eeeeeennrn nn 133  Color   Cable Wiring    71  Color screen   Backlight          inier 102  313  COM port   screen blanking                      eene 176  COM port settings tab     oooooonconnccinoniccnocnccnnonnonnnonos 160  COM POS  nes cete ettet tenentes 119  157  323  COM I Scanner Connection  Location                        7  COM3 Connector  Location      cocooocononccccnnnnncononnanonons 7  Comm Ports   COM sirio eeu 36  37   COMB reas a es eaten 36  38  Command Prompt   
110. 6RG J    Application Configuration 273    Launch Button  Note  The Launch button may not be available in all versions of Multi AppLock  Contact your  LXE representative for assistance  downloads and AppLock update availability     When clicked  displays the Launch options panel for the Filename selected on the Administration  panel           Application Launch Options  Launch     v Auto At Boot Retries  fo Delay  fro   Y Auto Re launch Retries  fo Delay  fo        Manual        Allow Close Match                       Figure 6 5 Application Launch Options    Note  Launch order is determined by the Order specified in the Application tab  The Order  value does not have to be sequential     AppLock contains several types of delays and timeouts to accommodate different applications   Please note that the delays specified on this panel are delays before AppLock attempts to start the  specified application s   The timesouts specified on the Options panel are delays after AppLock  has attempted to launch the application     Auto At Boot    Default is Enabled  Auto At Boot  when enabled  automatically launches  subject to the specified  Delay in seconds  the application after the unit is rebooted  If a Delay in seconds is specified   AppLock waits for the specified period of time to expire before launching the application  The  Delay default value is 10 seconds  valid values are between 0    no delay    and a maximum of 999  seconds     Auto At Boot Retries is the number of times the 
111. A     Refer to Appendix A    Key Maps    for 101 key keyboard equivalent keypresses     The keyboard is used to manually input data that is not collected otherwise  Almost any function  that a full sized computer keyboard can provide is duplicated on the VX6 keyboard but it may  take a few more keystrokes to accomplish a keyed task     Almost every key has two or three different functions  The primary alpha or numeric character is  printed on the key     For example  when the  lt 2   gt  key is selected pressing the desired second function key produces  the  lt 2  gt  character ie   lt 2   gt      Fl   toggles the CAPS Lock function  The specific  lt 2  gt   character is printed above the corresponding key     Please refer to Appendix A    Key Maps    for instruction on the specific keypresses to access all  PC compatible keyboard functions     Tethered Scanners    The VX6 supports an accessory barcode label reading device  Keyboard data entries can be mixed  with barcode data entries  Any scanner that decodes the barcode internally and outputs an RS 232  data stream may be used  COM port 1 is designed to be used with a hand held tethered barcode  scanner     COM1 is set to  5V on pin 9 up to accept input from a barcode scanner by default  To change       the setting for pin 9  refer to Chapter 4     Scanner    section titled    Serial Port Pin 9    for details     Bluetooth Scanners    Bluetooth scanners are paired to the VX6 wirelessly using the VX6 Bluetooth wireless clien
112. A EE dd b x Fea id 128  Crede d Communication CODO si od 129    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents vil    Technical Specifications     Connection Cable os cssszsnssen saarisacesascsasssosanisessauanssintecnsinatedasasaganns 130  20 AMA                   131  LAUNCHEAE asilos 131  REGEDIT EX E pasan ca 133  REGLOAD EXE ii ii 133  REGDUMP EXE caries 133  WARMBOOT  EXE a a a ER 133  WAVPLAY EXE nue eique tad DM E deu su MES 133  perge go D LS CRT II ERES 133  COLDBOOT EX oo 133  POSO EX E rio td RSE P 133  AAA 134  ROMS th   VAG it                                         135  How To  Reflash using Keypress Melodia uD opu E 135  How To  Reflash using TAG Me Method accio 136  Clearing Persistent SIOFBBB ne enoni 137  Network CORTIQUIOUON sonic rr da 137  A MM D DM UN 137  EHE Comet api 137  Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration     oommocncccccccncnnnnnnnanncncnencnnnnnnananannns 138  BASS riadas 138  A                138  Euer ARIS PEO duod rM A AUR Du RPM UM SU EIUS 138  Enabler Uminstall Process as iesu a penanidad eden det dus nua iu Cas bee am a osea a moi sS CH e uu Dose 138  Stop the Enabler A A 139  Update Monitoring CEE AAA A 139  Mobile Device Wireless and Network Seblinggs  eee eret retra peer nde eni Here is 140  A A A 141  Fil   Meni OP a o ia 142  Avalanche Update Settings  A Rd Eb cA GU Q   143  hune EN 143  Conectores 144  EXCUSA 145  Server Conia E TEN 146  Sarup SHUG Wiis ER 147  Scan C OMA ue E 148  Display AEST 148  SOON ce 149  API als ro
113. Aux On   BG Main and BG Aux On   A Main only Main Only  BG Main only Main Only                Please contact your LXE representative if you have questions about the antenna s  installed on  your VX6     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    196 Summit Radio    RX Diversity  How to handle antennas diversity when receiving packets from AP     Options  Main Only   use main antenna only  Aux Only   use aux  antenna only  On start on Main   On startup use main antenna  On start on Aux   On startup use aux antenna    Default  On start on Main  for 802 11b g radio   Main only  for 802 11a b g radio     The value for this parameter should be set as follows                                   Antenna Configuration RX Diversity   A Main and BG Main Main Only   A Main and A Aux On Start On Main   BG Main and BG Aux On Start On Main   A Main only Main Only   BG Main only Main Only  Please contact your LXE representative if you have questions about the antenna s  installed on  your VX6   Frag Thresh    If the packet size  in bytes  exceeds the specified number of bytes set in the fragment threshold   the packet is fragmented  sent as several pieces instead of as one block   Use a low setting in areas  where communication is poor or where there is a great deal of radio interference     Options  256 to 2346  Default  2346    RTS Thresh    If the packet size exceeds the specified number of bytes set in the Request to Send  RTS   threshold  an RTS is sent before sending the packet  A low RTS thre
114. CE   VK ADD VK F3 VK NUMPADO  VK APOSTROPHE VK F4 VK OEM CLEAR  VK APPS VK F5 VK OFF  VK ATTN VK F6 VK PAI  VK BACK VK F7 VK PAUSE  VK BACKQUOTE VK F8 VK PERIOD  VK BACKSLASH VK F9 VK PLAY  VK BROWSER BACK VK FINAL VK PRINT  VK BROWSER FAVORITES VK HANGUL VK PRIOR  VK BROWSER FORWARD VK HANJA VK RBRACKET  VK BROWSER HOME VK HELP VK RBUTTON  VK BROWSER REFRESH VK HOME VK RCONTROL  VK BROWSER SEARCH VK HYPHEN VK RETURN  VK BROWSER STOP VK INSERT VK RIGHT  VK CANCEL VK JUNJA VK RMENU  VK CAPITAL VK KANA VK RSHIFT  VK CLEAR VK KANJI VK RWIN  VK COMMA VK LAUNCH APPI VK SCROLL  VK CONTROL VK LAUNCH APP2 VK SELECT  VK CONVERT VK LAUNCH MAIL VK SEMICOLON  VK CRSEL VK LAUNCH MEDIA SELECT VK SEPARATOR  VK DECIMAL VK LBRACKET VK SHIFT  VK DELETE VK LBUTTON VK SLASH  VK DIVIDE VK LCONTROL VK SLEEP  VK DOWN VK LEFT VK SNAPSHOT  VK END VK LMENU VK SPACE  VK EQUAL VK LSHIFT VK SUBTRACT  VK EREOF VK LWIN VK TAB  VK ESCAPE VK MBUTTON VK UP  VK EXECUTE VK MEDIA NEXT TRACK VK VOLUME DOWN  VK EXSEL VK MEDIA PLAY PAUSE VK VOLUME MUTE  VK Fl VK MEDIA PREV TRACK VK VOLUME UP  VK F10 VK MEDIA STOP VK ZOOM  VK FII VK MENU  VK F12 VK MULTIPLY  VK F13 VK NEXT  VK F14 VK NOCONVERT  VK F15 VK NONAME  VK F16 VK NUMLOCK  VK F17 VK NUMPADO  VK F18 VK NUMPADI  VK F19 VK NUMPAD2  VK F2 VK NUMPAD3  VK F20 VK NUMPAD4  VK F21 VK NUMPADS  VK F22 VK NUMPAD6  VK F23 VK NUMPAD7  VK F24 VK NUMPADS                                     VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    ASCII Control Codes    ASCII Control Codes    
115. Certificate File Name blank for now    Click OK then click Commit  Ensure the correct Active profile is selected on the Main tab   Please review    Windows Certificates Store vs  Certs Path    earlier in this chapter     Once successfully authenticated  import the CA certificate into the Windows certificate store   Return to the Credentials screen and check the Validate server checkbox        Password  LXE    CA Cert    tru trusted store           Validate server Use MS store          Figure 5 20 PEAP MSCHAP Certificate Filename    If using the Windows certificate store   e Check the Use MS store checkbox  The default is to use the Full Trusted Store   e To select an individual certificate  click on the Browse button   e Uncheck the Use full trusted store checkbox     e Select the desired certificate and click Select  You are returned to the Credentials  screen     If using the Certs Path option    e Leave the Use MS store box unchecked    e Enter the certificate filename in the CA Cert textbox   Click OK then click Commit     The device should be authenticating the server certificate and using PEAP MSCHAP for the user  authentication     For information on generating a Root CA certificate  please see    Root CA Certificate    later in this  chapter     Note  The date must be properly set on the device to authenticate a certificate     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    210 Summit Radio    PEAP GTC  To use PEAP GTC  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter 
116. Control Panel Options    Owner    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Owner Icon  Set VX6 owner details        Factory Default Settings  Identification   Blank  Notes Blank                      There is no change from general desktop PC Owner Properties display  Enter the information and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately        Owner Properties    Identification   Notes   Network ID  At Power On    Name     _  Display owner identification    Company       Address  Work     Home     Area code  Phone        Figure C 14 Owner Properties    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    Password    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Password Icon    Set VX6 access power up password properties        Factory Default Settings       Password    Blank          At Power On          Disabled       319    Note  Once a password is assigned  the Owner and Password Control Panel options require  the password to be entered before the Control Panel option can be accessed  If you  forget the password  it cannot be restored without performing a cold boot on the unit   which erases all memory      Enter the password  then type it again to confirm it and click the OK box to save the changes  The  password is immediately in effect     Tap the Power On checkbox to set whether the user types a password at Power On     Tap the Screen Saver checkbox to set whether the user types a password to clear the screensaver   If there is no 
117. E recommends caution when editing the Registry and also recommends  making a backup copy of the registry before changes are made     REGLOAD EXE    Double tapping a registry settings file  e g  REG  causes RegLoad to open the file and make the  indicated settings in the registry  This is similar to how RegEdit works on a desktop PC  The   REG file format is the same as on the desktop PC     REGDUMP EXE  Registry dump     Saves a copy of the registry as a text file  The file  REG TXT  is located in the  root folder     Note  The REG TXT file is not saved in persistent storage  To use the REG TXT file as a  reference in the even of a coldboot  LXE recommends copying the file to the  SYSTEM  directory on the VX6 or storing a copy of the file on a PC     WARMBOOT EXE    Double click this file to warm boot the computer  i e   all RAM is preserved   It automatically  saves the registry before rebooting which means configuration changes are not lost     WAVPLAY EXE    Double tapping a sound file  e g  WAV  causes WavPlay to open the file and run it in the  background     VX6 Command line Utilites    Command line utilities can be executed by Start   Run    program name      COLDBOOT EXE  Command line utility which performs a cold boot  all RAM is erased      Passwords are lost upon cold boot  If a password is set  that password must be entered to begin the  cold boot power cycle process     PrtScrn EXE    Command line utility which performs a screen print and saves the file in  BMP f
118. EQ VX6RG J    Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync 125    Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync    Using Microsoft ActiveSync version 3 7 or higher  you can synchronize information on your  desktop computer with the VX6 and vice versa  Synchronization compares the data on your VX6  with your desktop computer and updates both with the most recent data     For example  you can   e Back up and restore your device data   e Copy  rather than synchronize  files between your device and desktop computer     e Control when synchronization occurs by selecting a synchronization mode  For  example  you can synchronize continually while connected to your desktop  computer or only when you choose the synchronize command     If the VX6 is connected to a PC by a RS 232 or USB cable  disconnect the cable from the VX6  and reconnect     Check that the correct connection is selected  Serial or USB    Client       Note  By default  ActiveSync does not automatically synchronize all types of information  Use  ActiveSync Options to specify the types of information you want to synchronize  The    synchronization process makes the data  in the information types you select  identical on  both your desktop computer and your device     When installation of ActiveSync is complete on your desktop computer  the ActiveSync Setup  Wizard begins and starts the following processes     e connect your device to your desktop computer     e setup a partnership so you can synchronize information between your device and  y
119. EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    238 Cisco Radio    The profile properties screen is displayed        LEAP  WPA    Properties    Value      wpaTest    PAC Import       Network Security Type WEP Keys     WEP  Authentication Type    User Name  User Password ly  Cancel       Figure 5 62 Profile Properties Screen    Enter the SSID and Client Name in the correct fields   Set the Network Security Type to LEAP WPA    Click the OK button     Select Active Profile   LEAP WPA LEAP WPA    350 Series Radio is Mot  Associated    Figure 5 63 Select Profile       Use the drop down box to choose the profile just configured   Click OK     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 239    The VX6 associates and displays the sign on screen     LEAP EAP FAST Login                   Figure 5 64 Login Screen    Click the Status tab to display status     ACU             Figure 5 65 ACU Status Tab    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    240 Cisco Radio    EAP TLS Authentication Configuration    To authenticate using the EAP TLS protocol you need a user certificate file and a private key file   Once you have the user certificate files run the certificate installer from the Microsoft control  panel  For EAP TLS it does not matter which Cisco cab file is installed     Note  It is important that all dates are correct on the device when using any type of certificate   Certificates are date sensitive and if the date is not correct authentication will fail     User Certificate    To check if a user ce
120. El    OK E    Input Panel  Current input method    lt eyboa                               To quickly switch input methods   tap the Input Panel arrow and then  tap the desired method from the       menu that appears         Allow applications to change the  input panel state          Figure C 11 Input Panel Properties    Use this option to make the Soft Keyboard or the keypad primarily available when entering data   Selecting Keyboard enables both     The Input Panel is disabled by default  To enable the input panel  make sure the checkbox for     Allow applications to change input panel state    is checked and warmboot the VX6     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    Internet Options    Access     315    Start   Settings   Control Panel   Internet Options    Set General  Connection  Security and Advanced options for Internet connectivity        Factory Default Settings       General                                                                   Start Page http   www lxe com   Search Page http   www google com  Cache Size 512 Kb   Connection   Use LAN Disabled   Autodial Name Blank   Proxy Server Disabled   Security   Allow cookies Enabled   Allow TLS 1 0 security Disabled   Allow SSL 2 0 security Enabled   Allow SSL 3 0 security Enabled   Warn when switching Enabled   Advanced   Display web images Enabled   Play web sounds Enabled   Enable web scripting Enabled   Display script error note Disabled   Underline links Never          Select a tab  Adju
121. Encryption   TKIP y  Authentication   wea y     Network key    Key index  m Kev provided automatically    IEEE 802 1X Authentication  Enable 802 1X authentication on this network    EAP type   Cisco PEAP y        Figure 5 37 Cisco PEAP installed     If the Cisco installation is correct continue  with the configuration  If it is not correct  follow the  procedures below   Note  Instructions are also included in the README file located in the  SYSTEM folder   There are two Cisco CAB files in the SYSTEM folder of the VX6  The default files are   e CISCO CAB  e CISCOPEAP CAB    The default CISCO CAB file provides for all authentications except Cisco PEAP  When the  default CISCO CAB file is loaded  the Wireless Network Properties screen looks like the figure  labeled    No Cisco PEAP     above     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio    225    If Cisco PEAP is desired   1  Rename the CISCO CAB file to CISCOMSCHAP CAB   2  Rename the CISCOPEAP CAB file to CISCO CAB   3  Coldboot the terminal to install the new driver with the registry     The renamed CISCO CAB file provides for Cisco PEAP and PEAP GTC authentications  When  the renamed CISCO CAB file is loaded  the Wireless Network Properties screen looks like the  figure labeled    Cisco PEAP Installed     above     If it becomes necessary to switch to a different authentication than Cisco PEAP or PEAP GTC   1  Rename the CISCO CAB file to CISCOPEAP CAB   2  Rename the CISCOMSCHAP CAB file to CISCO CAB  3  Coldboot the
122. Factory Default Settings   Always on Top Enabled  Auto hide Disabled  Show Clock Enabled                         There are a few changes in the Windows CE version of Taskbar as it relates to the general desktop  PC Windows Taskbar options     When the taskbar is auto hidden  press the Ctrl key then the Esc key to make the Start button  appear                Taskbar and Start Menu Properties    General   advanced      Always on top      Auto hide  Show Clock               Figure 3 2 Taskbar Properties    Advanced Tab    Expand Control Panel   Tap the checkbox to have the Control Panel folders appear in drop down menu format from the  Settings   Control Panel menu option    Clear Contents of Document Folder    Tap the Clear button to remove the contents of the Document folder     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 87    Control Panel Options    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel or My Computer   Control Panel    Getting Help    Please click the         box to get Help when changing Control Panel options     Option Function          About Displays hardware and software details    Accessibility Customize the way the keyboard  display or mouse functions   Administrator AppLock configuration   See Chapter 6     AppLock       Control       Aironet Client Utility   Set the parameters for a Cisco radio   See section    Start Menu  Program Options     only present if Cisco radio software installed                           Bluetooth Discover and manage Blue
123. G  retrieves the application information from the registry   Enter password dialog Entering the password dialog processing  LOG_PROCESSING  Enter password timeout Entering the password timeout processing  LOG_PROCESSING  Enter restart app timer Some application shut down before AppLock can stop LOG_PROCESSING  it  In these cases  AppLock gets notification of the exit   When the notification is received  AppLock starts a  timer to restart the application  This message logs that  the timer has expired and the processing is at the  beginning of the timer function   Enter TaskbarScreenMode Entering the function that switches the screen to non full   LOG_PROCESSING  screen mode and enable the taskbar   Enter ToAdmin Entering the function that handles a mode switch into LOG_PROCESSING  admin mode   Enter ToUser Entering the function that handles the mode switch to LOG_PROCESSING  user mode  Enter verify password Entering the password verification processing  LOG_PROCESSING  Exit AppLockEnum Windows  There are two exit paths from the enumeration function    LOG PROCESSING  Found This message denotes the enumeration function found  the application   Exit AppLockEnum Windows Not There are two exit paths from the enumeration function    LOG PROCESSING  found This message denotes the enumeration function did not  find the application   Exit DecryptPwd Exiting password decryption processing  LOG PROCESSING  Exit EncryptPwd Exiting password encryption processing  LOG PROCESSING  Exit Full
124. GE  Enabled   COM Ports  COMI   COM3      Baud Rate 9600   Parity None   Stop Bits 1   Data Bits 8   Power on Pin 9   5v  Enabled  COM1  Disabled  COM3    Barcode   Enable Code ID None   Symbology Settings Enable Dimmed   Min       to Max     all  AIM  ID  Enable Dimmed  Symbol  ID  Enable Dimmed  Custom Null   Control Character Disabled  Translate All Disabled  Character Replacement NULI   Ignore drop    Custom Identifiers  Name Blank  ID Code Blank          Notes     e   ActiveSync will not work over a COM port if that COM port is assigned to Port 1 or  Port 2 in the Scanner applet as a scanner input  For example  if COMG is being used  by the scanner  COM3 can t be used by any other program     e After scanning a Reset All or equivalent barcode for your specific external scanner   the next step is to select Start   Control Panel   Scanner  Click the OK button and  close the scanner control panel  This action synchronizes all scanner formats     e The scanner wedge does not configure an external scanner  Supported symbologies  must be enabled for external scanner  see the documentation provided with the  external scanner   Enabling or disabling a symbology in the scanner wedge only  affects processing of the barcode data  It does not enable or disable the external  scanner s ability to scan the symbology     e LXE 8300 Tethered Scanners and Symbology Settings  AIM ID      Before  manipulating data received from an 8300 series scanner  and symbology settings are  desired  th
125. History  and the following charts   e Valid VK Codes for CE  e  ASCII Control Codes  e Hat Encoding    e  Decimal Hexadecimal Chart    E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    330    AppLock Error Messages    AppLock Error Messages    Any messages whose first word is an    ing    word is output prior to the action described in the  message  For example     Switching to admin hotkey press    is logged after the administrator has  pressed the hotkey but prior to starting the switch process     For all operations that can result in an error  an Error level message is displayed when a failure  occurs  These messages contain the word    failure     These messages have a partner Extended level  message that is logged which contains the word    OK    if the action completed successfully rather    than with an error     For processing level messages     Enter       is logged at the beginning of the function specified in  the message and    Exit       is logged at the end  just before the return  of the function specified in    the message                                                        Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Error reading hotkey The hotkey is read but not required by AppLock  LOG_EX  Error reading hotkey  using default A hotkey is required  If there is a failure reading the LOG_ERROR  hotkey  the internal factory default is used   App Command Line   lt Command Command line of the application being locked LOG PROCESSING  line   App    Application name
126. Is   device drivers  events and messaging  graphics  keyboard and touchscreen input   window management  and common controls     Network and Device Drivers  Wavelink Avalanche  Optional   LXE AppLock    Java  Optional     e Java executables and browser components are handled by the Java option  when installed      Terminal Emulation  Optional   e RFTerm  VT220  TN5250  TN3270   Runs automatically at the conclusion of each reboot   if installed    LXE API Routines  see  Accessories  for the LXE SDK Kit part number     Note    Please contact your LXE representative for software updates and CAB files as they are  released by LXE     Software Applications  The following applications are included   e WordPad  was PocketWord in previous versions of Windows CE   e Word Viewer  e Excel Viewer  e PDF Viewer    e Image Viewer    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Installed Software 295    e Scanner Wedge  LXE developed   e ActiveSync   e   Transcriber   e Media Player   e Internet Explorer    Note that the viewer applications allow viewing documents  but not editing them     Java  Optional     Installed by LXE  Files can be accessed by tapping Start   Programs   JEM CE  Doubletap the  EVM icon to open the EVM Console  A folder of Java examples and Plug ins is also installed  with the Java option  LXE does not support Java applications running on the mobile device     LXE RFTerm  Optional     AppLock    Installed by LXE  The application can be accessed by tapping Start   Programs   RFT
127. Key Maps Revised section    Creating Custom Keymaps for the VX6        Appendix B     Technical Added    Revision History    to appendix   Specifications Added Summit Radio Technical Specifications     Appendix C     AppLock Deleted appendix  Information is now included in Chapter 6  AppLock        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Revision History 349    Revision E  November 2006    Added Wavelink trademark information   Chapter 1     Introduction Revised    When to Use this Guide        Chapter 2     Physical Added information that was previously included in Chapter 3     Power  Description and Layout Supply        Chapter 3     Power Supply Deleted chapter  This information is now included in Chapter 2     Physical  Description and Layout        Chapter 4     System Renamed to Chapter 3     System Configuration        Configuration Revised    Software Load        LAUNCH EXE     Control Panel Options    and     Scanner    section  Scanner information is now included in Chapter 6      Scanner        Added new section    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration      Chapter 4     Scanner Created new chapter with scanner information removed from Chapter 4      System Configuration    and updated as necessary   Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Revised    Summit Radio    section to include new Sign On screen and  Configuration support for PEAP GTC   Chapter 6     AppLock Revised    Setup A New Device        Revision F  November 2007    Added CE 5 0 information and instruction 
128. LXE device by double clicking the eXpress Scan icon on the    desktop     express  Scan    Figure 3 51 eXpress Scan Desktop Icon    2  Enter the barcode password used when the barcode was created  if any     eXpress Scan    passcode          Enter Passcode     Press Start before scanning the  first barcode     Figure 3 52 eXpress Scan Password Input       Click Start     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    eXpress Scan 155    3  Barcode 1 must be scanned first  The scanned data is displayed in the    Data    text box  The    password  if any  entered above is compared to the password entered when the barcodes were  created     eXpress Scan    Scan Barcode 1 into Data field        Figure 3 53 Scan Barcode 1    4  If the passwords match  the barcode data is processed and the screen is updated to reflect the  number of barcodes included in the set     eXpress Scan    Scan next barcode into Data field        Figure 3 54 Scan Remaining Barcodes    The remaining barcodes may be scanned in any order  After a barcode is scanned  that  barcode is removed from the    Remaining     list and placed in the    Scanned     list     5  If the passwords do not match  an error message is displayed  The current screen can be  closed using the X in the upper right corner  The password can be re entered and Barcode 1  scanned again     6  Once the first barcode is scanned  the remaining barcodes may be scanned in any order     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    156 eXpress Scan    7  After the l
129. Options    Discover    LXEZ Pairing    Bluetooth Devices   Settings    Bluetooth Address    Discover       Figure 3 8 Control Panel   Bluetooth    Tap the Discover button to locate all discoverable Bluetooth devices in the vicinity  The  Discovery process also queries for the unique identifier for each device discovered        LXEZ Pairing   LXEZ Pairing    Bluetooth Devices il Settings   About    Bluetooth Address   Bluetooth Address    12 34 00 20 E0 00 12 34    Discovering Bluetooth devices    Bn Querying Devices names    haga   NENE LLL nus    L                        Figure 3 9 Discover Bluetooth Devices    Tap Stop at any time to end the Discover and Query for Unique Identifier functions     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 95    Bluetooth Devices    A device previously discovered and paired with the VX6 is shown in the Bluetooth Devices panel        LXEZ Pairing      Bluetooth Devices   settings    Last 4      Bluetooth Address     PrinterO1 00 20 E0 00 12 34  E Printeroz 00 05 4E 00 AA BB       Fi scannero  00 04 76 00 AB CD  Scanner02 00 03 74 00 14 26             Figure 3 10 Bluetooth Devices Panel    Note  When an active paired device enters Suspend Mode  is turned Off or leaves the VX6  Bluetooth scanning range  the Bluetooth connection between the paired device and the    VX6 is lost  There may be audible or visual signals as paired devices disconnect from the  VX6     The discovered paired devices may or may not be identified with an 1co
130. P y  Authentication   WPA PSK y     network  wireless access points are not used    Network key   passphrase Key index  fr Key provided automatically    IEEE 802 1X Authentication  Enable 802 1  authentication on this network    EAP type   peap   y     Figure 5 74 WPA PSK Configuration       Configure the Wireless Network Settings as described in    Wireless Network Settings     earlier in  this chapter     Change the Network Authentication to WPA PSK     Enter an ASCII network key in the text field  Hex keys do not work in the Microsoft Zero Config  utility at this time     There is no server authentication when using WPA PSK     Click the OK button to complete configuration     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Symbol Radio 245    Symbol Radio  The Symbol radio is a 2 4GHz 802 11b radio  This radio supports no encryption and WEP   Note  When making changes to profile parameters  the VX6 should be warmbooted afterwards     Access  Double Tap the Network Connected Icon in the Status Bar       NETWLAN1       IP Information IPv6 Information   Wireless Information    Internet Protocol  TCP IP   Address Type  DHCP    IP Address  100 100 100 100  Subnet Mask  255 255 0 0       Default Gateway           Figure 5 75 Symbol NETWLAN Screen    IP Information Tab    After the IP Address has been assigned to the VX6  tap the Renew button to renew the IP address  if necessary     Tap the Details button to view the Network Connection details     IPv6 Information Tab    This is the TCP IP
131. PA     later in this section     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    220    Cisco Radio    Use this option to manage profiles and review firmware information  status  statistics and wireless                                                                        Figure 5 34 Cisco Profile Properties Screen                  Jaro   PAC Import          e  fno security is used  the only entry necessary on the Profile Properties screen may be the  SSID  If the SSID is left blank  the radio can associate to any available network     Profiles Tab  radio survey data   Profile Parameter Default  SSID Blank  Client Name Blank  Infrastructure Mode Yes  Power Save Mode Fast PSP  Network Security Type None  WEP No WEP  Authentication Types Open  LEAP Disabled  Mixed Mode Disabled  World Mode Disabled  Data Rates Auto  Transmit Power MAX  Offline Channel Scan Enabled  Select an active profile to manage      ProfileO    Properties  Property   Client Name  Infrastructure Mode  Power Save Mode  Network Security Type  WEP  Authentication Type  User Name  User Password y   No Security  Create a new profile or edit an exiting profile   e Network security must be set to None   e WEP must be set to No WEP   VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 221       WEP   To use WEP  create a new profile or select an exiting profile   e WEP must be set to either Static WEP keys or Dynamic WEP keys  When one of the WEP  methods is selected  the WEP Keys button is active   e Authentication must be se
132. PCMCIA  Accepts  Type I and II PCMCIA cards     External Two  2  external RS 232C serial   9 pin  D   male   Connectors  ports  COMI and COM3    connectors  Interfaces   One USB Host and one USB   Client Port Via Adapter Cable   One  1  Ethernet Port    Ee    3 Connector 12 80V DC O N power    Power   Power Switch   Sealed power switch   power switch    Beeper Minimum loudness greater than  95dBm at 10 cm in front of unit    Dimensions Length  12 2 in  30 98 cm     Width  9 6 in  24 38 cm   Depth  3 7 in  9 39 cm     Battery for CMOS Internal lithium Battery PA     External AC Adapter 120 240VAC to 12VDC  Power    Supply          10 64MB Flash and 64MB RAM options have been discontinued      The COM3 port is labeled    COM2 3        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    288 Environmental Specifications    Environmental Specifications    The VX6 will withstand the following environmental characteristics and has been tested in  accordance with applicable sections of MIL STD 810E     Operational to 10 000 ft   3048 meters     Operating Temperature   Standard version    4  F to 122  F   20  C to 50  C   non condensing     Extended temperature version    22   to 122   F   30  C to 50  C  condensing     Storage Temperature Standard version    22  F to 140  F   30  C to 60  C   non condensing     Extended temperature version    22  F to 140  F   30  C to 60  C   condensing     Water  Sand and Dust   IP66 per IEC60529    Humidity Standard version   Up to 90  Non condensing at 40  C  10
133. ROR       Reset system work area failure    The system work area is adjusted when in user mode to  cover the taskbar area  The system work area has to be  adjusted to exclude the taskbar area in administration  mode  AppLock was unable to adjust this area     LOG_ERROR       Shift pressed    The Shift key has been pressed and trapped by the  HotKey processing     LOG_EX       Shift    Processing the hotkey and backdoor entry    LOG_EX       Show taskbar    The taskbar is now being made visible and enabled     LOG_PROCESSING       Switching to admin backdoor          The system is currently in user mode and is now  switching to admin mode  The switch occurred because  of the backdoor key presses were entered by the  administrator     LOG_PROCESSING             VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J                                                       AppLock Error Messages 337  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Switching to admin hotkey press The system is currently in user mode and is now LOG_PROCESSING  switching to admin mode  The switch occurred because  of a hotkey press by the administrator   Switching to admin kbdhook dll not   The keyboard hook load failed  so AppLock switches to   LOG  PROCESSING  found admin mode  If a password is specified  the password  prompt is displayed and remains until a valid password  is entered   Switching to admin keyboard hook If the keyboard hook initialization fails  AppLock LOG PROCESSING  initialization failure switche
134. Radio Driver   SGCFGCECO1A    NET Compact Framework   v1 1  Internet Explorer   MSIE 6 0   LXE Utilities   YXCPC422BT   LXE Drivers   VXCPC422BT   LXE Image P2    VXCPC422BT             Figure C 4 About Properties  Versions    Radio MAC Address  The    Network IP  tab displays the MAC address of the radio card     About kd OK  ES          Software   Hardware   Versions Network IP   l   Adapter 0 5M5C1111 Adapter 1 CISCO1  MAC   00 40 FD 00 00 00 MAC    00 0F 34 00 00 00  IP   0 0 0 0 IP    100  100  100  100  GW    GW             Figure C 5 About Properties  Network IP    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 309    Accessibility    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Accessibility    Customize the way the keyboard  sound  display  mouse  automatic reset and notification sound  function  There is no change from general desktop Accessibility options  Adjust the settings and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately        Accessibility       Keyboard   sound   Display   Mouse   General    Use StickyKevs if you want to use Shift  Ctrl   or Alt key by pressing one key at a time         Use StickyKeys    Use TogoleKeys if you want to hear tones when  pressing CapsLock  NumLock  and ScrollLock       Use ToggleKeys          Figure C 6 Accessibility Properties  Keyboard    Note  The StickyKeys option SHOULD NOT be used on the VX6  It does not work for the  integrated VX6 keyboard     If the ToggleKeys option is selected  pl
135. Reference Guide    16    ActiveSync     Initial Setup    ActiveSync   Initial Setup    The following instructions relate to initial setup of ActiveSync  When there is a Connect icon on  the VX6 desktop  this section can be bypassed     USB Connection    The VX6 is configured to use USB C by default  No configuration is necessary    Connect the cable to the PC  the host  and to the dongle cable on the VX6  the client   The  ActiveSync connection is established automatically when the cable is connected     Cables for USB ActiveSync Connection     USB Client to PC Laptop Dongle cable w USB C     9000A075CBLUSBHCETH  connector    Also requires a standard USB cable with a type A plug on  one end  and a type B plug on the other     Serial Connection    Connect    Radio    Select Start   Settings   Control Panel   PC Connection  Click the Change button  From the  popup list  choose the appropriate COM port and baud rate     This will set up the VX6 to use the USB or designated COM port  Click OK and ensure the check  box for    Allow connection with desktop computer when device is attached    is checked     Click OK to return to the Control Panel   Note  By default COM3  labeled  COM2 3   is configured to use ActiveSync  Pin 9   RI      Please refer to  Serial Port Pin 9  in Chapter 4   Scanner  for details on configuring  Pin 9 of the serial ports     Connect the correct cable to the PC  the host  and the VX6  the client   Select  Connect  from the  Start Menu on the VX6  Start   P
136. S  or other countries  and are used under license     Intel and Intel XScale are trademarks or registered trademarks of Intel Corporation or its subsidiaries in the United States and  other countries     RAMO and RAM Mount    are both trademarks of National Products Inc   1205 S  Orr Street  Seattle  WA  98108     The Cisco Square Bridge logo is a trademark of Cisco Systems  Inc   Aironet  Cisco and Cisco Systems are  registered trademarks of Cisco Systems  Inc  and or its affiliates in the United States and certain other countries     Summit Data Communications  Inc  Summit Data Communications  the Summit logo  and    The Pinnacle of  Performance    are trademarks of Summit Data Communications  Inc  All rights reserved     Symbol  the Symbol logo and Spectrum24 are registered trademarks of Symbol Technologies  Inc     The Bluetooth   word mark and logos are owned by the Bluetooth SIG  Inc  and any use of such marks by LXE   Inc  is under license     Wavelink   and Wavelink Avalanche   are registered trademarks and the Wavelink logo  tagline and Avalanche  MC are trademarks of Wavelink Corporation  Kirkland  WA     All other brand or product names are trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective companies or  organizations     When this manual is in PDF format     Acrobat   Reader   Copyright    2008 Adobe Systems Incorporated  All  rights reserved  Adobe    the Adobe logo  Acrobat    and the Acrobat logo are registered trademarks of Adobe  Systems Incorporated    
137. Scanner    for details     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    32    Hardware Configuration    Power Supply    Vehicle power input for the VX6 is 12V to 80V DC nominal and is accepted without the need to  perform any manual operation within the VX6     If 12V to 60V DC power is not available     for example  in an office environment     an optional  external Universal Input Power Supply can be used to convert AC wall power to an appropriate  DC level  See    External Power Supply     later in this chapter     Power input is fused for protection and the fuse is externally accessible     Uninterruptible Power Supply    A DC uninterruptible power supply  UPS  battery is available to maintain power to the VX6 for a  minimum of 15 minutes when vehicle power is not available  such as when a vehicle battery is  being swapped      Backup Battery    The LXE VX6 has a permanent lithium battery installed to maintain time and date  The backup  battery is not user serviceable and should last five years with normal use before it requires  replacement     Note  This battery should only be changed by authorized service personnel     PCMCIA Slots    CF Slot    SD Slot    Microsoft Windows CE Plug and Play operating system controls the PCMCIA cards  These cards  are hot swappable per the PCMCIA specifications     The CF ATA slot is not hot swappable  The VX6 must be powered down to insert or remove an  ATA card  Since the operating system is stored on the ATA card  the VX6 cannot operate  with
138. ScreenMode Exiting the function that switches the screen to full LOG PROCESSING  screen   Exit GetAppInfo Processing is at the end of the function that retrieved the   LOG PROCESSING  application information from the registry   Exit password dialog Exiting password prompt processing  LOG PROCESSING  Exit password dialog cancel Exiting password prompt w cancel  LOG PROCESSING  Exit password dialog OK Exiting password prompt successfully  LOG PROCESSING  E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide       334    Message    Exit password timeout    Explanation and or corrective action    Exiting password timeout processing     AppLock Error Messages    Level    LOG_PROCESSING       Exit restart app timer    Processing is at the end of the timer function    LOG_PROCESSING       Exit TaskbarScreenMode    Exiting the function that switches the screen mode back  to normal operation for the administrator     LOG_PROCESSING          Exit ToAdmin Exiting the function that handles the mode switch into LOG_PROCESSING  admin mode   Exit ToUser Exiting the user mode switch function  LOG_PROCESSING       Exit ToUser Registry read failure    The AppName value does not exist in the registry so  user mode cannot be entered     LOG_PROCESSING       Exit verify password no pwd set    Exiting password verification     LOG_PROCESSING       Exit verify password response from  dialog    Exiting password verification     LOG_PROCESSING       Found taskbar    The handle to the taskbar has been found so that  AppLo
139. Startup    Because copying these has no effect on the system or an incorrect effect     Files in the Startup folder are executed  but only from System Startup  Windows Startup is parsed  too early in the boot process so it has no effect     Executables in System Startup must be the actual executable  not a shortcut  because shortcuts are  not parsed by launch     My Computer Folders                            Folder Description Preserved upon Reboot   System Internal ATA Card Yes  Network Mounted network drive No  Storage Card PCMCIA No  Media Card SD No  Windows Operating System in ROM No  Program Files Applications No  Application Data   Data saved by running applications No  My Documents Storage for downloaded files   applications No  Temp Location for temporary files No                         VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Start Menu Program Options 299    Start Menu Program Options    The following options represent the factory default program installation  Your system may be  different based on the software and hardware options purchased     Access  Start   Programs    Cisco    Communication  ActiveSync  Connect  Start FTP Server  Stop FTP Server   Microsoft File Viewers  Excel Viewer  Image Viewer  PDF Viewer  Word Viewer   Summit    Command Prompt  Internet Explorer  Java   LXE RFTerm   Media Player  Microsoft WordPad    Remote Desktop Connection    Transcriber  Avalanche  Windows Explorer    Set Cisco radio   network parameters    Please see Chapter 5     Wirel
140. System   Device Name    The device name and description can be changed  Enter the name and description using either the  keypad or the Input Panel and tap OK to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     Copyrights    This screen is presented for information only  The Copyrights information cannot be changed by  the user     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 123    Terminal Server Client Licenses  Select a server client license from a drop down list    Not available at this release     Volume and Sounds    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Volume  amp  Sounds Icon    Set volume parameters and assign sound wav files to Windows CE events                                   Factory Default Settings   Volume   Events Enabled  Application Enabled  Notifications Enabled  Volume Middle of Bar  Key click Loud   Screen tap Loud   Sounds   Scheme LOUD                 Follow the instructions on the screen and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take  effect immediately        Volume  amp  Sounds Properties e OK  x     Volume   Sounds      a   Loud Enable sounds for   Events  warnings  beeps and system events     Applications  program specific and all other sounds       Notifications  alarms  appointments and reminders        Enable clicks and taps for      ER     Key clicks  O Loud   Soft        Screen taps  O Loud     Soft          Figure 3 37 Volume and Sounds    Wi Fi    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Wi Fi    Pr
141. The default password is SUMMIT     Note  The password is case sensitive   The Admin password can be changed on the Global tab   The end user can   e Turn radio On Off on the Main tab  e Select active Profile on the Main tab  e View the current parameter settings for the profiles on the Profile tab  e View the global parameter settings on the Global tab   e View the current connection details on the Status tab  e View the radio status  software versions and regulatory domain on the Main tab  e Access additional troubleshooting features on the Diags tab   After Admin login  the use can also   e Create  edit  rename and delete profiles on the Profile tab    e Edit global parameters on the Global tab     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 185    Auto Profile    Auto Profile allows the user to configure a list of profiles that the SCU can search when a radio  connection is lost  After using the Profile tab to create any desired profiles  return to the Main  tab  To specify which profiles are to be included in Auto Profile  click the List button             Auto Profile        Profile     SSIDO1     SsIDO2     ssIDO3     ssiDO4               Figure 5 4 Select Profiles for Auto Profile  The Auto Profile selection screen displays all currently configured profiles  Click on the  checkbox for any profiles that are to be included in Auto Profile selection then click OK to save   To enable Auto Profile  click the On button on the Main tab     When Auto Profile is On  if the
142. VX6 Reference Guide          Copyright O September 2008 by LXE Inc   All Rights Reserved  E EQ VX6RG J       Notices    Notice   LXE Inc  reserves the right to make improvements or changes in the products described in this manual at any time  without notice  While reasonable efforts have been made in the preparation of this document to assure its  accuracy  LXE assumes no liability resulting from any errors or omissions in this document  or from the use of the  information contained herein  Further  LXE Incorporated  reserves the right to revise this publication and to make  changes to it from time to time without any obligation to notify any person or organization of such revision or  changes     Copyright Notice   This manual is copyrighted  All rights are reserved  This document may not  in whole or in part  be copied   photocopied  reproduced  translated or reduced to any electronic medium or machine readable form without prior  consent  in writing  from LXE Inc     Copyright    2008 by LXE Inc  An EMS Technologies Company   125 Technology Parkway  Norcross  GA 30092 U S A   770  447 4224    Trademarks   LXE   is a registered trademark of LXE Inc  RFTerm   is a registered trademark of EMS Technologies  Norcross  GA   Microsoft  Windows and the Windows logo are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United  States and or other countries     Java   and Java based trademarks and logos are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun Microsystems  Inc  in  the U 
143. Vehicle Power Connection Cable  12 Ft      1  Vehicle Electrical  System    2  10Amp Slow  Blow Fuse    DC     DC     Vehicle Chassis  Red   White  Red  Black   8  Green                      DW   9    QU q   9    Figure 2 42 Connecting the Power Cable to the Vehicle    Note  Correct electrical polarity is required for safe and proper installation  Connecting the  cable to the VX6 with the polarity reversed will cause the VX6 s fuse to be blown  See the  following table for wire color coding specifics     Wiring color codes for LXE supplied DC input power cabling     Vehicle Supply Wire Color    12   80VDC  DC    Red with White Stripe  Return  DC    Red with Black Stripe  Vehicle Chassis  GND  Green    Figure 2 43 Vehicle Connection Wiring Color Codes    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    72    Power Supply    VX6 Input Power Specifications    Feature Specification   DC Input Voltage 12   80 VDC   Input Current 3 5 Amps   Input Fuse 10A Time Delay   Input Power Switch SPST 6 Amp 125VDC  Power Adapter Cable    LXE offers an adapter cable  part no  9000A077CBLPWRADPTR  to adapt certain VX1  VX2 or  VX4 DC power supplies to the VX6  Please read and follow all cautions in the    VX6 User   s  Guide    to determine if your present power supply can be used with the VX6           1  VX6 Connector    2  VX1 2 4 Power  Supply Connector    Figure 2 44 Power Adapter Cable  VX1 2 4 to VX6        gt     Caution     For use only with VX1 2 4 DC power cables with yellow colored cable contai
144. X6 is  mounted is in motion  This feature required a serial cable connection and is enabled  using the Scanner control panel  Please see    Screen Blanking    in Chapter 4     Scanner     for details     E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 103    Input Panel    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Input Panel    Select the current key   data input method        Factory Default Settings   Input Method Keyboard  Allow applications to Disabled  change input panel state  Keys Small keys  Use gestures Disabled    Input Panel Properties El    OK E    Input Panel  Current input method    lt eyboa                               To quickly switch input methods   tap the Input Panel arrow and then  tap the desired method from the       menu that appears         Allow applications to change the  input panel state          Figure 3 18 Input Panel Properties    Use this option to make the Soft Keyboard or the keypad primarily available when entering data   Selecting Keyboard enables both     The Input Panel is disabled by default  To enable the input panel  make sure the checkbox for     Allow applications to change input panel state    is checked and warmboot the VX6     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    104    Internet Options    Access     Control Panel Options    Start   Settings   Control Panel   Internet Options    settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     Set General  Connection  Security  Privacy  Advanced and Popups option
145. a 123  Pinout  Senal Cable for SyncbtOnizatiofi   iuier iieri or in edo 130  Avalanche Enabler Opere Sere ett iaa pcia 141    CONNECTION OPHANS msi diia 144  Execution Opticas  Ditnthed  cirio atan 145  Server Comact     pti io eri 146  Startup Shutdown O ptt Ons seria RE S EHE V OE HERI TIE IEEE UN REENE E 147  Scan Config ODUOD i e a park es idu Pee sends can E EErEE I 148  Window Display ODDS  inco cash mp RU bh rn o on rv Op HEUS 148  Application Shores rta ia ers 149  Adapter Options   Ne tWoL ira sands ia cose RETE etae 150    J VX6 Reference Guide    xvi    Figure 3 48  Figure 3 49  Figure 3 50  Figure 3 51  Figure 3 52  Figure 3 53  Figure 3 54  Figure 2 55  Figure 4 1  Figure 4 2  Figure 4 3  Figure 4 4  Figure 4 5  Figure 4 6  Figure 4 7  Figure 4 8  Figure 4 9  Figure 4 10  Figure 4 11  Figure 4 12  Figure 4 13  Figure 5 1  Figure 5 2  Figure 5 3  Figure 5 4  Figure 5 5  Figure 5 6  Figure 5 7  Figure 5 8  Figure 5 9  Figure 5 10  Figure 5 11  Figure 5 12  Figure 5 13  Figure 5 14  Figure 5 15  Figure 5 16  Figure 5 17  Figure 5 18  Figure 5 19  Figure 5 20  Figure 5 21  Figure 5 22  Figure 5 23  Figure 5 24  Figure 5 25  Figure 5 26  Figure 5 27  Figure 5 28  Figure 5 29  Figure 5 30  Figure 5 31  Figure 5 32  Figure 5 33  Figure 5 34    VX6 Reference       Table of Contents   Avalanche Network Profile Displayed    uscd ei D ere das 151  Manual Settings Properties Panel vincia rusia 152  Status Display iaaiuiie nei oie En ti iri aire ETUR EE PH EH debi vidi ads 15
146. a DSSS OFDM    1  2  5 5  6  9  11  12  18  24  36  48  54 Mbps          Bluetooth       VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Network Device Specifications    PCMCIA Cisco 2 4GHz Type Il    PCMCIA Symbol 11Mb 2 4GHz Type Il    E EQ VX6RG J    Bus Interface     Radio Frequencies     RF Data Rates    RF Power Level   Channels   Operating Temperature  Storage Temperature    Connectivity     Bus Interface    Radio Frequencies    RF Data Rates    RF Power Level   Channels   Operating Temperature  Storage Temperature    Connectivity     291          VX6 Reference Guide    292 Network Device Specifications    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Introduction    Appendix C VX6 CE  NET 4 2    There are several different aspects to the setup and configuration of the VX6  Many of the setup  and configuration settings are dependent upon the optional features such as hardware and software  installed on the unit  The examples found in this chapter are to be used as examples only  the  configuration of your specific VX6 computer may vary  The following sections provide a general  reference for the configuration of the VX6 and some of its optional features     Your VX6 operating system may be Windows CE  NET 4 2 or Windows CE 5 0  The VX6  operating system 1s displayed on the Desktop as Windows CE  NET or Windows CE  This is the  factory default value for the Desktop Display Background     This chapter presents information and procedures for Windows CE  NET 4 2 only  Windows CE  5 0 informatio
147. abeiec  apensac  dnes 250    Download CA Certificate  Srila e pet 250   B uUDIDEI P P EE 251  Import Cerificate P                         ET E 251  Browsing to Certificate Location    nire a ERREUR asa 252   Certificate Import Contato eio ore resa ree ERET lacada CR tg RA 252  Logon to Cettiiicate Authority salsa Rn OR v re RH o Toe bn 253  Certificate Services  Welcome SOM ici 253  Requesta Certificate SCreeM irc 254    VX6 Reference Guide    xviii Table of Contents  Figure 5 90 Advanced Certificate Request Screens  Gc aeciuscosi ir dei oe i etre as 254  Figute 95 91 Advanced Certificate Details      ea oii te a iia 259  Figure 3 92 Script Warnings  ioco em tin ilii m adosadas 256  Eipgure5 095 Senpt WI ii ao 256  icine 5 94  X entficate Issued einar EE E E bra OPERE ER OH EHI ORIE ER 257  Figure  3 95  Download Security Warte    acciri rtt rt pa n Og ety ty nts 257  lari feme NO quU aparcar 258  Figure 5 97  Import Cedar 258  Figure 5 98  Browsing to Cerificate LoGdtlOD  oia 259  Elite 9 99 Coca unitat ius un ELI cad 259  Figure 3 100  Private Key Not Presents  cor sse s chayensstih  ono oo toti o sara 260  Figure 5 101 Browsing to Private Key Looatloli    3 tr  s 260  Figure  5 102 Private Key Presentan tes aad ide Ge Ale lie 261  Figure 6 1 Multi Application Applian  ii otii Hopes e rer te e a AAR Eo aE abi CHEN RE Re ani meee 264  Pigute 6 2  Sisle App lication  AppLock aim ias 265  Eionre 6 3 Swate bpad MIU 2n eerte ie ro HROHPOBBIG ER DRE Or mr Eee 269  Figine 6 4 Appl
148. ad 150  Miu                                                      cis 153  ERE                             154    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    vili Table of Contents    CHAPTER 4 SCANNER 157  AAA eeu                                            157  Barcode Processing OVOIVIQM ssicciinirnn liarla ERE pad 157  Barcode nig cll iiie Be DIT 158   LUN ME E LS T a TES RSTNDRORC NEUEM 159  COM Port WIDE weed A dE 160  Barcode Tails 161  A E ERN 161  E M p p T                              162  Barcode   Symbology Sel EIER  uerius apii sisas 163  Stip Leading Trailing Controls ainia 165  Barcode Data Match Lista a a dass as 166  Barcode Data Edit Buttons  A aca 166   Match List Rules  i   167   Add Pre fig SUX Control  li A Roache 168  Barcode cul Char MabDITBon ducent HAM Hate Ute Teu ORON 169   WD EIN E RE LT mien ce tyet ha lead ah ears salees aaa 169  Barcode     Custom  deme ers ia 170  Control Code Replacement Examples ados 172  Barcode Processing EXAM ples   s0  2saccaseasaseasazidaasasaacaneaactsbasessaconsdasasbaanesasadsansasbesnesassanentioasanieacee 173  Length Based Barcode Stripping Liuius eue e san sup pa t EE pAR ER PRERER SR eR noo nina ERR PARERE IRA ERRP ME ne 174  Sor DNI TT                         176  ODEON GL moe oceans een d detta assets MED E DE MERI 177   CHAPTER 5 WiRELESS NETWORK CONFIGURATION 179  INTA cc 179  cp dnldicilo e m m m Ea En O eka O reinaan inii 180   Summit Client AA A 181  A A 181  Summit Iray iii al 182  Wireless Zero Config Utility and 
149. adjust the decibel level  Tap OK to save the    e None     No microphone  Use this setting when stereo headphones are attached to the    e Micl     Use this setting when a mono headset with microphone is attached to the    When checked   enabled  Input Boost provides increased sensitivity of the microphone by 20  dB  Input Boost can only be enabled after an Input type other than None is selected     110  Mixer  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Mixer Icon  Adjust the volume  record gain  and sidetone for microphone input   Factory Default Settings  Master Volume   0dB  Record Gain 22 5dB  Sidetone 12 0dB  Input None  Input Boost Disabled  Mixer  Master Volume Record Gain  ode  4  22 5d8  KA  46 5dB  MA Ode   6 0 dB 6 0 dB  settings   The following options are available for Input  device   device   e Bluetooth     Reserved for future use   VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 111    Mouse  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Mouse  Set the double click sensitivity for stylus taps on the touchscreen   MX3X VXC Options    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   MX3X VXC Options  Set options such as IP V6  time sync  touchscreen enable and CapsLock   It may be necessary to warmboot the VX6 after making desired changes  A pop up window  indicates if a warmboot is required   Communication    Options on this tab configure communication options for the VX6        MX3X VXC Options ki OK E        Enable TCP IP Version 6        Allow Remote Des
150. am Files Applications No  System Internal SD Flash Card  CAB file storage  Yes  Temp Location for temporary files No  Windows Operating System in Secure Storage No                         VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Start Menu Program Options 81    Start Menu Program Options    The following options represent the factory default program installation  Your system may be  different based on the software and hardware options purchased     Access  Start   Programs    Cisco    Communication  ActiveSync  Connect  Start FTP Server  Stop FTP Server   Microsoft File Viewers  Excel Viewer  Image Viewer  PDF Viewer  Word Viewer   Summit    Command Prompt  Internet Explorer  Java   LXE RFTerm   Media Player  Microsoft WordPad    Remote Desktop Connection    Transcriber  Avalanche  Windows Explorer    Set Cisco radio   network parameters    Please see Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration    for details   Stores Network communication options   Transfer files between a VX6 and a desktop computer  Run this command after setting up a connection  Begin connection to FTP server   End connection to FTP server   View downloaded files  see Note    View Excel 97 and newer documents   View BMP  JPEG and PNG images   View Adobe Acrobat documents   View Word 97 and newer documents and RTF files  Set Summit radio   network parameters    Please see Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration    for details   The command line interface in a separate window  Access web pages on the world 
151. ame and description can be changed  Enter the name and description using either the  keypad or the Input Panel and tap OK to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     Copyrights    This screen is presented for information only  The Copyrights information cannot be changed by  the user     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 327    Volume and Sounds    E EQ VX6RG J    Access     Start   Settings   Control Panel   Volume  amp  Sounds Icon    Set volume parameters and assign sound wav files to Windows CE events                                      Factory Default Settings   Volume   Events Enabled  Application Enabled  Notifications Enabled  Volume Middle of Bar  Key click Loud   Screen tap Loud   Sounds   Scheme LOUD              Follow the instructions on the screen and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take  effect immediately        Volume  amp  Sounds Properties         Foxy x     Loud Enable sounds for   Events  warnings  beeps and system events   Applications  program specific and all other sounds       Notifications  alarms  appointments and reminders     Enable clicks and taps for       Key clicks  O Loud      Screen taps  Q Loud         Soft    Soft       Figure C 25 Volume and Sounds    VX6 Reference Guide    328 Control Panel Options    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Appendix D Reference Material    Introduction    Contents of this Appendix include   e AppLock Error Messages and Registry Settings  e Revision 
152. and 5 Connections  RJ45  Pins 7 and 8 Connections  USB Power  Current Limited  Not Connected   Not Connected   Transmit       Transmit      Chassis Ground    VX6 Reference Guide    42    Ethernet USB Dongle Cables    The available dongle cables are shown below     Q          6       9000A075CBLUSBHCETH               9000A071CBLD15USBETH    Figure 2 9 VX6 Ethernet USB Dongle Cables    External Connectors    D15 Connector  RJ45 Connector    USB Host  Connector    USB Client  Connector    D15 Connector  RJ45 Connector    USB Host  Connector    Note  Power the VX6 off before attaching a cable or device to the Ethernet USB connector     The connectors and pinouts for the dongle cables are detailed below        VX6           A 9000A075CBLUSBHCETH is required when using ActiveSync via USB on the          VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors    D15 Female Connector    Pinout    Pin    VD 0 1 OQ th d   U Nel    Rh  e a   e  e    nA A U N     C    Shell    10  15    Signal  USB2N_A    RXP  RXN  USB2P_A  DGND    RJA5 45  RJA5 78  5V USB 23    TXN  TXP  CGND    43       Figure 2 10 D15 Female Connector    Description   USB H D       Not Connected   USB D Power   Receive     Receive       USB H D     USB H Power Return   USB D D       RJ45  Pins 4 and 5 Connections  RJ45  Pins 7 and 8 Connections  USB H Power  Current Limited  USB D Power Return   USB D D     Transmit       Transmit      Chassis Ground    VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    44 External Connectors 
153. anged by the user     Memory sizes given do not include memory used up by the operating system  Hence  a system  with 64 MB may only report 35 MB memory  since 29 MB is used up by the Windows CE  operating system  This is actual DRAM memory  and does not include internal flash or the  internal ATA card used for storage     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    326 Control Panel Options    Memory    System Properties      General   Memory   Copyrights    Move slider to the left for more memory to run programs  Move slider to  the right for more storage room  Only unused RAM can be adjusted     Storage LEDITOCECKEUCOLEOHCOCUBIGOETUCPBECPCDETOCEHCCHGUCORELOCEDCEREDCERGEBODELUCEDCERUSU Program  Memory Eoo        M Memory    Allocated 11892KB Allocated 24152KB  In Use 1280KB In Use 8020KB       Figure C 23 System   Memory    Move the slider to allocate more memory for programs or storage  If there isn   t enough space for a  file  increase the amount of storage memory  If the VX6 is running slowly  try increasing the  amount of program memory  Adjust the settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The  changes take effect immediately     Device Name    System Properties      General   Memory   Device Name   Copyrights    These settings are used to identify your Windows CE device to  other computers     Please type a name  without any spaces  and a short description     Device name   vxcoo1  Device description   LXE VXC       Figure C 24 System   Device Name    The device n
154. anges to the Transcriber  application  enable or disable the current Transcriber session  etc   click the    hand with a pen     icon in the toolbar  Click the         button or the Help button to access Transcriber Help     Windows Explorer    Access  Start   Programs   Windows Explorer    There are a few changes in the Windows CE version of Windows Explorer as it relates to the  general desktop PC Windows Explorer options  Click the         button to access Windows Explorer  Help     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    304    Taskbar    Start Menu Program Options    Access  Start   Settings   Taskbar and Start Menu       Factory Default Settings   Always on Top Enabled  Auto hide Disabled  Show Clock Enabled                         There are a few changes in the Windows CE version of Taskbar as it relates to the general desktop  PC Windows Taskbar options     When the taskbar is auto hidden  press the Ctrl key then the Esc key to make the Start button  appear                Taskbar and Start Menu Properties    General   advanced      Always on top      Auto hide  Show Clock               Figure C 2 Taskbar Properties    Advanced Tab    Expand Control Panel   Tap the checkbox to have the Control Panel folders appear in drop down menu format from the  Settings   Control Panel menu option    Clear Contents of Document Folder    Tap the Clear button to remove the contents of the Document folder     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 305    Control Panel O
155. ap the Network Connected icon in the  Toolbar     Select a User Certificate    1     eeu d  pes qa    Select Wireless Information Tab   Select a network by double tapping the network name    In the IEEE 802 1X Authentication box  enable 802 1X authentication   Select an EAP type   Tap the Properties button  Validate Server is enabled by default    At the Authentication Settings display  tap the Select button to choose a User Certificate     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 249    Certificates    Root Certificates    Generating a Root CA Certificate       Ea Please refer to the    LXE Security Primer    for more information on obtaining and  installing root certificates                 The easiest way to get the root CA certificate is to use a browser on a PC to navigate to the CA   To request the root CA certificate  open a browser to    http    lt CA IP address gt  certsrv     Sign into the CA with any valid username and password          C       onnect to 100 100 100 100 21x     Connecting to 100 100 100 100  User name   a y  5  Password          Remember my password    x   coma      Figure 5 79 Logon to Certificate Authority       Microsoft Certificat es    johndoe    Welcome    Use this Web site to request a certificate for your Web browser  e mail client  or other program  By  Using a certificate  you can verify your identity to people you communicate with over the Web  sign and    encrypt messages  and  depending upon the type of certificate you request 
156. application launch will be retried if a failure  occurs when the application is automatically launched at bootup  Valid values are between 0  no  tries  and 99 tries or  1 for infinite  Infinite tries ends when the application successfully launches   The default is O retries     Auto At Boot Delay timer is the time that AppLock waits prior to the initial launch of the selected  application when it is automatically launched at bootup  Delay default is 10 seconds  Valid values  are between 0 seconds  no delay  and 999 seconds     The Auto At Boot delay is associated for each application  it will be either a value specified by the  Administrator or it will be the delay default value  At startup  when a delay has been assigned for  each application  AppLock waits for the delay associated with the first application to expire before  launching the first application then AppLock waits for the delay associated with the second  application to expire before launching the second application  AppLock continues in this manner  until all applications are launched     Note  A  Global Delay    can be accomplished by setting a timed delay for the first application    to be launched  by lowest Order number  and no delay  0 seconds  for all other  applications     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    274    Application Configuration    Auto Re Launch    Default is Enabled  Auto Re Launch  when enabled for a specific application  automatically re   launches 1t  subject to the specified Auto Re La
157. arameters configured set the EAP type to Cisco PEAP as shown below     Wireless Network Properties    Network name  SSID   IpeapTest         This is a computer to computer  ad hoc     Wireless network key  WEP   This network requires a key for     Encryption   TKIP y   Authentication   we A  y      network  wireless access points are not used    Network key    Key index  fr Key provided automatically    IEEE 802 1X Authentication  Enable 802 1X authentication on this network    EAP type   Cisco PEAP y     Figure 5 50 PEAP GTC Wireless Network Properties       If the EAP type box text is not exactly as shown see    Installing Radio Drivers     earlier in this  chapter  to change the radio cab file     Click the Properties button     PEAP Properties        Validate server certificate     Connect only if server name ends in     Trusted root certificate       Connect only if server is signed by  specified trusted root CA    Always try to resume secure session     Figure 5 51 PEAP Properties       When first configuring and authenticating  do not validate the server certificate  This allows the  user authentication to be tested  When user authentication is successful  return to this screen and  validate the server certificate as shown later in this section     Check the Always try to resume secure session box     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 233  Note  This box must be checked for the LXE device to roam from one AP to another AP   Click the OK button     The log
158. ast barcode is scanned  the settings are automatically applied           Configuring settings       Please Wait          Figure 2 55 Configuring Settings    8  Once configured  the device is warmbooted and the new settings are active     9  If Wavelink Avalanche is deployed and the appropriate network settings are configured  the  device connects to the Mobile Device Server and any software updates and additional  configuration data are downloaded     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Chapter 4 Scanner    Introduction    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner    Set scanner keyboard wedge parameters  enable or disable symbologies from being scanned   scanner icon appearance  active scanner port  and scan key settings  Assign baud rate  parity  stop  bits and data bits for available COM ports     Barcode Processing Overview    Note  Steps 1 6 describe the barcode manipulation  Steps 7 11 describe how the manipulated  data is built  Step 12 describes how the manipulated data is output     The complete sequence of barcode processing is as follows     1 Scanned barcode is tested for a code ID and matching length  Min Max   If it matches  it  is processed per the rules in place for that symbology  If the scan does not meet the  criteria for that symbology  it will be processed based on the settings for All  Ifa code ID  is not found  the barcode data will be processed based on the settings for All    2 If symbology is disabled  the scan is rejected    3 Strip leading
159. ates             Figure 5 85 Browsing to Certificate Location    Using the explorer buttons  browse to the location where you copied the certificate  select the  certificate desired and click OK         Root Certificate Store    Do you want to ADD the following certificate to the Root Store         Subject   doe  SUPPORT  LOCAL   Issuer   Self Issued   Time Validity   Thursday  July 01  2004 through Tuesday  July 01  2014  Serial Number   12345678 SOABCDEF 12345678 90ABCDEF    Figure 5 86 Certificate Import Confirmation       Click Yes to import the certificate     Once the certificate is installed  return to the proper authentication section  earlier in this manual     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 253    User Certificates  User certificates are only needed for EAP TLS     Generating a User Certificate       LL Please refer to the    LXE Security Primer  for more information on obtaining and  installing user certificates                 The easiest way to get the user certificate is to use a browser on a PC to navigate to the CA  To  request the user certificate  open a browser to    http    lt CA IP address gt  certsrv     Sign into the CA with the username and password of the person who will be logging into the  mobile device     Connect to 100 100 100 100 BE       Connecting to 100 100 100 100    were  8 rz  Password        T Remember my password           OK   Cancel    Figure 5 87 Logon to Certificate Authority  This process saves a user certificate a
160. changes to   once auto launch installs the file  FileCheck is the name of a file to look for to determine if the CAB file is installed     The value in FileCheck is the name of one of the files  with path  installed by the CAB file  Since  the CAB file installs into DRAM  when memory is lost this file is lost  and the CAB file must be  reinstalled     Three optional fields are also added  Order  Delay  and PCMCIA  These are all DWORD fields   described below     The auto launch process goes as follows  The launch utility opens the registry database and reads  the list of CAB files to auto launch  First it looks for FileName to see if the CAB file is present  If  not  the registry entry is ignored  If it is present  and the Installed flag is not set  auto launch  makes a copy of the CAB file  since it gets deleted by installation   and runs the Microsoft utility  WCELOAD to install it  If the Installed flag is set  auto launch looks for the FileCheck file  If it  is present  the CAB file is installed  and that registry entry is complete  If the FileCheck file is not  present  memory has been lost  and the utility calls WCELOAD to reinstall the CAB file  Then   the whole process repeats for the next entry in the registry  until all registry entries are analyzed     To force execution every time  for example  for AUTOEXEC BAT   use a FileCheck of     dummy     which will never be found  forcing the item to execute     For persist keys specifying  EXE or  BAT files  the executing
161. ck can disable it in user mode     LOG_PROCESSING       Getting address of keyboard hook  init procedure    AppLock is retrieving the address of the keyboard hook     LOG_PROCESSING       Getting configuration from registry    The AppLock configuration is being read from the  registry  This occurs at initialization and also at entry  into user mode  The registry must be re read at entry  into user mode in case the administration changed the  settings of the application being controlled           LOG_PROCESSING                         Getting encrypt pwd length The length of the encrypted password is being LOG_EX  calculated    Hook wndproc failure AppLock is unable to lock the application  This could LOG_ERROR  happen if the application being locked encountered an  error after performing its initialization and shut itself  down prior to being locked by AppLock    Hook wndproc of open app failure The application is open  but AppLock cannot lock it  LOG_ERROR   Hot key event creation failure The Admin applet is unable to create the hotkey LOG_ERROR  notification    Hot key pressed Processing the hotkey and backdoor entry LOG_EX   Hot key pressed Processing the hotkey and backdoor entry LOG_EX   Hot key set event failure When the administrator changes the hotkey LOG_ERROR    configuration the hotkey controller must be notified   This notification failed        Hotkey press message received          The user just pressed the configured hotkey        LOG_PROCESSING       VX6 Refer
162. d  Not Used  Not Used  Not Used  Not Used   No signal when in motion    Continuity to Pin 8 when stopped                                  AID AH Aaju ij        8 No signal when in motion   Continuity to Pin 7 when stopped    9 Not Used                   Figure 2 6 Pinout     Screen Blanking Cable       Pin T    Figure 2 7 Sample Cable for Screen Blanking       Please refer to Chapter 4     Scanner     for the proper COM port settings to support screen blanking     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors    Ethernet USB Connector    The VX6 Ethernet USB connector accepts dongle cables that provide combinations of the  following connections     Note     41    an Ethernet port  via an RJ45 connector    a USB Host port for connecting a USB device to the VX6  a USB Client port to connect the VX6 to a USB host or hub     Please refer to the diagrams later in this chapter for details on available ports with the  dongle cable options     The connector is shown below        5  10  15       Figure 2 8 VX6 USB Connector and External USB Adapter Cable Connector    Note     Pinout    E EQ VX6RG J    Pin    VD 00  1 O0 t BR WN        Rh    e a    nA A W N     O    Shell    Signal  USB2N_A    USB2P_A  DGND  RJA5 45  RJA5 78  5V USB 23    TXN  TXP  CGND    Power the VX6 off before attaching a cable or device to the Ethernet USB connector     Description   USBD    Not Connected   Not Connected   Receive     Receive       USBD    USB Power Return   Not Connected   RJ45  Pins 4 
163. d  and other beeps from  the VX6 during final barcode data manipulation     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    34    Power Modes    Power Modes    The VX6 has several distinct power modes     VX6 Reference Guide    On Mode   When the VX6 is attached to either vehicle 12 80 VDC or an external  power supply and the power button is pressed  the VX6 is in the On mode  In this  mode  the keypad  touchscreen and any attached peripherals such as a scanner  function normally  The display remains on until the backlight timer  if enabled   expires     User Idle Mode     If the Display Backlight Timer is enabled  see the Display section  in the Windows CE Control panel   the VX6 enters User Idle Mode when the display  backlight timer expires without any Primary Event  see below  to reset the timer   The VX6 exits User Idle Mode with any Primary Event  The keypress or screen  touch that exits User Idle Mode is sent to the operating system  The VX6 then  transitions to On Mode     Primary Events                      Any key on the keypad COMI activity   Stylus touch on the touchscreen   Scanner activity  Power button tap USB client connection  Bluetooth device reconnect   disconnect message          System Idle Mode     The VX6 does not support System Idle mode     Suspend Mode     TheV X6 does not support Suspend mode  However  if the  Suspend timer is enabled  the VX6 transitions to Off mode when the Suspend timer  expires     Off Mode     The VX6 turns off if the user presses the powe
164. d directory path  of up to 64 characters  where Root CA certificates for EAP authentication   PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC  EAP TLS  and manual PACs for EAP TLS are stored     The Windows certificate store can also be used to store Root CA certificates  User certificates   EAP TLS  must be stored in the Windows certificate store     LXE suggests ensuring the directory path currently exists before assigning the path in this  parameter  For example  if the certificate is stored in My Computer System mycertificate cer   enter System in the Certs Path text box as the directory path     Default  System   Ping Payload   Maximum amount of data to be transmitted on a ping   Options  32  64  128  256  512  1024 bytes  Default  32    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    198 Summit Radio    Ping Timeout ms    The amount of time  in milliseconds  that a device will be continuously pinged  The Stop Ping  button can be tapped to end the ping process ahead of the ping timeout     Options  0 to 30 000 ms  Default  5000    Ping Delay ms   The amount of time  specified in milliseconds  between each ping   Options  0 to 30 000 ms  Default  1000    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    199    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials    When using wireless security that requires a user name and password to be entered  the Summit  Client Utility offers two choices     e The Username and Password may be entered on the Credentials screen  If this  method is selected  anyone using the device can access t
165. device  LXE recommends  changing and then saving the changes  reboot  before connecting to the network     Alternatively  the Mobile Device Server on the Wavelink Avalanche Management Console can be  disabled until needed  refer to the Wavelink Avalanche Mobility Center User s Guide for details      Menu Options             Settings Tab Function   Connection Enter the IP Address or host name of the Mobile Device Server portion  of the Avalanche Management Console  Set the order in which serial  ports or RF are used to check for the presence of the Mobile Device  Server    Execution Unavailable in this release  LXE recommends using AppLock  which is    resident on each Windows mobile device        Server Contact    Setup synchronization  scheduled Mobile Device Server contact  suspend  and reboot settings                             Startup Shutdown   Set options for Enabler program startup or shutdown    Scan Config This option allows the user to configure Enabler settings using a special  barcode that is created by the Avalanche Mobility Center Console  Not  currently supported by LXE    Display Set up the Windows display at startup  on connect and during normal  mode  The settings can be adjusted by the user    Shortcuts Add  delete and update shortcuts to user allowable applications    Adapters Enable or disable network and wireless settings  Select an adapter and  switch between the Avalanche Network Profile and manual settings    Status View the current adapter signal st
166. display notifying the user the connection between one  or all  of  the paired Bluetooth devices has stopped  This option is enabled by default     Click the OK button or the X button to remove the dialog box from the screen     Report when reconnected    A dialog box appears on the VX6 display notifying the user a connection between one  or all  of  the previously paired Bluetooth devices is complete  This option is disabled by default     Click the OK button or the X button to remove the dialog box from the screen     Report failure to reconnect    If the reconnect timeout  30 minutes  expires  a dialog box appears on the VX6 display notifying  the end user the connection between one  or all  of the previously paired Bluetooth devices has  failed  This option is enabled by default     Click the OK button to remove the dialog box from the screen     Computer is connectable    There is no dialog connected to this checkbox  Enable this checkbox when you want the VX6 to  be able to pair with other Bluetooth devices  This option is enabled by default     Computer is discoverable    There is no dialog connected to this checkbox  Enable this checkbox when you want the VX6 to  be Discovered by other Bluetooth devices  This option is disabled by default     Prompt if devices request to pair    A dialog box appears on the VX6 screen notifying the user a Bluetooth device requests to pair  with the VX6  This option is disabled by default     The requesting Bluetooth device does not need
167. dmin is familiar with the  pairing function of the Bluetooth devices     LXEZ Pairing      OK E    Bluetooth Address                     Bluetooth Devices          Discover       Figure 1 12 Bluetooth Devices Display     Before Discovering Devices    1  Select Start   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth or tap the Bluetooth icon in the taskbar or  on the desktop     2  Tap the Settings Tab     3  Change the Computer Friendly Name at the bottom of the Settings display  The Bluetooth  VX6 default name is determined by the LXE factory installed software version  LXE strongly  urges assigning every VX6 a unique name  up to 32 characters  before Bluetooth Discovery  is initiated    4  Check or uncheck the VX6 Bluetooth options on the Settings tab    5  Tap the OK button to save your changes or the X button to discard any changes     See Also  Chapter 3     System Configuration  section titled Bluetooth     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    18 Bluetooth    Settings Tab   Bluetooth Options  Note  These options can still be checked or unchecked whether Bluetooth connection is enabled  or disabled     As Bluetooth devices pair with the VX6  the name of the device and an icon representing the type  of device is displayed in the Devices window  The icon state changes as the paired Bluetooth  devices connect and disconnect from the VX6  When the Bluetooth devices are disconnected  the  device icon has a red background     Report when connection lost    A dialog box appears on the VX6 
168. e    152 Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration       Manual Settings Properties    Network  DNS   Wireless     Manage network settings     O  Use server assigned IP address  O Use the following IP address     IP  Subnet     Gateway        Network       Manual Settings Properties     Network   DNS   Wireless   _     Y  Manage network    These addresses may be re assigned if DHCP is enabled     DNS 1    DNS 2     DNS 3     Domain          DNS       Manual Settings Properties     Network DNS  vires      Manage wireless settings    SSID     Encryption   Open System  None  y        Wireless    Figure 3 49 Manual Settings Properties Panels    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 153    For descriptions of these Enabler parameters  refer to Chapter 5    Wireless Network  Configuration        LXE does not recommend enabling    Manage Wireless Settings    for Summit Client devices     When you download a profile that is configured to manage network and wireless settings  the  Enabler will not apply the manage network and wireless settings to the adapter unless the global  Manage wireless settings and Manage network settings options are enabled on the Adapters  panel  see Figure titled Adapters Options     Network      Until these options are enabled  the network and wireless settings are controlled by the third party  software associated with these settings     Status    The Status panel displays the current status of the mobile device networ
169. e    50 External Connectors    Antenna Connections  Note    VX6 s are equipped with a radio and require an either an external or an internal    antenna  Some VX6   s may be equipped with a dual antenna option  For these VX6   s  an  external antenna must be connected to each antenna connector     1  Antenna    2  Antenna Connector          Figure 2 20 External Antenna    Spread Spectrum RF Antenna Connector Pin    VX6   s ordered with an external antenna option have either one or two antenna connectors located  on top of the unit  VX6 s ordered with the internal antenna option do not have an external  antenna connector        Figure 2 21 RF Antenna SS Connector    Vehicle Remote Antenna Mount    The external antenna  or antennas  can be remotely mounted on the vehicle  Please refer to the     Vehicle Remote Mount Antenna Installation Sheet  for details     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors 51    Internal Antenna    If the internal antenna option is ordered  an antenna is mounted on the inside of the user access  panel cover        Figure 2 22 Internal Antenna Cables    The internal antenna assembly has two antenna cables which are attached to the radio card     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    52 The QWERTY Keyboard    The QWERTY Keyboard    The VX6 has a QWERTY keyboard  available with a standard overlay  an IBM 3270 overlay or  an IBM 5250 overlay  These keyboards have 101 keyboard functions  including a numeric  keypad  Please refer to Appendix A  
170. e Coldboot and tap the OK button  factory default registry  settings are loaded during coldboot  All changes and settings are lost     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Getting Help    Getting Help    25    All LXE manuals are now available on one CD and they can also be viewed downloaded  from the LXE website  Contact your LXE representative to obtain the LXE Manuals CD     You can also get help from LXE by calling the telephone numbers listed on the LXE Manuals  CD  in the file titled    Contacting LXE     This information is also available on the LXE website    www lxe com     Explanations of terms and acronyms used in this guide are located in the file titled    Glossary    on    the LXE Manuals CD     Manuals and Accessories    Manuals    Accessories    The following manuals are available on the LXE Manuals CD     VX6 User   s Guide  RFTerm    Reference Guide  Contacting LXE   LXE Technical Glossary    The table below lists the available VX6 accessories     e Where two parts numbers are listed for a given part  the part number ending in     R       is the RoHS compliant version     e When only one part number is listed  the part is RoHS compliant unless otherwise    noted     VX6 Brackets   Bracket  U Style  VX6 VX77   Kit  VXX U Bracket to VX6 VX7 Adapter   Bracket  RAM Mount VX6 VX7   Bracket  VXX RAM ball on plate   Bracket  RAM Squeeze Mount  VX6 VX7   Bracket  RAM Backup Mounting Plate   Data Cables   Cable  Combo D15 to USB and Ethernet Adapter 1 Ft  Cable  Combo
171. e Symbology selected in the Symbologies dialog defines the symbology for which the data is  being configured  The features available on the Symbology Settings dialog include the ability to  individually enable or disable a barcode from scanning  set the minimum and maximum size  barcode to accept  strip Code ID  strip data from the beginning or end of a barcode  or  based on  configurable Barcode Data  add a prefix or suffix to a barcode     The Symbology drop down list contains all symbologies supported on the VX6  An asterisk  appears in front of symbologies that have already been configured or have been modified from the  default value     Each time a Symbology is changed  the settings are saved as soon as the OK button is tapped   Settings are also saved when a new Symbology is selected from the Symbology drop down list        Symbology  fan y  Strip  Enable Min  fi Max  fal  Leading f       Trailing        V  Code ID   Barcode Data             Figure 4 4 Barcode Tab     Symbology Settings    Clear This button will erase any programmed overrides  returning to the default settings for the  selected symbology  If Clear is pressed when All is selected as the symbology  a  confirmation dialog appears  then all symbologies are reset to their factory defaults  and  all star     indications are removed from the list of Symbologies     The order in which these settings are processed are     e Code ID  e Leading   Trailing  e Barcode Data    Note  When Enable Code ID is set to Non
172. e Update Settings    OK E    Startup Shutdown   Scan Config Shortcuts          Figure 3 46 Application Shortcuts    Configure shortcuts to other applications on the mobile device  Shortcuts are viewed and activated  in the Programs panel  This limits the user   s access to certain applications when the Enabler is  controlling the mobile device display     LXE recommends using LXE AppLock for this function  See Chapter 6    AppLock    for  instruction     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    150    Adapters    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    Note  LXE recommends the user review the network settings configuration utilities and the  default values in Chapter 5 before setting All Adapters to Enable in the Adapters applet                    Avalanche Update Settings OK Fl      Scan Config   Display   Shortcuts   Adapters no    All Adapters    Manage Network     Manage Wireless      Current Adapter     soccr 1061        Primary   Use Avalanche Network Profile A     adapter  E O Use Manual Settings       Figure 3 47 Adapter Options     Network       Manage Network  Setting    When enabled  the Enabler will control the network settings  This  parameter cannot be configured from the Avalanche Mobility Center  Console and is enabled by default        Manage Wireless    When enabled  the Enabler will control the wireless settings  This          Settings parameter cannot be configured from the Avalanche Mobility Center  Console and is disabled by default  This parameter settin
173. e a single  application to lock and the end user is limited to that application           Administrator Control E  OK A  Control   Security   Status      Application       I  Internet       Command Line     rere              Application Startup Delay   fio seconds             Figure 6 2 Single Application AppLock    Though this chapter is designed for users of the newer Multi Application AppLock  the  instructions may also be used to configure Single Application AppLock with the following  differences     E EQ VX6RG J    The Control tab is used to specify the application to lock instead of the Application tab   While the Application tab contains provisions for multiple applications  the Control tab  only allows the administrator to specify a single application     The section on End User Switching Technique does not apply to this version     Some configuration items may not be available     VX6 Reference Guide    266    Setup a New Device    Setup a New Device    LXE devices with the AppLock feature are shipped to boot in Administration mode with no  default password  thus when the device is first booted  the user has full access to the device and no  password prompt is displayed  After the administrator specifies the applications to lock  a  password is assigned and the device is rebooted or the hotkey is pressed  the device switches to  end user mode     Briefly  the process to configure a new device is as follows     T     2  3   4    O wc 0 p UA    Connect an external pow
174. e are noted in the Language section of this tab   e English only     No additional fonts are built into the OS  e Japanese  e Simplified Chinese  e Traditional Chinese  e Korean    The above listed Asian fonts are ordered separately and built in to the VX6 OS image  Built in  fonts are added to registry entries and are available immediately upon startup  Thai  Hebrew   Arabic and Cyrillic Russian fonts are available in the  English only  default  extended  fonts     When an Asian font is copied into the fonts folder on the  System folder  the font works for Asian  web pages  the font works with RFTerm  the font does not work for Asian options in Regional  Settings control panel  the font does not work for naming desktop icons with Asian names  the  font does not work for third party  NET applications  the font does not work for some third party  MFC applications     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    308 Control Panel Options    Identifying Software Versions    The    Versions    tab displays the versions of many of the software programs installed  Not all  installed software installed on the VX6 is included in this list and the list varies depending on the  applications loaded on the VX6  The LXE Image line displays the revision of the system software  installed  Please refer to the last three digits to determine the revision level  i e   in the example  below  the revision level is 2BT         About OK E    Software   Hardware Versions   Network IP                  LXE CF 
175. e on the Barcode tab and when All is selected in the  Symbology field  Enable and Strip Code ID on the Symbology panel are grayed and the  user is not allowed to change them  to prevent deactivating the scanner completely     When All is selected in the Symbology field and the settings are changed  the settings in this  dialog become the defaults  used unless overwritten by the settings for individual symbologies   This is also true for Custom IDs  where the code IDs to be stripped are specified by the user     Note  In Custom mode on the Barcode tab  any Code IDs not specified by the user will not be  stripped  because they will not be recognized as code IDs     If a specific symbology   s settings have been configured  a star     will appear next to it in the  Symbology drop down box  so the user can tell which symbologies have been modified from their  defaults  If a particular symbology has been configured  the entire set of parameters from that  symbologies screen are in effect for that symbology  In other words  either the settings for the  configured symbology will be used  or the default settings are used  not a combination of the two   If a symbology has not been configured  does not have an   next to it  the settings for    All    are    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    Barcode Manipulation    used which are not necessarily the defaults        This checkbox enables  checked  or disables  unchecked  the symbology field     The scanner driver searches the beginning
176. e password before entering administration mode  The    271    password prompt remains on the display until a valid password is entered        Option    Explanation       Filename    Default is blank  Move the cursor to the Filename text box and either type  the application path or tap the Browse button  the     button   The standard  Windows CE Browse dialog is displayed  After selecting the application  from the Browse dialog  tap OK        Title    Default is blank  Enter the Title to be associated with the application  The  assumption is that multiple copies of the same application may need unique  titles in order to differentiate them in the application switcher panel        Arguments    Default is blank  Enter the command line parameters for the application in  the Arguments text box        Order    Default is 1  Enter the Order in which the application is to be loaded or  presented to the end user  Applications are launched in lowest to highest  number order        Internet    Default is Disabled  Enable the Internet checkbox to use the End user  Internet Explorer  EUIE EXE  When the checkbox is enabled  the Internet  Menu and Internet Status are available  See the section titled End user  Internet Explorer  EUIE  for more details        Launch Button    See following section titled Launch Button     Note    AppLock Administrator Control panel file Launch option does not  inter relate with similarly named options contained in other LXE    Control Panels        Global Ke
177. e the results of the diagnostics to a text file  Use the  explorer window to specify the name and location for the diagnostic file  The text  file can viewed using an application such as WordPad     E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 193                  Global Tab  Note  The Global tab was previously labeled Global Settings   The parameters on the global settings tab can be changed when an Admin is logged on  Without  the admin login  the current values for the parameters can be viewed  but they cannot be edited   Summit Client Utility i  foki x  Main   Profile   Global  Property  Value  uti    f SDC  Roam Trigger   65 dBm    Roam Delta  Roam Period i   i j i  BG Channel Set E M big setting will require a  Annressive Scan i  Save Change  Figure 5 9 SCU   Global Tab  Parameters    IMPORTANT     Remember to click the Commit button after making changes to ensure the  changes are saved  Many versions of the SCU display a reminder if the Commit button is  not clicked before an attempt it made to close or browse away from the Global tab if  there are unsaved changes     Note    Custom parameter options  Some parameters contain an option for custom  The  parameter s value is displayed as    Custom    when the operating system registry has  been used to set the parameter to a value not available from the Global settings  parameter options  Selecting Custom for a parameter has no effect as the parameter  value returns to the previously selected value when you press Commit     Roam Trigger 
178. e user must configure and append the Symbology ID as a prefix  See the  documentation provided with the scanner for details           COMG port is labeled    COM2 3        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation 159    Main Tab    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner   Main       Scanner Control fa OK ES    Main   comi   coma   Barcode    Port 2            disabled O Bluetooth O disabled   O comi O coma   comi O coma   O comi serctl    COM3 ScrCtl O coM1 serctl    coms ScrCtl      Output Enable C  Output Enable   C  Power Port 1 while asleep Send Key Messages  WEDGE    Enable Internal Scanner Sound 3000 On Delay Ms          Figure 4 1 Scanner Control   Main Tab    Adjust the settings and tap the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     When Power Port 1 while asleep is checked  whichever serial port is enabled as Port 1 will  remain powered while the device is in Suspend  This allows a tethered scanner to wake the device  by pressing the trigger on the scanner     When Send Key Messages  WEDGE  is checked any data scan is converted to keystrokes and  sent to the active window  When this box is not checked  the application will need to use the set of  LXE Scanner APIs to retrieve the data from the scanner driver  Note that this latter method is  significantly faster than using    Wedge     Even if Send Key Messages is enabled     key mode      the  data is still available using the scanner APIs     block mode      When 
179. eSync                eese 39  130  Serial Connector   coocoooccnononccononancnonancnccnonnanonnnanos 37  38  Set the double click sensitivity for stylus taps      111   317  Setup  ADDLOCE iiit iue i ires 263  Show Clock                 seen 86  304  Single Application AppLock                               265  Slot 0  Left   iet rette perti tent 61  Slot 1  Right     eee temet tenis 61  Soft Keyboard             eee 103 314  Software and Files                         ssuss 76  131  294  Software Load   ocooooccconnoncccnononccononnnncononnnncnnnnnos 76  294  Software Revision               sssssseseeereee 29  Speaker Jack  Location    6 8  Speaker Volume Control Keys                                56  Speaker Beeper  Location    6 8  Specifications  Audio Connector               essere 46  DiSpl  y iii 289  Environmental                      esee 288  Input POWSGE      seo erede etre Ere inis 72  TN A idee 287  Power ComNeCtOT  oooonccnccnocnconnconoconccnnocanonnnonnninnos 47  USB Connector    eene intente een enne 41  Start Meri  ER 81  299  Static IP Address   coooooconoccccnonoccnononcnonnonanononoss 113 317  Status LED Indicator                         sse 54  Status Panel  Applock A tenerae 278  Stop Bits umi nai 119  157  323  Storage Manager  dC o id 323  Storage Temperature  Specifications                       288  Stored certificates     ooooonooccccnnocnnroonaccononanaronns 100  310  Strip Cod   Diccionari cette tenus 170  Strip leading and trailing              
180. ease note that Scroll Lock key does not produce a sound as  the CapsLock and NumLock keys do  This is due to a limitation in the Microsoft Windows CE  operating system     Accessibility E OK E    Keyboard   Sound Display   Mouse   General          Use SoundSentry if you want Windows to generate  visual warnings when your system makes a sound         Use SoundSentry          Figure C 7 Accessibility Properties  Sound  If the SoundSentry option is selected  please note that Scroll Lock does not produce a visual    warning as the CapsLock and NumLock keys do  This is due to a limitation in the Microsoft  Windows CE operating system     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    310 Control Panel Options    Administrator Control    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PC Connection    Use this option to set parameters for computers intended to be used as dedicated  single  or multi   application devices  In other words  only the application s  or feature s  specified in the AppLock  configuration by the Administrator are available to the user     LXE devices with the AppLock feature are shipped to boot in Administration mode with no  default password  thus when the device is first booted  the user has full access to the device and no  password prompt is displayed  After the administrator specifies an application to lock  a password  is assigned and the device is rebooted or the hotkey is pressed  the device switches to end user  mode     AppLock also contains a component which set
181. ecio neea eene n E a aE E a tae e eS RS devo ue Semele ERES 238  HFigute 5 63  Select Profil essere oisin ea E EEE E FUMUS PUN UO E HER EUREN DER 238  Ersure 3204  Egi Soles nap or dodi EDU M pL E T 239  Hemres 63 ACU Status Taide 239  ETS 5 06 Cebtficate StOLes eie HH TEE TUE DU Ub eria HAE cH Ep ra e HS EIE DELE UA 240  Eienre 5 57 View Cericate Detalla fo dios 240  Figure 5 68 EAP TLS Configuratioti      che e oett ie e eb e Lb te ie el LER INTR EUROS 241  Figure 3 69  Authentication Settings eus dite eh ais iia 241  Fiore 5270 Select C Srtficaleue ccu Dota tr pete baee ebbe bp ba eR pou DE ME sr Gnd AE ats 242    Figure 5 71  Figure 5 72  Figure 5 73  Figure 5 74  Figure 5 75  Figure 5 76  Figure 5 77  Figure 5 78  Figure 5 79  Figure 5 80  Figure 5 81  Figure 5 82  Figure 5 83  Figure 5 84  Figure 5 85  Figure 5 86  Figure 5 87  Figure 5 88  Figure 5 89    E EQ VX6RG J    Authentication Settings  Cert  ticate Details    inar rasa 242    Validate SeEVeb oce orm ab pFIE OTIO ERE GISEPRUSU IEEE SEFRHEHETISET DI EFIE 243  SOU Ate mith CALCU ao 243  WPA PSK  Configuration siii iia 244  Symbol NE FWLAN Sora nta  245  Symbol Wireless Information Tab eii ba Reti terre ERE a obe lada ici 246  Symbol Wireless Network Properties  aou oaa met eri dais 247  Symbol Advanced Wireless Mota 248  Logon to Certificate Authors 249  Certificate Services  Welcome crepas iii is 249    Download CA Certificate SCreGtih  cccc ccccciciesincsavecsccsancosacsavessascatessusscncss ec ansspustanessacc
182. ected  gt   disabled   Code 39 1401234567890 aaa4567890www  Code 39 full ASCII  A41231234567890 aaal234567890www  Code 39  A4  lt  rejected  gt   too short              Rejected barcodes generate a bad scan beep  In some cases  the receipt of data from the scanner  triggers a good scan beep  from the external scanner   and then the rejection of scanned barcode  data by the processing causes a bad scan beep on the same data     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    174 Length Based Barcode Stripping    Length Based Barcode Stripping    Use this procedure to create symbology rules for two barcodes with the same symbology but with  different discrete lengths  This procedure is not applicable for barcodes with variable lengths   falling between a maximum value and a minimum value      Example 1     e Anormal AIM or Symbol symbology role can be created for the desired barcode ID   e Next  a custom barcode symbology must be created using the same Code ID as the original  AIM or Symbol ID rule and each rule would have unique length settings     Example 2     For the purposes of this example  the following sample barcode parameters will be used      EANI28 and Codel28 barcodes  Some of the barcodes start with    00    and some start with    01      The barcodes are different lengths     e 34 character length with first two characters      01     strip first 2 and last 18    e 26 character length with first two characters      01     strip first 2 and last 10    e 24 character length
183. ector  Additionally this assembly provides a  connection point for the vehicle   s chassis ground to be connected internally to the conductive    chassis of the computer     The VX6 internal power supply can accept DC input voltages in the range of 12 to 80 Volts     5    Figure 2 15 The Power Connector    Pinout  Pin Signal  1 DC Positive      2 UPS Battery Positive      3 Chassis Ground  4 UPS Battery Negative        5 DC Negative          E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    48 External Connectors    UPS Battery Pack Connectors    Input    5  Figure 2 16 The UPS Battery Pack Input Connector    Pinout  Pin Signal  1 DC Positive      Not used  Chassis Ground  Not used  DC Negative          nan A WwW N    Output    5  Figure 2 17 The UPS Battery Pack Output Connector    Pinout  Pin Signal  1 DC Positive      UPS Battery Positive      Chassis Ground  UPS Battery Negative        DC Negative          nA Bb W N    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    External Connectors 49    UPS Battery Extension Cable Connectors    Input    5    Figure 2 18 The UPS Battery Extension Cable Input Connector    Pinout  Pin Signal  1 DC Positive      UPS Battery Positive      Chassis Ground  UPS Battery Negative        DC Negative          Un A vc N    Output    5    Figure 2 19 The UPS Battery Extension Cable Output Connector    Pinout  Pin Signal  1 DC Positive      UPS Battery Positive      Chassis Ground  UPS Battery Negative        DC Negative          nA Bb W N    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guid
184. ed    DATA COMMUNICATIONS Radio Type  BG    Auto Profle   Don  off List    Admin Login Reg  Domain  FCC    Driver  v2 01 22    Disable Radio SCU   v2 D1 12 About SCU       Figure 5 2 SCU   Main Tab    The Main tab displays information about the radio including     Active Profile     Select from the profiles created using the Config tab   Status of the radio  Down  Associated  Authenticated  etc     Radio Type  BG is 802 11b g radio  ABG is 802 11a b g radio    Auto Profile option   Regulatory Domain   Driver version   SCU  Summit Client Utility  version   Copyright Info may be accessed by clicking the About SCU button    The Disable Radio button can be used to disable the radio card  Once disabled  the button label  changes to Enable Radio  By default  the radio is enabled     The Admin Login button provides access to editing radio parameters as well as adding  renaming  and deleting profiles  Profile and Global parameters may only be edited after entering the Admin  Login password  The Active Config may be changed without logging in  Once logged 1n  the  button label changes to Admin Logout  The admin is also automatically logged out when the  SCU is exited     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    184 Summit Radio    Admin Login    To login to Admin mode  click the Admin login button     Admin Password Entry    Enter Admin Password        Figure 5 3 Admin Password Entry    Enter the Admin password and press OK  If the password is incorrect  an error message is  displayed  
185. ed with several secondary keys  These keys are identified by the  superscripted text found on the keyboard keys  The secondary keys are accessible by using two   2  keystrokes  the   2  key followed by the superscripted key        SOUBOLOO  OG660666e00       Figure 2 28 The Secondary Key    Once the  lt 2  gt  state is enabled  by pressing the  lt 2  gt  key  the Secondary Mode LED is  illuminated and the  lt 2   gt  state is enabled until another key is pressed  The  lt 2   gt  key is toggled on  with a  lt 2  gt  keypress and then immediately off with another   2   keypress     For example    Press  lt 2   gt  and   F1   to turn CapsLock on and off   Press  lt 2  gt  and  lt  gt  to initiate the PgUp command   Press  lt 2   and   Q  to type the         key     Press  lt 2  and  lt BkSp gt  to enter the Insert  Ins  mode     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    56 The QWERTY Keyboard    Control Keys  The VX6 keyboard has several control keys  some of which are not used on the VX6     Note  The 2     functions of the   F4   and  lt F5 gt keys are not used as the display brightness is  adjusted via the buttons on the control panel   The 2  functions of the   F6    and   F7   keys are not used as the VX6 has TFT LCD  screen with no provision for contrast adjustments   The 2     functions of the  lt F8 gt  and  lt F9 gt  keys are not used as the sound volume on the  VX6 is controlled with the Volume and Sounds icon in the Microsoft Windows CE  Control Panel     The 2  function of
186. ed within range  Pairing supports SPP devices only     Up to two Bluetooth devices can be connected to the VX6 at a time  LXE supports one scanner  and one printer  see Accessories         Taskbar Icon    Legend       0    Bluetooth is ready to connect  or    Bluetooth module is connected to one or more of the targeted  Bluetooth device s               VX6 is not connected to another Bluetooth device  or    VX6 is out of range of all targeted Bluetooth device s   Connection  is inactive           Note  Configuration elements are persistent and stored in the registry     Setup the Bluetooth module to establish how the user is notified by easy pairing and auto     reconnect events     AppLock  if installed  does not stop the end user from using the Bluetooth application  nor does it  stop other Bluetooth enabled devices from pairing with the VX6 while AppLock is in control  See  Chapter 6     AppLock for more information     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    100 Control Panel Options    Certificates    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Certificates  Manage digital certificates used for secure communication   Lists the Stored certificates trusted by the VX6 user  These values may change based on the type    of radio security resident in the client  access point or the host system     Date Time    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Date Time Icon    Set Date  Time  Time Zone  and Daylight Savings        Factory Default Settings  Current Time Midnight  Time Z
187. een  Blanking    in Chapter 3  System Configuration    for details     Cleaning the Display    Keep fingers and rough or sharp objects away from the display  If the glass becomes soiled or  smudged  clean only with a standard household cleaner such as Windex  without vinegar or use  Isopropyl Alcohol  Do not use paper towels or harsh chemical based cleaning fluids since they  may result in damage to the glass surface  Use a clean  damp  lint free cloth  Do not scrub optical  surfaces  If possible  clean only those areas which are soiled  Lint particulates can be removed  with clean  filtered canned air     Touchscreen    Touchscreen    The touchscreen is a Resistive Panel with a scratch resistant finish that can detect touches by a  stylus  and translate them into computer commands  In effect  it simulates a computer mouse   Only Delrin or plastic styluses should be used  A right mouse click is simulated by touching and  holding the screen for the appropriate time interval     Note  Always use the point of the stylus for tapping or making strokes on the display  Never use  an actual pen  pencil or sharp object to write on the touchscreen     An extra or replacement stylus may be ordered from LXE  See the    Accessories    section for the  stylus part number     Please refer to Chapter 3     System Configuration    for more information on   e Calibrating the touchscreen  e Disabling the touchscreen     LXE offers a replaceable touchscreen protective film to protect the touchsc
188. eless Security section following    E EQ VX6RG J    in this chapter     If invalid credentials are entered into the stored credentials  the authentication will fail   No error message is displayed and the user is not prompted to enter valid credentials     VX6 Reference Guide    200    Summit Radio    How to  Use Sign On Screen    After completing the other entries in the profile  click on the Credentials button  Leave the  Username and Password blank  No entries are necessary on the Credentials screen for LEAP  or WPA LEAP     For PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC and EAP TLS import the CA certificate into the Windows  certificate store     For EAP TLS  also import the User Certificate into the Windows certificate store     Access the Credentials screen again  Make sure the Validate server and Use MS store  checkboxes are checked     The default is to use the entire certificate store for the CA certificate  Alternatively  use the  Browse button next to the CA Cert  CA Certificate Filename  on the Credentials screen to  select an individual certificate     For EAP TLS  also enter the User Cert  User Certificate filename  on the credentials screen  by using the Browse button     Click the OK button then the Commit button   When the device attempts to connect to the network  a sign on screen is displayed     Enter the Username and Password  Click the OK button           SDC Credentials    User     Password               Figure 5 10 Sign On Screen    10  Verify the device is authenticated b
189. ence Guide    E EQ VX6RG J          hook  WM WINDOWPOSCHANG  ED    exiting  AppLock must also prevent the application from  enabling the taskbar and resizing the application s  window  This message traps a change in the window  position and corrects it     AppLock Error Messages 335  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  In app hook  WM SIZE In addition to preventing the locked application from LOG EX  exiting  AppLock must also prevent the application from  enabling the taskbar and resizing the application s  window  This message traps a change in the window  size and corrects it   In app In addition to preventing the locked application from LOG EX       Initializing keyboard hook    AppLock is calling the keyboard hook initialization     LOG PROCESSING                procedure   Keyboard hook initialization failure   The keyboard filter initialization failed  LOG ERROR  Keyboard hook loaded OK The keyboard hook dll exists and loaded successfully  LOG EX   L after Ctrl Processing the backdoor entry  LOG EX   Loading keyboard hook When AppLock first loads  it loads a dll that contains LOG PROCESSING    the keyboard hook processing  This message is logged  prior to the load attempt                                            Open failure The status information is being saved to a file and the LOG ERROR  file open has failed  This could occur if the file is write  protected  If the file does not exist  it is created    Open registry failure If the Administration re
190. ent storage are lost     The Status LED  located on the keyboard of the VX6  is lit when the power is on   e Green     VX6 is operating from vehicle power or AC power   e Solid Yellow     VX6 is operating from the UPS  UPS battery is good   e Flashing Yellow     VX6 is operating from the UPS  UPS battery is critically low     Note  Always turn the computer off prior to removing power cables     s   me  6000000808    VX6       Figure 2 2 The Power  On Off  Switch       Caution The VX6 has voltage on it even when power is off  Always disconnect input  power before working on the VX6  changing fuse  opening access panel   etc                  E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    36 External Connectors    External Connectors  Most external connectors for the VX6 are located on the bottom of the unit     e The Keyboard Mouse connector is not used on the VX6 as the VX6 contains an  integrated keypad     e COMI connects to a serial barcode scanner     e  COM3  labeled  COM2 3   connects to a serial printer or PC with the appropriate  cables     e The USB Ethernet connector accepts dongle cables  offering a combination of the  following ports     o An Ethernet port  o A USB Host port  o A USB Client port   e Audio connects to a mono or stereo telephone headset microphone   Other external connectors are located as follows     e Antenna connectors are located on the top of the VX6  VX6 s can be configured for  a single antenna or dual antennas     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Ext
191. ents of the subdirectories and the general function of the files  Files  installed in each VX6 are specific to the intended function of the VX6     Files installed in each VX6 configured for an RF environment contain PCMCIA card radio  specific drivers     the drivers for each type of radio are specific to the manufacturer  e g  Summit   Cisco  Symbol  for the radios installed in the RF environment and are not interchangeable     Software Load    The software loaded on the mobile computer consists of Windows CE 5 0 OS  hardware specific  OEM Adaptation Layer  device drivers  Internet Explorer 6 0 for Windows CE browser and  utilities  The software supported is summarized below     Operating System    e Full Operating System License  Includes all operating system components  including  Windows CE 5 0 kernel  file system  communications  connectivity  for remote APIs    device drivers  events and messaging  graphics  keyboard and touchscreen input  window  management  and common controls     Network and Device Drivers  Bluetooth  Optional    Wavelink Avalanche  Optional   LXE AppLock    Java  Optional     e Java executables and browser components are handled by the Java option  when installed      Terminal Emulation  Optional   e RFTerm  VT220  TN5250  TN3270   Runs automatically at the conclusion of each reboot   if installed    LXE API Routines  see  Accessories  for the LXE SDK Kit part number     Note    Please contact your LXE representative for software updates and CAB fi
192. er cable to the VX6  The power cable can also be connected to a UPS  battery pack  which is then connected to the VX6  see    VX6 User   s Guide       3  Connect accessories to VX6  e g  scanner  antenna  etc   see    VX6 User   s Guide    4  Secure all cables to the VX6 with the Strain Relief Cable Clamps   5  Turn the VX6 on   6  When instructed  calibrate the touchscreen  see Chapter 3     System Configuration      7  The screen may appear white while applications and drivers are loading  When  complete  set Date and Time  see Chapter 3     System Configuration     8  Pair Bluetooth devices   9  Configure radio  see Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration     10  Warmboot to ensure all registry settings are saved   11  Device is ready for use   The VX6 should be mounted in an area in the vehicle where it   e Does not obstruct the vehicle driver s vision or safe vehicle operation   e Can be easily accessed by anyone seated in the driver s seat   Troubleshooting  Can t calibrate the AppLock is installed and running on the mobile device  AppLock  touch screen  change restricts User access to running programs  Changes or modifications  the date time or require Administrator access   adjust the volume  M    Refer to    Chapter 6     AppLock    for setup and processing information   RFTerm opens and  runs upon each cold   Tap File   Exit to close the RFTerm application   reset and warm reset   There may be small delays while the wireless client connects to the  VX6 seems to
193. er source to the device and press the Power button   Adjust screen display  audio volume and other parameters if desired  Install accessories   Tap Start   Settings   Control Panel   Administration icon     Assign applications on the Control  single application  or Application  dual application  tab  screen     Assign a password on the Security tab screen    Select a view level on the Status tab screen  if desired    Tap OK   Press the hotkey sequence to launch AppLock and lock the configured application s      The device is now in end user mode     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Administration Mode 267    Administration Mode  Administration mode gives full access to the mobile device  hardware and software configuration  options     The administrator must enter a valid password  when a password has already been assigned   before access to Administration mode and configuration options are allowed  The administrator  can configure the following options     e Create change the keystroke sequence to activate administrator access   e  Create change the password for administrator access    e Assign the name of the application  or applications  to lock    e Select the command line of the application to lock     In addition to these configuration options  the administrator can view and manage the status logs    of AppLock sessions    Administrator default values for this device   Administrator Hotkey Shift Ctrl A  Password none  Application path and name none  Application comma
194. ere tite a 79  297  Device Name and description                         122  326  DHCP pe 113  317  Dialup properties for dial up access                101  312  Dimensions  Specifications                       sesssss 287  Discover and Query                  sse 94  DISPLAY E                    31   Brightness Control Keys                           esses 56   Cleaning  cina ado 60   Contrast Control Keys                      sees 56   A A cates  60   ai steers iiis 60   Specifications    287  289  Diversity   RECEIVE i iethete otto een tiere etes 196   ie ci cronicas 195  Document Conventions                essere 3  Dot Pitch  Specifications                      sesessess 289    E    EAP TLS   CISCO  Radio  eicere EE  240  Enable Code ID                        eee 162  170  Enable Code ID drop down box                             161  Enable internal scanner sound                                 159  Enable or Disable specific symbology                    161  End user switching   LOUGH m                M   269  A                eves 9  Environmental Specification                        sss 288  Error Messages   ADDLOCk uite enero 330  Ethernet    E EQ VX6RG J    Index    Configuratiofi     2  orent teet tee pe 137  UIE soc ete mein emen eh n 275  Examples   Barcode processing                   sse 173   Control Code replacement                                  172   raw scanner data and resulting data                    173  Expand Control Panel                            
195. erence Guide    286 IBM 3270 Terminal Emulator Keypad    IBM 3270 Terminal Emulator Keypad    esc    onp Y CAPS Mere  ms Soyaovyory Ov Mor Os ox Bene    F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 EZ F8 F9 F10 7 9        A  amp      ins BELE      TRL   Dol wl cl PE vil pole                    PgUp  gt   668066680080 00G83  i Home f PgDn Wf END  lt  DELW     6668608680606    Figure A 2 IBM 3270 Specific Keypad       This keypad is designed to allow the user to enter terminal emulator commands when running  LXE s RFTerm    program  When running this program please refer to the RFTerm    Reference  Guide for equivalent keys and keypress sequences     IBM 5250 Terminal Emulator Keypad       Esc Bono W CAPS fenex  ns oo ovey Ory Ove x4 hv sx Benes    F1 A ro Ars Ara A Fs ro Hr  M re ro AiO 7 9        A       ins EN      TRL  3006868808060                  uy    00000000005  E Home W PgDn W END  lt  DEL Y     gt   5600000000009    Figure A 3 IBM 5250 Specific Keypad       This keypad is designed to allow the user to enter terminal emulator commands when running  LXE   s RFTerm    program  When running this program please refer to the RFTerm    Reference  Guide for equivalent keys and keypress sequences     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Appendix B Technical Specifications    Physical Specifications    fms         omes        we mrmeseas   CS   MESS Sorge Various sizes supported  DEREN  Compact Flash supported via    Secure Digital adapter   Secure   Secure Digital      PCMCIA CardBus Interface Two  2  
196. erm   Please refer to    Setup Terminal Emulation Parameters    earlier in this guide for RFTerm quick  start instruction  Refer to the    RFTerm Reference Guide    on the LXE Manuals CD for complete  information and instruction     Installed by LXE  Application is setup by the Administrator by tapping Start   Settings   Control  Panel   Administration  Configuration parameters are specified by the AppLock Administrator  for the mobile device end user  AppLock is password protected by the Administrator  End user  mode locks the end user into the configured application or applications  The end user can still  reboot the mobile device and respond to dialog boxes  The administrator specified application is  automatically launched and runs in full screen mode when the device boots up     See Also  Chapter 6    AppLock    for instruction     Wavelink Avalanche Enabler  Optional     The following features are supported by the Wavelink Avalanche Enabler when used in  conjunction with the Avalanche Molility Center  MC  Console     After configuration  Enabler files are installed upon initial bootup and after a hard reset  Network  parameter configuration is supported for     e IP address  DHCP or static IP  e RF network SSID  e DNS hosts  primary  secondary  tertiary   e Subnet mask  e Enabler update  Related Manual     Using Wavelink Avalanche on LXE Windows Computers        The VX6 has the Avalanche Enabler installation files loaded  but not installed  on the mobile  device when it
197. ernal Connectors 37    Scanner Serial Connector  COM1     The serial connector  labeled    SCANNER      configured as COM1  is industry standard RS 232   The connector includes a PC AT standard 9 pin    D    male connector  By default  Pin 9 is  configured to supply  5 VDC at 0 4A  max  for an external bar code scanner  Pin 9 may also be  configured to provide RI  Refer to Chapter 4     Scanner     section titled    Serial Port Pin 9    for  more information on configuring Pin 9     If Pin 9 is powered off  please see    Technical Specifications     Connection Cable    in the following  section for information on using a serial cable     If COMI is not being used for a scanner  it can also be used for screen blanking when the vehicle  is in motion  Please see  Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable  in the following  section for more details        Figure 2 3 Scanner Serial Connector  COM1     Note    Power the VX6 off before attaching a cable or device to the COMI serial port     Pinout  Pin Signal Description  1 DCD Data Carrier Detect     Input  2 RXD Receive Data     Input  3 TXD Transmit Data     Output  4 DTR Data Terminal Ready     Output  5 GND Signal Power Ground  6 DSR Data Set Ready     Input  7 RTS Request to Send     Output  8 CTS Clear to Send     Input  9  5VDC Barcode Scanner Power     400mA max  Default   or or  RI Ring Indicator     Input  Shell CGND Chassis Ground    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    38 External Connectors    Printer PC Serial
198. ertificate Details  Do not check the Validate server certificate box  This allows the user to be authenticated as the  first step     When the user certificate successfully authenticates  come back to this screen and validate the  server certificate as described in the next section     Click the OK button to dismiss the configuration screens   When the radio re connects the user is authenticated with the user certificate     If the user does not authenticate  recheck the user certificate and the date on the computer     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 243    Validating the Server Certificate  Before validating the server certificate  make sure the Root CA certificate is installed on the VX6   Navigate to the Wireless Network Properties configuration screen   Click the Properties button     Check the Validate server box as shown below     Authentication Settings       Figure 5 72 Validate Server    Click OK to dismiss the configuration boxes     Advanced Wireless Settings    Y Add New     Y peapTest  preferred        Only access points          Figure 5 73 SSID Authenticated    Once the authentication completes the status changes to show the VX6 has authenticated to   lt SSID gt  as shown above     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    244 Cisco Radio    WPA PSK Configuration    Wireless Network Properties  Network name  SSID    bsapTest     This is a computer to computer  ad hoc     Wireless network key  WEP   This network requires a key for     Encryption   TKI
199. es a password to clear the screensaver   If there is no screensaver chosen  this checkbox is ignored     Note  Screensaver option only works with Remote Desktop screensavers        a       E EQ VX6RG J    Password Properties    Password Settings    Password          Password     Confirm password       Enable Password Protection   _  At Power On   _  screen Saver       Figure 3 27 Password Properties       VX6 Reference Guide    116 Control Panel Options    PC Connection    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PC Connection    Control the connection between the VX6 and a nearby desktop laptop computer        Factory Default Settings  Allow Connection Enabled  Connect Using     USB Client                         Tap the Change button to adjust the settings and click the OK button to save the changes  The  changes take effect immediately     Unchecking the    Allow connection with          disables ActiveSync     Change         Clicking Change lists configured ActiveSync connections  In addition  there is a checkbox for  Automatic Connect  This option applies to USB connection only  If this checkbox is checked   when the USB cable is connected  the VX6 will automatically try to start ActiveSync over the  USB port  Note that this interferes with processes on the configured port at the same time     PC Connection Properties E OK  3      PC Connection        n These settings control the connection between your Windows  CE device and desktop computer  Warning  Adjusting these 
200. es for  editing  The Add button changes to Replace  When Replace is tapped  the  values for the current item in the list are updated        Clear All When no item in the Custom IDs list is selected  tapping the Clear All button  clears the Custom ID list and any text written  and not yet added or inserted  in  the Name and ID Code text boxes        Remove The Clear All button changes to a Remove button when an item in the Custom  IDs list is selected  Tap the desired line item and then tap the Remove button to  delete it  Line items are Removed one at a time  Contents of the text box fields  are cleared at the same time                 Notes  e Prefix and Suffix data is always added on after stripping is complete  and is not affected  by any stripping settings   e Ifthe stripping configuration results in a 0 length barcode  a    good    beep will still be  sounded  since barcode data was read from the scanner     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation    Match List Rules  The data in the list is processed by the rules listed below     E EQ VX6RG J    167    Strings in the list will be searched in the order they appear in the list  If the list contains  ABC and AB  in that order  incoming data with ABC will match first  and the AB will have  no effect    When a match between the first characters of the barcode and a string from the list is  found  that string is stripped from the barcode data    Processing the list terminates when a match is found or when the
201. ess  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner   Barcode  Note  The Barcode tab replaces the Advanced tab used in previous software revisions and  adds several new features  Please contact your LXE support representative for details     The Scanner application  Wedge  can only enable or disable the processing of a barcode inside  the Wedge software     The Scanner application enables or disables the Code ID that may be scanned     Enabling or disabling a specific barcode symbology is done manually using the configuration  barcode in the Integrated Scanner Programming Guide  available on the LXE Manuals CD and  the LXE ServicePass website      Choose an option in the Enable Code ID drop down box  None  AIM ID  Symbol ID  or Custom  ID        Scanner Control mi OK E  Man   comi   coma   Barcode fo  Enable Code ID  Symbology Settings   None y   Ctrl Char Mapping  Custom Identifiers          Figure 4 3 Scanner Control   Barcode tab       Symbology Individually enable or disable a barcode from being scanned  set the minimum  Settings and maximum size barcode to accept  strip Code ID  strip data from the  beginning or end of a barcode  or  based on configurable Barcode Data  add a  prefix or suffix to a barcode before transmission              Ctrl Char Define the operations the LXE Wedge performs on control characters  values  Mapping less than 0x20  embedded in barcodes   Custom Defines an identifier that is at the beginning of barcode data which acts as a    Identifiers Code ID
202. ess Network Configuration    for details   Stores Network communication options   Transfer files between a VX6 and a desktop computer  Run this command after setting up a connection  Begin connection to FTP server   End connection to FTP server   View downloaded files  see Note    View Excel 97 and newer documents   View BMP  JPEG and PNG images   View Adobe Acrobat documents   View Word 97 and newer documents and RTF files  Set Summit radio   network parameters    Please see Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration    for details   The command line interface in a separate window  Access web pages on the world wide Internet   Option   Option  Terminal emulation application    Music management program   Opens an ASCII notepad   Log on to a Windows Terminal Server   Enter data using the stylus on the touchscreen  Option  Remote management for networked devices  File management program    Note  The Microsoft File Viewers cannot display files that have been password protected     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    300 Start Menu Program Options    Communication    Access  Start   Programs   Communication    ActiveSync    Once a relationship  partnership  has been established with Connect  ActiveSync will synchronize  using the radio link on the VX6  See also  Chapter 1    Introduction     section    ActiveSync     Initial  Setup        Requirement  ActiveSync version 3 7  or higher  must be resident on the host  desktop laptop   computer  ActiveSync is available from the Mic
203. esults of the keypress if a       Key Sequence  LaunchApp or RunCmd is mapped to the keypress        For more information  please see the How To sections later in this chapter     LaunchApp    The default for all text boxes is Null  The text boxes accept string values only     Click the exe radio button to enter the name of the application to launch     Click the opt radio button to enter any options for the application launch              Keypad Control ka OK xX   _KeyMap   LaunchApp    Appi App3  App2 App4    D HE o    App Opt    e exe O opt         Figure 3 20 KeyMap Properties   LaunchApp Tab    For more information  please see How To  Remap an Application Launch  later in this section     Note  The executable file and options are not checked for accuracy  If the launch fails  the    E EQ VX6RG J    device emits a single beep    VX6 Reference Guide       108    Control Panel Options    RunCmd    The default for all text boxes is Null  The text boxes accept string values only     Click the file radio button to enter the name of the command to launch     Click the parm radio button to specify parameters for the command        Keypad Control       Keiao   Launchapp   Runtmd   0000000000         Cmdi Cmd3  Cmd2 Cmd4    po      File Parm      file    parm               Figure 3 21 KeyMap Properties   RunCmd Tab    For more information  please see How To  Remap an Application Launch  later in this section     How To  Remap a Single Key    1      gt  ped    On the KeyMap tab  se
204. et  see below  is required    Headset  Single Band   Headset  Dual Band   Headset  Behind the Ear  Dual Ear   Foam  Replacement Block  Headset   Yoke  Replacement for Dual Band Headset   Yoke  Replacement for Single Band Headset  Replacement Microphone Foam  Wind Screen  10 pack  Replacement Microphone Foam  Wind Screen  50 pack  Replacement Headset Foam  Ear Cover  10 pack    Replacement Headset Foam  Ear Cover  50 pack    VX6 Reference Guide    Manuals and Accessories    9000A317PSACUS R  9000A318PSACWW R    9000A378UPSBATTPACK R  9000A074CBLUPSEXTNDR    153180 0001  9000A279ANTREMOTE8 R  9000A283RMTAGANT8  9000A278ANTREMOTE6 R  9000A282RMTAGANT6  9000A280ANTREMOTE6RT  9000A284RMTAGANT6RT  9000A281ANTREMOTISRT  9000A285RMTAGANTISRT                   9000A510STYLUS  VX6A512PROTFILM    9000A076CBLHEADSET1    HX1A501SINGHEADSET  HX1A502DUALHEADSET  HX1A503BTHHEADSET  HX1A504HSBLOCKFOAM  HX1A505DUALYOKE  HX1AS06SINGLEYOKE  HX1A508WINDSREENIO  HX1A509WINDSREEN50  HX1ASIOFOAMEARIO  HX1A511FOAMEAR    E EQ VX6RG J    Manuals and Accessories    E EQ VX6RG J    Scanners    Scanner  Powerscan  SR  8    Cbl  WW    Scanner  Powerscan  SR  12    Cbl  US    Scanner  Powerscan  SR  Low Temp  8    Cbl    Scanner  Powerscan  SR  Low Temp  12    Cbl    Scanner  Powerscan  LR  8    Cbl  WW    Scanner  Powerscan  LR  12    Cbl  US    Scanner  Powerscan  LR  Low Temp  8    Cbl    Scanner  Powerscan  LR  Low Temp  12    Cbl    Scanner  Powerscan  XLR  8    Cbl  WW    Scanner  Powerscan  XLR  12  
205. et this key Press this key    FH Fale ee o gp si  F12 Px   x         e  a pp py   A  b Lo   P        B  c EEE  c  d pro D  e pp py   E  F o pp py   F  o pp py   G  h pp   p      H    p    j EE EMEN ee E J  k ER K      p        m Lo   P        M  n EA E AA N  o o pp py   o  p po   py   P  a pp py   Q  r Lo   pp py   R  s AAA S  t EA AAA T  u EA AE U  Y EN MAA v  w L  pp py   w  x pp   p     X  y pL Y  z pp py   Z  A lo pp  x  A  B Lo p   p       B  c lo pp   o   c  D ER EA D  E ESG d dE d RA E    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    284    To get this key    VX6 Reference Guide    o cvc o   oj o 25 o m 2 N         x  sS    c4M o xjo violz e r x ceci irio  m    DOT             gt                numeric     Key Map 101 Key Equivalencies    Press These Keys and Then    e   sin   on   ar   coss         ia    x    Hr    Lx  o xp         x    Press this key    olvo o    l ojo s  o m  2 N        x 3    ciaHlo xj olv olzieE rixi c  i ir o m    J  O  4    NIL ODO  Oo  R  oO  msl  o    E EQ VX6RG J    Key Map 101 Key Equivalencies    To get this key       alpha       numeric      alpha       numeric      alpha       numeric      alpha      colon       semicolon         _  underscore      comma      apostrophe      tilde                1                      gt     E EQ VX6RG J    Press These Keys and Then    27  swe   om  an   coptocr     Hr              x    px   ppp           x lt     285    Press this key    v  o c    aj jmx  m si o o    oj u r c  z ir m o     o do o  o       V X6 Ref
206. ey will appear in the Key Map dropdown list on  the Keyboard Panel     These values do not affect virtual keyboard taps     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    106 Control Panel Options    KeyPad    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel  KeyPad Icon    Use this option to assign key functions to mappable keys and specify application launch or run  command key sequences        Factory Default Settings             KeyMap  Modifier Mode None  Key Fl       Remapped Key Fl  Key Sequence Null                                        LaunchApp  App1 App4 Null  App Opt exe  RunCmd   Cmd1 Cmd4 Null  File Parm file       KeyMap    Tap the OK button to save changes  Tap the X button to ignore changes and return to the Control  Panel        Keypad Control E OK             KeyMap LaunchApp Runcmd  Modifier Mode    amp  None  O shift     2nd shift    Remapped Key Key Sequence   Fi y                Figure 3 19 KeyPad Properties   KeyMap Tab       Modifier Mode Available modifier keys are None  Shift and 2    Shift  The  default value is None        Key The key to be remapped  valid keys alone or with a modifier key     F1 through F10  Scan Key Left  Scan Key Right  Enter      Decimal        Remapped Key A key can be remapped to           any single key in the drop down list        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J       Control Panel Options 107       a Key Sequence  string of keys   an application  LaunchApp   a command  RunCmd            Key Sequence The Key Sequence textbox displays the r
207. eyboard wedge  active scanner port   and COM port settings such as baud rate  parity  stop bits and data bits     Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration    details radio setup  Configuration for WEP and  WPA is included     Chapter 6   AppLock  contains explanation and instruction when working with VX6   s running  AppLock     Appendix A    Key Maps    describes the keypress sequences for the VX6 keyboard     Appendix B    Technical Specifications    lists technical specifications including physical   environmental  display and the radios     Appendix C    VX6 CE  NET 4 2  takes you through the Windows CE  NET 4 2 system setup  and files structure     Appendix D     Reference Material    includes parameter programming charts and other reference  information     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    When to Use thi    Document Conventions    s Guide    This reference guide uses the following document conventions        ALL CAPS    All caps are used to represent disk directories  file names  and application  names        Menu   Choice    Rather than use the phrase    choose the Save command from the File menu      this guide uses the convention    choose File   Save              Quotes       Indicates the title of a book  chapter or a section within a chapter  for example      Document Conventions            Indicates a key on the keyboard  for example   lt Enter gt           Indicates a reference to other documentation        Differences in operation or commands due to pla
208. eyboards    Virtual keyboards display the actual character a keypress results in  For example  pressing the   lt Shift gt  key on the virtual keyboard toggles the characters displayed on the keys between upper  and lower case  The  lt aii gt  key toggles the keys between standard and international symbols  The    Shift   and  lt      gt  keys can be used in combination for capitalized international characters     Note  When the virtual keyboard is displayed  the physical keyboard is still active  Therefore it  is possible to input data from both keyboards     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    The QWERTY Keyboard 59    Enabling the Input Panel    The Input Panel is disabled by default  To enable the Input Panel  select Start   Settings    Control Panel   Input Panel icon  Make sure the    Allow applications to change the input panel  state    checkbox is checked and warmboot the VX6     Input Panel Properties          Figure 2 31 Input Panel Properties    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    60    The Display    The Display    The VX6 Display is a thin film transistor display capable of supporting half screen SVGA   graphics modes  Display size is 800 x 320 pixels  The display covering is designed to resist stains   The touchscreen allows signature capture and touch input     The display supports screen blanking to eliminate driver distraction when the vehicle is in motion   Please see    Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable    earlier in this chapter and    Scr
209. f  the barcode data to an application    When Strip  Code ID  see Symbology panel  is enabled  the entire custom code ID string is  stripped  1 e  treated as a Code ID     UPC EAN Codes only  The code id for supplemental barcodes is not stripped    When Enable Code ID is set to AIM or Symbol  Custom Code IDs appear at the end of the  list of standard Code IDs    When Enable Code ID is set to Custom  Custom Code IDs replace the list of standard Code  IDs    When Enable Code ID is set to Custom  AIM or Symbol Code IDs must be added to the  end of the Custom Code ID  For example  if a Custom Code ID    AAA    is created to be  read in combination with an AIM ID for Code 39     A1     the Custom Code ID must be  entered with the AIM ID code first then the Custom Code ID   JA1AAA    When Enable Code ID is set to None  Custom Code IDs are ignored    Custom symbologies appear at the end of the list in the Symbology dialog  They are  processed at the beginning of the list in the scanner driver  This allows custom IDs  based  on actual code IDs  to be processed before the Code ID    The tethered scanner operation cannot be controlled by the VX6 scanner application   therefore  a    good    beep may be sounded from the tethered scanner even if a barcode from  a tethered scanner is rejected because of the configuration specified  The VX6 emits a bad  scan beep  to indicate the barcode has been rejected     E EQ VX6RG J       Barcode Manipulation 163    Barcode   Symbology Settings    Th
210. g does not  apply to Summit Clients only    Current Adapter Lists all network adapters currently installed on the mobile device    Primary Adapter Indicates if the Enabler is to attempt to configure the primary adapter     active only if there are multiple network adapters         Icon on taskbar    Places the Avalanche icon in the Avalanche taskbar that may   optionally  override the standard Windows taskbar        Use Avalanche Network  Profile          The Enabler will apply all network settings sent to it by the  Avalanche Mobility Center Console        VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J       Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 151    Avalanche Icon Selecting the Avalanche Icon will access the Avalanche Network    Profile tab which will display current network settings        Avalanche Network Profile Properties OK B     Profile    Property    ManageNet   no  ManageWire    no       Figure 3 48 Avalanche Network Profile Displayed          Use Manual Settings When enabled  the Enabler will ignore any network or wireless  settings coming from the Avalanche Mobility Center Console and  use only the network settings on the mobile device        Properties Icon Selecting the Properties icon displays the Manual Settings  Properties dialog applet  From here  the user can configure  Network  DNS and Wireless parameters using the displays shown  below                 Note    A reboot may be required after enabling or disabling these options     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guid
211. g of  keypresses or to execute an application or command     All key remapping is done using the KeyPad option in the Control Panel  Please see KeyPad in  Chapter 3  System Configuration  for details   NumLock and the VX6    The keyboard does not have a NumLock indicator or key  NumLock is always On     Keyboard Backlight    The LXE keyboard keys are backlit  The keyboard backlight and the display share the same  timer  which is configured in the Windows CE Control Panel  When the display is On  the  keyboard backlight is also On  Please refer to    Power Management    later in this document for  information on configuring the timeout     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    54 The QWERTY Keyboard    Keyboard LEDs  The VX6 keyboard has two  2  LED indicators     1  CapsLock Mode LED  Indicator           LLLA LEE s IC  2    IIIITITLILIJOTIE Secondary Mode LED    Indicator    Figure 2 26 Keyboard LEDs    CAPS LED    This LED indicates the state of the keyboard CapsLock mode  If CapsLock is enabled this LED 1s  illuminated green  When CapsLock is off  the LED is dark        Figure 2 27 The CapsLock Key    Press  lt 2   gt  then  lt F1 gt  to toggle CapsLock On and Off   The default value of CapsLock is    Off        For information on preserving CapsLock configuration after a reboot  please see  Configuring  CapsLock Behavior  in Chapter 3     System Configuration        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    The QWERTY Keyboard 55    Secondary Keys LED    The VX6 keyboard is equipp
212. g the Registry and also recommends making a backup copy of  the registry before changes are made     The registry settings for the Version window are under HKEY LOCAL MACHINE   Software V  LXE   Version in the registry     Create a new string value under this key  The string name should be the Application name to  appear in the Version window  The data for the value should be the version number to appear in  the Version window     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 89    Language and Fonts  The Software tab displays any fonts built into the OS image           Software Network IP    GUID 8B075942 C347 EEEF 709D DSB052F6F 724  Windows CE version Windows CE 4 20 patched through Apr 30 2006  OAL version VXC VXCPC422BT XScale PXA255 Jun 8 2006 09 01 06    Bootloader version VXC VXCPC422BT XScale PXA255 Jun 8 2006 09 29 49  Compile version VXCPC422BT compiled Jun 8 2006 09 01 14  FPGA version FPGA v 2 6  Language ANSI 1252  Win Latin 1  OEM 437  US   Enalish only          Figure 3 3 About Properties  Software    The fonts built into the OS image are noted in the Language section of this tab   e English only     No additional fonts are built into the OS  e Japanese  e Simplified Chinese  e Traditional Chinese  e Korean    The above listed Asian fonts are ordered separately and built in to the VX6 OS image  Built in  fonts are added to registry entries and are available immediately upon startup  Thai  Hebrew   Arabic and Cyrillic Russian fonts are available in 
213. g with the network for this method to succeed  If a  Mobile Device Server is found  the Enabler will automatically attempt to apply all wireless and  network settings from the active profile  The Enabler will also automatically download and  process all available packages     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    140 Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    Mobile Device Wireless and Network Settings    Once the connection to the Mobile Device Server is established  the Enabler will attempt to apply  all network and wireless settings contained in the active profile  The success of the application of  settings is dependent upon the local configuration of control parameters for the Enabler  These  local parameters cannot be overridden from the Avalanche Mobility Center Console     The default Enabler adapter control setting are    e Manage network settings     enabled   e Use Avalanche network profile     enabled   e Manage wireless settings     disabled for Windows CE Units  To configure the Avalanche Enabler management of the network and wireless settings   1  Open the Enabler Settings Panels by tapping the Avalanche icon on the desktop   Select File   Settings  Enter the password   Select the Adapters tab     Choose settings for the    Use Manual Settings    parameter     PQ A UN    Choose settings for    Manage Network Settings        Manage Wireless Settings    and    Use  Avalanche Network Profile        6  Click the OK button to save the changes    7  Reboot the device 
214. gistry key does not exist  the LOG ERROR  switch to user mode fails because the AppName value in  the Administration key is not available    Opened status file The status information is being saved to a file and the LOG EX  file has been opened successfully    Out of memory for encrypted pwd Not enough memory to encrypt the password  LOG ERROR   pRealTaskbarWndProc already set The taskbar control has already been installed  LOG_EX   Pwd cancelled or invalid remain in The password prompt was cancelled by the user or the LOG_EX   user mode maximum number of failed attempts to enter a password  was exceeded    Read registry error hot key The hotkey registry entry is missing or empty  This is LOG_ERROR  not considered an error  The keyboard hook uses an  embedded default if the value is not set in the registry    Read registry failure app name AppName registry value does not exist or is empty  This   LOG_ERROR  constitutes a failure for switching into user mode    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide       336 AppLock Error Messages  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Read registry failure Cmd Line AppCommandLine registry entry is missing or empty  LOG_ERROR  This is not considered an error since command line  information is not necessary to launch and lock the  application   Read registry failure Internet The Internet registry entry is missing or empty  This is LOG_ERROR    not considered an error since the Internet value is not  necessary to launch and lock the app
215. handle search failure The application being locked did not complete LOG_ERROR  initialization   Application handle search OK The application initialized itself successfully LOG_ERROR  Application load failure The application could not be launched by AppLock  the   LOG_ERROR  application could not be found or is corrupted   Backdoor message received The backdoor keys have been pressed  The backdoor LOG_PROCESSING  hotkeys provide a method for customer service to get a  user back into their system without editing the registry  or reloading the device   Cannot find kbdhook dll The load of the keyboard filter failed  This occurs when   LOG_ERROR  the dll is missing or is corrupted  Look in the  Windows  directory for kbdhook dll  If it exists  delete it  Also  delete AppLock exe from the  Windows directory and  reboot the unit  Deleting AppLock exe triggers the  AppLock system to reload   Converted Pwd Converted password from wide to mbs  LOG_EX  Could not create event The keyboard filter uses this event at the Administrator   LOG ERROR  EVT_HOTKEYCHG Control panel  The event could not be created   Could not hook keyboard If the keyboard cannot be controlled  AppLock cannot LOG_ERROR  process the hotkey  This failure prevents a mode switch  into user mode   Could not start thread HotKeyMon The keyboard filter must watch for hot key changes  LOG_ ERROR  The watch process could not be initiated   Ctrl after L or X Processing the backdoor entry  LOG_EX  Ctrl pressed The Ctrl key has
216. he Browse button   e Uncheck the Use full trusted store checkbox     e Select the desired certificate and click Select  You are returned to the Credentials  screen     If using the Certs Path option    e Leave the Use MS store box unchecked    e Enter the certificate filename in the CA Cert textbox   Click OK then click Commit     The device should be authenticating the server certificate and using PEAP MSCHAP for the user  authentication     For information on generating a Root CA certificate  please see    Root CA Certificate    later in this  chapter     Note  The date must be properly set on the device to authenticate a certificate     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    212    Summit Radio    WPA LEAP    To use WPA LEAP  make sure the following profile options are used     Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  Set EAP Type to LEAP   Set Encryption to WPA TKIP   Set Auth Type to Open    Please see    LEAP    earlier in this section to configure the radio for LEAP without WPA     Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 24 WPA LEAP    Please review    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials     earlier in this chapter     VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    E EQ VX6RG J    213    To use Stored Credentials  click on the Credentials button  No entries are necessary for Sign On    Credentials as the user will be prompted for the Username and Password when connecting to the  network        Credentials E  User  user2    Password  LXE    Figure
217. he network     e The Username and Password are left blank on the Credentials screen  When the  device attempts to connect to the network  a sign on screen is displayed  The user  must enter the Username and Password at that time to authenticate     How to  Use Stored Credentials    I     mode ow ge    After completing the other entries in the profile  click on the Credentials button   Enter the Username and Password on the Credentials screen and click the OK button   Click the Commit button    For LEAP and WPA LEAP  configuration is complete     For PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC and EAP TLS import the CA certificate into the Windows  certificate store     For EAP TLS  also import the User Certificate into the Windows certificate store     Access the Credentials screen again  Make sure the Validate server and Use MS store  checkboxes are checked     The default is to use the entire certificate store for the CA certificate  Alternatively  use the  Browse button next to the CA Cert  CA Certificate Filename  on the Credentials screen to  select an individual certificate     For EAP TLS  also enter the User Cert  User Certificate filename  on the credentials screen  by using the Browse button       Click the OK button then the Commit button       Verify the device is authenticated by reviewing the Status tab  When the device is property    configured  the Status tab indicates the device is Authenticated and the method used     Notes  More details are provided in the appropriate Summit Wir
218. her device  it may indicate a bad serial port     ActiveSync indicator on the host turns green and spins  but connection never occurs    Baud rate of connection is not supported or detected by host  Try forcing ActiveSync on the  desktop PC to use a specific baud rate and set the VX6 to use the same baud rate      Or     Incorrect or broken data lines in cable     ActiveSync indicator on the host remains gray    The host doesn   t know you are trying to connect  May mean a bad cable  with no control lines  connected  or an incompatible baud rate  Try the connection again  with a known good cable     Testing connection with a terminal emulator program  or a serial port monitor    You can use HyperTerminal or some other terminal emulator program to do a rough test of  ActiveSync  Set the terminal emulator to 8 bits  no parity  1 stop bits  and the same baud rate as  the connection on the CE device  After double clicking REPLLOG EXE on the CE device  the  word    CLIENT    appears on the display in ASCII format  When using a serial port monitor  you  see the host echo    CLIENT     followed by    SERVER     After this point  the data stream becomes  straight  binary  PPP     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync 129    Create a Communication Option    l     10     11   12   13   14     On the VX6  select Start   Settings   Control Panel   Network and Dialup Connections  A  window is displayed showing the existing connections     Assuming the one y
219. i M C                     H    A 32  A bte areata eRe PME NIB IU 32  Backup BAUE Y A mima admiten Idtm Edd M 32  PCMCIA or A P                               HERE 32  E AM A II er Oe ee 32  A A A 32  Bluetooth LXEZ PAIDE sti iia 33  Power o0 ronie                             karabi 34  Physical GOMAS cocinar    n                A                               35  OWOH re  OOO POP O HA s OA 35  EXISTA COI ceci 36  Scanner Serial Connector  COMI arcos ia 37  A A 37  PAM Mensidat n ld Ei 38  luii  Tm A 38    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents 111    Technical Specifications     Connection C aDIG ainia aisl   39  RIS CIS Handshaking and the Serial POP  ett sr RR REED ER FER HOS M etae ina 39  Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable                                   eene 40  Ethernet USB Connec eaa open p pma ib frappe ME dai OM In ME 41  A ate eines 41  A xn MD MM cep eee REN ere Ur Pere eiser sre Seer UM ME UM 42  MIST mil sse acp dub dstedn in 43  lun                                         UM    43  WSB Host Connector   oos citta Pesan abd ei Up qaem ids ua Et Chose mq dua mE 44  A nnan a E E KE AT 44  USB sn Connector id din 44  A CP               MH 44  DAD Race sigilo dida 45  Junii m EET 45  A PRUNUS 46   j MT              a        P    46  POWELL ODORE  a 47  PNOO esnia EE EEE EE                           47  UPS  Battery Pack Cometa si 48  lon mem         o       n        a P tues 48  lun                                            48  Un cT e
220. ial  Many commercial null modem cables will not work  LXE  recommends the following cable     Serial cable   9000A054CBL6D9D9                                  5 1  9 6  Pinout   DB9 female DB9 female  1 7  2 3  3 2  4 6 8  5 5  6 8 4  7  9 no connection                Figure 3 38 Pinout     Serial Cable for Synchronization    Some laptop devices do not properly implement all control lines on the serial port     the laptop  connection will not work     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Utilities    VX6 Utilities    131    The following files are pre loaded by LXE     LAUNCH EXE    All applications to be installed into persistent memory are normally in the form of Windows CE  CAB files  These CAB files exist as separate files from the main installation image  and need to be  copied to the mobile device using an internal ATA card or from a PC using ActiveSync  The CAB  files are loaded into the folder System  which is the internal ATA drive     Then  information is added to the registry  if desired  to make the CAB file auto launch at startup   The CAB file can update the registry as desired and cause the unpacked file s  to be placed in the  appropriate location     The registry information needed is under the key HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE   SOFTWARE   LXE    Persist  as follows  The main subkey is any text  and is a description of the file  Then 3 values  are added     FileName is the name of the CAB file  with the path  usually  System   Installed is a DWORD value of 0  which 
221. ication Panel  see o PE EP e ippo 270  Figute 6 5 Application Launch Opos HERREN ENS ROERTUM FUN KEE AREE anaes eee 213  Figute 6 6 Security Paoli nenen sats Ne SENE ES O KE EEEE HU NEE TN ici 276  Figure 0 7 Options Paella 217  ES Paneli enni mre ey shes tana cere elt  ded M IM MU ces a ala  278  Figure A   VXGOWERTY Keyboard 281  Figure A 2 IBM 3270 Specife Keypad    3i e ee Uit ie at ios d iaa sides e e tus 286  Figure A 3 IBM 3250 Specific Keypad    t   ndr i a e ias 286  Figure C L Pocket CMD Prompt S6EeGI s   ne ione ra pir rs o 302  Figure C2  Taskbar Properties  304  Fienre C3    About Properties SONWANE tano mun tamm er o retta ERU UD m ete Rs 307  Figure CA About Properties  VeISIOHS pipe 308  Figure  C5  About Properties  Network IP espanola 308  Figure C 6 Accessibility Properties  Keyboard    ie et ir Rete tee Pe EE DIE ERE ERE DO AERE EENE Pe apes 309  RicureC 7 Accessibility Properties  Sound oae eerte Rt hiatus el ce o is 309  Figure Cos  Date lime Properties tea poi 311  lure Dial eR E 312  Figure C 10 Display Properties  Backlight TD  sust 313  Eieure  C  1T  Input Panel Properties  ecd HERO reses dai 314  Briel MIX rea a E ET 316  Fisurs C 13 Network Connection Propecia EE OF EDU FIERE  317  Foue CAA  OW HEL Properties 318  EienteGslS Password PropelleS RN ias pipi 319  Figure  C 16 Communication   PC Connect On Taba 320  Eiguiec 17 PCMCIA Control Tab  Slot 0 and Slot Landa 321  Figure Cs18    Compact Flash ATA Control Tab Slot Liso sedas 321  Ficus CH9 PG 
222. ication s   Upon bootup completion an application with Manual enabled is listed on the  Switchpad accompanied by a checkmark that indicates the application is currently active or  available for Launching  When an application name is tapped by the end user  the application is  launched  if inactive  and brought to the foreground     Applications set up with Manual  Launch  enabled may or may not be launched at bootup  This  function is based on the application   s Auto At Boot setting  The applications have been listed as  approved applications for end user manual launch using the Switchpad menu structure  The  approved applications are listed on the Switchpad  A checkmark indicates the applications active  status     When Manual  Launch  is disabled for an application  and Allow Close is enabled for the  application  when the end user closes the specific application it is no longer available  shown  on  the Switchpad     When Auto At Boot and Manual  Launch  are both disabled for a specific application  the  application is 1  not placed on the list of approved applications for end user manual launch and 2   never launched  and 3  not displayed on the Switchpad     Default is Disabled  When enabled  the associated application can be closed by the end user     This option allows the administrator to configure applications that consume system resources to  be terminated if an error condition occurs or at the end user   s request  Error conditions may  generate a topmost popup re
223. icrosoft Certificat es    johndoe    Certificate Issued    The certificate you requested was issued to you     e  DER encoded or    Base 64 encoded    Download certificate  Download certificate chain       Figure 5 94 Certificate Issued    Click the Download certificate link     File Download x     Some files can harm your computer  If the file information below  looks suspicious  or you do not fully trust the source  do not open or  save this file    File name  certnew cer   File type  Security Certificate   From  100 100 100 100     amp  This type of file could harm your computer if it contains  malicious code     Would you like to open the file or save it to your computer     Open   Save   Cancel   More Info      Tv stays ask before opening this wpe of hie       Figure 5 95 Download Security Warning    Click Save to download and store the user certificate to the PC  Make sure to keep track of the  name and location of the certificate  The private key file is also downloaded and saved during this  process     Be sure use the same name for the certificate file as was used for the private key  file  For example  it the private key was saved as VX6USER PVK then the    certificate file created must be given the same name  for example   VX6USER CER        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    258 Certificates    Installing a User Certificate    Copy the certificate and private key files to the VX6  Import the certificate by navigating to Start    Control Panel   Certificates     5
224. ificate store   Return to the Credentials screen     Use the Browse button to locate the User Cert from the certificate store  Highlight the desired  certificate and press the Select button  The name of the certificate is displayed in the User Cert  box     Enter the password for the user certificate in the User Cert pwd box   Please review    Windows Certificates Store vs  Certs Path    earlier in this chapter     Check the Validate server a checkbox        Credentials E  User  user2  User Cert  fusercert          User Cert pwd  pe  CA Cert   E trusted store  E     Validate server Use MS store    Figure 5 30 EAP TLS Credentials          If using the Windows certificate store   e Check the Use MS store checkbox  The default is to use the Full Trusted Store   e   To select an individual certificate  click on the Browse button   e Uncheck the Use full trusted store checkbox     e Select the desired certificate and click Select  You are returned to the Credentials  screen     If using the Certs Path option    e Leave the Use MS store box unchecked    e Enter the certificate filename in the CA Cert textbox   Click OK then click Commit     The device should be authenticating the server certificate and using EAP TLS for the user  authentication     For information on generating a Root CA certificate  please see    Root CA Certificate    later in this  chapter  For more information on generating a User certificate  see    User Certificate  later in this  chapter     Note  The date m
225. igital  SD   cues Microsoft Windows CE  NET 4 2 or CE 5 0  system    Extended temperature version  Other options TM      RAM Mount   vehicle mounting   RY Windows CE net    ems y  DAPPORErADO  c ED  E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide          2 When to Use this Guide    When to Use this Guide    Lu The    VX6 User s Guide    is directed toward the VX6 user  It is delivered on the LXE  Documentation CD  It contains safety warnings  descriptions of the controls and  connectors  instruction on installing antennas  and day to day operation     As the reference for LXE   s VX6 equipped with a Microsoft Windows CE operating system  this  guide provides detailed information on its features and functionality  Use this guide as you would  any other source book    reading portions to learn about the VX6  and then referring to it when  you need more information about a particular subject     This chapter     Introduction     briefly describes this reference guide structure  contains setup and  installation instruction  briefly describes data entry processes  and explains how to get help     Chapter 2    Physical Description and Layout    describes the function and layout of the controls  and connectors on the VX6  Describes AC power and DC power connections     Chapter 3    System Configuration    takes you through the system setup and file structure   covering all components except the wireless network  AppLock and Scanner     Chapter 4    Scanner    contains information on the scanner k
226. in screen appears for logging into the wireless network     Enter Network Password    a     gt                  Figure 5 52 Login Screen    Enter valid user credentials     Once authenticated click the IP Information tab    CISCO1       Figure 5 53 IP Information Tab    The device displays the IP address given by the DHCP server     Now go back and authenticate the server     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    234 Cisco Radio    Server Authentication    To validate the server certificate  the root CA certificate must be installed  For instructions for  installing  see    Installing a Root CA Certificate    in this chapter  The RADIUS server certificate is  not required  only the root CA which issued the server certificate     Navigate to the Wireless Network Properties configuration screen     Click the Properties button     PEAP Properties ES    Walidate server certificate      Connect only if server name ends in           Trusted root certificate           Connect only if server is signed by  specified trusted root CA    Always try to resume secure session     Figure 5 54 PEAP Properties  Validate Server Certificate          Check the Validate server certificate box    Click OK to dismiss the configuration boxes    When the login box appears enter valid user credentials    It is possible for to be prompted to accept a Root CA certificate when using PEAP GTC     If the trusted root certificate box  as shown in the previous figure  is blank the user will be  prompted to acce
227. in the ActiveSync  section later in this chapter     LXEConnect allows a user to view the VX6 screen remotely from a PC using an ActiveSync  connection     Install LXEConnect    1  Install Microsoft ActiveSync version 3 8 or higher on a PC with a USB port  For details   please see ActiveSync later in this chapter     2  Power up the VX6     3  Connect the VX6 to the PC using the proper connection cable  Once connected  the  ActiveSync dialog box appears  If using the USB connection  the ActiveSync connection is  automatically established  If using a serial connection  it is necessary to initiate the  connection from the VX6     4  Select    No    for partnership when prompted  Dismiss any ActiveSync dialog boxes warning a  partnership is not set up  It is not necessary to establish a partnership to use LXEConnect   However  if a partnership is desired for other reasons  one may be established now  More  details on partnerships are included in ActiveSync later in this chapter     5  When the ActiveSync screen appears  select Explore          Microsoft ActiveSync al ES  File View Tools Help    e o saa    5top    Details Explore  Options    Guest  Connected                Information Type   Status             Figure 1 7 ActiveSync Explore    6  Anexplorer window is displayed for the VX6  Browse to the  System LXEConnect folder     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    14 Configuring the VX6 with LXEConnect                              LXEConnect Miel xi    File Edit View Favorites
228. indows CE Browse dialog is displayed  After selecting the logfile  from the Browse dialog  tap OK     Note  If your Status Panel does not look like the figure shown above  you may have the Single  Application version which does not have as many options     Error Error status messages are logged when an error occurs and is intended to be used by  the administrator to determine why the specified application cannot be locked     Process Processing status shows the flow control of AppLock components and is mainly  intended for LXE Customer Service when helping users troubleshoot problems with    their AppLock program    Extended Extended status provides more detailed information than that logged by Process  Logging    All All messages are displayed     Tap the Refresh button after changing from one view level to another  The filtered records are  displayed  all others are not displayed     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Application Configuration 279    Log  Note  Ifa level higher than Error is selected  the status should be cleared frequently by the  administrator   In addition to the three view levels the administrator can select that all status information be  logged or turn off all status information logging completely  The system default is    None      however to reduce registry use  the administrator may want to select    None    after verifying the  configuration  Tap the Clear button to clear the status information from the registry   e None  e Error  e Processing  e
229. inistrator to generate or use a key in the local  machine store     Additional Options   Request Format  9 CMC OPKCS10    Hash Algorithm    SHA 1     Only used to sign request                          Save request to a file          Attributes   gt     ul                Friendly Name           Figure 5 91 Advanced Certificate Details    For the Certificate Template  select    User      Check the    Mark keys as exportable    and the    Export keys to file    checkboxes   Type the full path on the local PC where the private key is to be copied  Also specify the private    key filename     Be sure to note the name used for the private key file  for example    VX6USER PVK  The certificate file created later in this process must be given  the same name  for example  VX6USER CER        DO NOT check to use strong private key protection   Make any other desired changes and click the    Submit    button     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    256 Certificates       Potential Scripting Violation       Potential Scripting Violation     Sr r       Figure 5 92 Script Warnings    If any script notifications occur  click the    Yes    button to continue the certificate request        Create Private Key Password                   Figure 5 93 Script Warnings    When prompted for the private key password   e Click    None    if you do not wish to use a password  or    e Enter and confirm your desired password then click    OK        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 257       M
230. ion requires a radio card and an Internet Service Provider  There are a few changes in the  Windows CE version of Internet Explorer as it relates to the general desktop Windows PC  Internet Explorer options  Click the         button to access Internet Explorer Help     Media Player    Access  Start   Programs   Media Player    There are few changes in the Windows CE version of Media Player as it relates to the general  desktop Windows PC Microsoft Media Player options  Click the         button to access Media  Player Help     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Start Menu Program Options 303    Remote Desktop Connection    Transcriber    Access  Start   Programs   Remote Desktop Connection    There are few changes in the Windows CE version of Remote Desktop Connection as it relates to  the general desktop Windows PC Microsoft Remote Desktop Connection options     Select a computer from the drop down list or enter a host name and tap the Connect button   Tap the Options  gt  gt  button to access the General  Display  Local Resources  Programs and    Experience tabs  Click the         button to access Remote Desktop Connection Help     Note  VX6 and Custom Key Maps  before connecting to a host using Remote Desktop  Connection  go to Start   Settings   Control Panel   Keyboard and select Preload or 0409   depending on system software revision  from the keymap popup  Click OK     Access  Start   Programs   Transcriber    Select Transcriber on the Start   Programs menu  To make ch
231. ioning  the PAC filename and Password must be entered     Please review    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials     earlier in this chapter     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 215    The entries on the Credentials screen are determined by the type of credentials  stored or sign on   and the type of PAC provisioning  automatic or manual      Click on the Credentials button     To use Stored Credentials  click on the Credentials button  No entries are necessary for Sign On  Credentials with automatic PAC provisioning as the user will be prompted for the Username and  Password when connecting to the network     Credentials E  User  user2    Password  LXE    PAC Filename     PAC Password       Figure 5 27 EAP FAST Credentials          To use Sign On credentials     e Do not enter a User and Password as the user will be prompted for the Username and  Password when connecting to the network     To use Stored Credentials     e Enter the Domain Username  if the Doman is required   otherwise enter the  Username     e Enter the password   To use Automatic PAC Provisioning   e No additional entries are required   To use manual PAC Provisioning   e Enter the PAC Filename and PAC Password     e The PAC file must be copied to the directory specified in the Certs Path global  variable  The PAC file must not be read only     Tap OK then tap Commit  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the Main tab and  warmboot  The SCU Main tab shows the device is associated after the
232. ions  Any updates available will be applied to  the mobile device immediately upon a successful connection        Abort    Stop transmission        Settings    The Settings option under the File menu allows the user to access the control  panel to locally configure the Enabler settings  The Enabler control panel is   by default  password protected  The default password is system  The  password is not case sensitive        Scan Config       VX6 Reference Guide          Note  LXE does not support the Scan Configuration feature on Windows CE  devices     The Scan Config option under the File menu allows the user to configure  Enabler settings using a special barcode that can be created using the  Avalanche Mobility Center Console utilities  Refer to the Wavelink  Avalanche Mobility Center User s Guide for details     The Exit option is password protected  The default password is leave  The  password is not case sensitive     If changes were made on the Startup Shutdown tab screen  then after entering  the password  tap OK and the following screen is displayed        Avalanche Monitor E    Do you want to  Em  e Continue monitoring     O Stop monitoring     Change the option if desired  Tap the X button to cancel Exit  Tap the OK  button to exit the Avalanche applet        E EQ VX6RG J       Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 143    Avalanche Update Settings    Access  Start   Avalanche   File   Settings    Use these menu options to setup the Avalanche Enabler on the mobile 
233. is greater than the maximum value allowed for that symbology  the  maximum valid length will be used instead           164  Parameters  Enable  Min  Max  VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation 165    Strip Leading Trailing Control    This group of controls determines what data is removed from the barcode before the data is  buffered for the application  If all values are set  Code ID takes precedence over Leading and  Trailing  Barcode Data stripping is performed last  Stripping occurs before the Prefix and Suffix  are added  so does not affect them     See Also  Barcode Processing Overview earlier in this chapter        Symbology  fan y  Strip  Enable     Min   i Max  fal  _  Leading        Trailing       V  Code ID   Barcode Data             Figure 4 5 Strip Leading Trailing Controls    If the total number being stripped is greater than the number of characters in the barcode data  it  becomes a zero byte data string  If  in addition  Strip Code ID is enabled  and no prefix or suffix 1s  configured  the processing will return a zero byte data packet  which will be rejected     The operation of each type of stripping is defined below     Leading This strips the number of characters specified from the beginning of the barcode  data  not including Code ID   The data is stripped unconditionally  This is  disabled by default     Trailing This strips the number of characters specified from the end of the barcode data   not including Code ID   The data is stri
234. is moved or clicked     e When a USB mouse is first attached to the V X6  the mouse pointer may not be  visible  However  moving or clicking the mouse causes the pointer to appear     e When the USB mouse is unplugged  the pointer may remain visible until the  touchscreen is tapped     e If the touchscreen is used for input  the mouse pointer may disappear  However   moving or clicking the mouse causes the pointer to reappear     Platform 2 VX6 s  The mouse pointer is not visible unless a USB mouse is attached     If a mouse is attached  the mouse pointer 1s displayed on screen     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    12 Setup the Radio and Network    Setup the Radio and Network    Prerequisites  e Network SSID or ESSID number of the Access Point  e WEP or LEAP Authentication Protocol Keys    4  See    Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration  for complete information     Setup Terminal Emulation Parameters    Before you make a host connection  you will  at a minimum  need to know   e the alias name or IP address  Host Address  and  e the port number  Telnet Port  of the host system   to properly set up your host session     1  Make sure the mobile client network settings are configured and functional  If you are  connecting over wireless LAN  make sure your mobile client is communicating with the  Access Point     2  From the Start   Programs  run LXE RFTerm or tap the RFTerm icon on the desktop     3  Select Session   Configure from the application menu and select the   
235. ither the SCU  Summit Client Utility  or ACU   Cisco Aironet Client Utility               Bluetooth Discover and then pair with nearby discoverable Bluetooth  devices    My Documents Storage for downloaded files   applications    Start Access programs  select from the Favorites listing     documents last worked on  change view settings for the  control panel or taskbar  on line help or run programs                 E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    80 Desktop    Folders Copies at Startup  The following folders are copied on startup     System Desktop   gt  Windows Desktop  System Favorites   gt  Windows Favorites  System Fonts   gt  Windows Fonts  System Help   gt  Windows Help  System Programs   gt  Windows Programs    This function copies only the directory contents  no sub folders   The following folders are NOT copied on startup     Windows AppMer  Windows Recent  Windows Startup    Because copying these has no effect on the system or an incorrect effect     Files in the Startup folder are executed  but only from System Startup  Windows Startup is parsed  too early in the boot process so it has no effect     Executables in System Startup must be the actual executable  not a shortcut  because shortcuts are  not parsed by launch     My Device Folders                            Folder Description Preserved upon Reboot   Application Data Data saved by running applications No  My Documents Storage for downloaded files   applications No  Network Mounted network drive No  Progr
236. k adapter selected in the  drop down box  Note the availability of the Windows standard Refresh button  When tapped  the  signal strength  signal quality and link speed are refreshed for the currently selected adapter  It  also searches for new adapters and may cause a slight delay to refresh the contents of the drop   down menu            Avalanche Update Settings    Scan Config   Display   Shortcuts   Adapters   Status   soccF1061 T al    Signal Strength  Signal Quality     PMI TH    SSID      SSID2    IP Addr  100 100 100 100 MAC      00 17 23 00 00 00  Speed  11 0 Mbps BSSID  00 02 2d 00 00 00                  Figure 3 50 Status Display    Link speed indicates the speed at which the signal is being sent from the adapter to the mobile  device  Speed is dependent on signal strength     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    154 eXpress Scan    eXpress Scan    eXpress Scan may be used for the initial network configuration of the mobile device  Available  configuration parameters can include wireless network settings and the Avalanche Mobile Device  Server Address     Barcodes are created with the eXpress Config utility  Please refer to Using Wavelink Avalanche  on LXE Windows Computers  available on the LXE manuals CD  for information on eXPress  Config  Depending on the barcode length and the number of parameters selected  eXpress Config  generates one or more barcodes for device configuration     To use eXpress Scan to configure an LXE device     1  Start eXpress Scan on the 
237. k the Commit button after making changes to ensure the  changes are saved  Newer versions of the SCU display a reminder if the Commit button  is not clicked before an attempt it made to close or browse away from the Config tab if  there are unsaved changes     Config   A string of 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters  name of the Profile  Default  Default   SSID    A string of up to 32 alphanumeric characters  the Service Set Identifier  SSID  of the WLAN to  which the radio connects    Default  Blank    Client Name    A string of up to 16 characters     Name assigned to the radio and the device using the radio  The  client name may be passed to networking radio devices  e g  Access Points     Default  Blank    Power Save  Power save mode     Options  CAM   Constantly Awake Mode  power save off  Maximum   Maximum power saving mode  Fast   Fast power saving mode    Default  Fast  Tx Power  Desired transmit power   Options  Maximum   Max power for current regulatory domain    50  30  20  10  5 or 1 mW    Default  Maximum  Bit Rate  Options  Auto   Rate negotiated automatically with the AP  1  2  5 5  6  9  11  12  18  24  36  48 or 54 Mbit  Default  Auto    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 189    Radio Mode    Specify 802 11a  802 11b and or 802 11g rates when communicating with AP  The options  displayed for this parameter depend on the type of radio  802 11b g or 802 11a b g  installed in  the mobile device     Options  B rates only  1  2  5 5 and 11 Mbps   BG Rate
238. ke sure the    Use Windows to configure my wireless settings    box is checked   Set the    Networks to access    drop down box to    Only access points       Click the OK button to return to the Wireless Information Screen    Click the Add New     line     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    228 Cisco Radio    Wireless Network Properties  Network name  SSID    peapTest     This is a computer to computer  ad hoc     Wireless network key  WEP   This network requires a key for     Encryption   TKIP y   Authentication   we A  y      network  wireless access points are not used    Network key    Key index  n Key provided automatically    IEEE 802 1X Authentication  Enable 802 1X authentication on this network    EAP type   TLS y     Figure 5 43 Wireless Network Properties       Enter the Network name  SSID  into the text field   For PEAP MSCHAP and EAP TLS  set Encryption to TKIP and Authentication to WPA   For WPA PSK see    WPA PSK Authentication Configuration        To configure the IEEE 802 1X Authentication box see the following sections for configuration of  each authentication protocol     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 229    PEAP MS CHAP Authentication Configuration    The Microsoft supplicant authenticates a user with the PEAP MS CHAP protocol  The Cisco  CAB file without Cisco PEAP must be used with PEAP MS CHAP  See    Installing Radio  Drivers     earlier in this chapter  for more information     Configuring the PEAP MS CHAP Supplicant       Wireless
239. keypad  it cannot be  entered from the SIP     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Application Configuration 277    Password    Move the cursor to the Password text box  The passwords entered in the Password and Confirm  Password fields must match  Passwords are case sensitive     When the user exits the Administrator Control panel  the two passwords are compared to verify  that they match  If they do not match  a dialog box is displayed notifying the user of the error   After the user closes the dialog box  the Security Panel is displayed and the password can then be  entered and confirmed again  Ifthe passwords match  the password is encrypted and saved     See Also  Passwords and Troubleshooting Multi Application AppLock    Options Panel    AppLock contains several types of delays and timeouts to accommodate different applications   Please note that the delays specified on the Launch panel are delays before AppLock attempts to  start the specified application s   The timeouts specified on this panel are delays after AppLock  has attempted to launch the application     Administrator Control E OK ES    Application   Security   Options Status                Launch timeout   60000  Replace timeout   20000  Restart timeout   20000                Figure 6 7 Options Panel    Launch timeout    This timeout specifies the period of time  in milliseconds  for AppLock to wait for the application  to initially launch after the application has been called  For example  1f the applicatio
240. ktop Autologon  Note   RDP file must be saved in  System folder        Autolaunch TimeSync                Figure 3 23 MX3X VXC Options Properties   Communication Tab    Enable TCP IP Version 6  By default  IPv6 is disabled on the LXE device  Check this checkbox to enable IPv6     Allow Remote Desktop Autologon  By default  Remote Desktop Autologon is disabled  Check this checkbox to enable Remote  Desktop Autologon     Note  The  RDP file must be saved in the NSystem folder  When prompted  use the Save As  button to save the  RDP file is the NSystem directory  If the  RDP file is saved in the  default root folder location  the  RDP file will not persist across a warmboot     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    112 Control Panel Options    Autolaunch TimeSync  By default  TimeSync does not automatically run on the VX6  To enable TimeSync to run  automatically on the VX6  check this checkbox   Synchronize with a Local Time Server    By default  GrabTime synchronizes via an Internet connection  To synchronize with a local time  server     1  Use ActiveSync to copy GrabTime ini from the My Device   Windows folder on the mobile  device to the host PC     2  Edit the copy of GrabTime ini on the host PC  Add the local time server s domain name to  the beginning of the list of servers  You can optionally delete the remainder of the list     3  Copy the modified GrabTime ini file to the My Device   System folder on the mobile  device     The System GrabTime ini file takes precedence o
241. l the Type IE PCMCUN Rad Ossa tetti tit etr TED ER etr lados 63  CISCO O os eeepc A LR M MM P ER IEEE 67  Replace ICF ESA                                67  SD Cad lt e ode 68  di MEC 68  Poner AI dida 69  External IN Sa ORO bM Vn a Pete Senrie oe feprerrrety Pete  are Qum MEE 69  A e ir EE E 70  Environmental IO as 70  Vehicle  12 80V DC Dr deca 71  WAG Input Power SSC Ate Ai 72  Power Adapter Cable T         P              P  72  CMOS Battery socie 73  luii EE 73  CHAPTER 3 SYSTEM CONFIGURATION 75  A RR RE ETT 75  Windows CE Operating SysiBm                       eee ee eco re cre rere rre reu rra rena reu EE E EE re EP EE  75  Wireless Network Conf a 75  Wat AEE E AE E EE E eeEEA ess eeee KE 75  E A or Nr IL Rn en ROR T3  III SOMA datositi oe lada e a e eOe BA E Eiaa 76  A 76  SOWAT tse 710701 adi o ds 76  IA A A AA 77  LXE RPTE EU rs cda TI  Lob qM                                                  IT  Wavelink Avalanche Enabler  Optional  ARS TT  DESKIOD                      79  Folders Copies at Ga oves ttal lesqsbn E aa Gul bate aarti ee 80  My Device Folders a                                S 80  Start Menu Program DON T           81  COmmlteabIOTE   E Le due D D E CE Edd 82    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents v    A         E A mm 82  Eorna t A A A ARA 83  Start FTP Servers Stop FIP SEE o dto 83  Command Prosa iii 84  o un a a MM dni Minus 84  A t E idit iM E mE nS 84  Ramis Desktop E MO ria 85  TIRE e datae xc ME M Le Ed ee ere 85  Windows ESPE   
242. lanche CE Manager  1s LXE_VXC        LXE CE devices manufactured before October 2006 must have their drivers and system files  upgraded before they can use the Avalanche Enabler functions  Please contact an LXE  representative for details on upgrading the mobile device baseline     If the user is NOT using Wavelink Avalanche to manage their mobile device  the Enabler  should not be installed on the mobile device s      VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Desktop 79    Desktop    For general use instruction  please refer to commercially available Windows CE     A user s guides or the Windows on line Help application installed in the mobile  device     The VX6 Desktop appearance is similar to that of a desktop PC running Windows 2000 or XP     At a minimum  it has the following icons that can be double tapped with the stylus to access My  Computer  Internet Explorer  and the Recycle Bin     At the bottom of the screen is the Start button  Clicking the Start Button causes the Start Menu to  pop up  It contains the standard Windows menu options  Programs  Favorites  Documents   Settings  Help  and Run     Desktop Icon Function             My Device Access files and programs    Recycle Bin Storage for files that are to be deleted    Internet Explorer Connect to the Internet intranet  requires radio card and  Internet Service Provider     ISP enrollment is not available  from LXE     Wireless Configuration Icon Used for accessing the appropriate wireless configuration    utility  e
243. lect the modifier key from the Modifier Mode options   Select the key to be remapped from the Key pulldown list    Select the value from the remapped key from the Remapped Key pulldown list   Click OK to save the result and close the Keypad Control     How To  Remap a Key Sequence    1     E op rq    On the KeyMap tab  select the modifier key from the Modifier Mode options   Select the key to be remapped from the Key pulldown list   Select Key Sequence from the Remapped Key pulldown list     Select the first key of the string from the pulldown list  Press the Add button to add the key to  the string shown in the Key Sequence box  Repeat this step until all keys desired have been  added to the key sequence  If necessary  use the Clear button to erase all entries in the Key  Sequence box     Click OK to save the result and close the Keypad Control     How To  Remap an Application Launch    l     Bow    On the KeyMap tab  select the modifier key from the Modifier Mode options    Select the key to be remapped from the Key pulldown list    Select Launch App1 4 from the remapped key from the Remapped Key pulldown list   Click on the LaunchApp tab     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 109    Make sure the EXE radio button is selected     In the text box  App1 4  corresponding to the number selected for Launch App1 4  enter the  application to launch     If any parameters are needed for the application  click on the OPT radio button  This clears  the text box 
244. lected  Locale  User Interface Language determines the language used for the menus  dialogs and alerts   Select the Default Input Language to use when the device is rebooted     Remove Programs    Scanner    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Remove Programs    No change from general desktop Remove Programs options  Select a program and click Remove   Follow the prompts on the screen to uninstall user installed only programs  The change takes  effect immediately     Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner    Set scanner keyboard wedge  scanner icon appearance  active scanner port  and scan key settings   Assign baud rate  parity  stop bits and data bits for available COM ports     To set the Scanner parameters  please see Chapter 4     Scanner    for details     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    120 Control Panel Options    Stylus  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Stylus  Set double tap sensitivity properties and or calibrate the touch panel   Double Tap  Follow the instructions on the screen and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take  effect immediately   Calibration       Stylus Properties fa OK x     Double Tap   Calibration      If your Windows CE device is not responding properly to your taps  you       may need to recalibrate your screen     Recalibration involves tapping the center of a target  If you miss the  center  keep the stylus on the screen  slide it over the target s center   and then lift the stylus  To start  ta
245. leep Send Key Messages  WEDGE    Enable Internal Scanner Sound  3000   On Delay Ms          Figure 4 13 Enable Screen Blanking       If the COM1 COM3 screen blanking and On Delay choices are not shown  the  system load must be updated        Warning   Do not select COMI SerCtl or COM3 SerCtl unless you have already attached  the cable described in    Technical Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable    in  Chapter 2  Physical Description and Layout        Failure to attach the cable before selecting a screen blanking option will cause  the screen to go blank  and remain blank  until an appropriate cable is attached  to the specified COM port                 Set the desired COM port  COMI ScrCtl or COM3 ScrCtl  and On Delay  Press OK  The On  Delay can be used to specify the time  in milliseconds  before the display turns on  For example   use the On Delay if the switch end of the cable is attached to the vehicle   s accelerator pedal   Release of the accelerator may mean the truck is coasting to a stop rather than stationary   Configure the delay to allow time for the vehicle to coast to a stop     To disable screen blanking  select COM1 or COM3 to return the selected COM port to normal  operation     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Screen Blanking 177    Operation    To prevent a general user from disabling the screen blanking feature  at least one of the two  following actions must be taken     e Password protection can be set via the Password icon in the Windows Contr
246. les as they are  released by LXE     Software Applications  The following applications are included   e WordPad  was PocketWord in previous versions of Windows CE   e Word Viewer  e Excel Viewer    e PDF Viewer    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Installed Software 77    e Image Viewer   e Scanner Wedge  LXE developed   e ActiveSync   e Transcriber   e Media Player   e Internet Explorer    Note that the viewer applications allow viewing documents  but not editing them     Java  Optional     Installed by LXE  Files can be accessed by tapping Start   Programs   JEM CE  Doubletap the  EVM icon to open the EVM Console  A folder of Java examples and Plug ins is also installed  with the Java option  LXE does not support Java applications running on the mobile device     LXE RFTerm  Optional     AppLock    Installed by LXE  The application can be accessed by tapping Start   Programs   RFTerm   Please refer to    Setup Terminal Emulation Parameters    earlier in this guide for RFTerm quick  start instruction  Refer to the    RFTerm Reference Guide    on the LXE Manuals CD for complete  information and instruction     Installed by LXE  Application is setup by the Administrator by tapping Start   Settings   Control  Panel   Administration  Configuration parameters are specified by the AppLock Administrator  for the mobile device end user  AppLock is password protected by the Administrator  End user  mode locks the end user into the configured application or applications  The end use
247. lication        Registering Backdoor MSG    The AppLock system communicates with the keyboard  hook via a user defined message  Both AppLock exe  and Kbdhook dll register the message at initialization     LOG_PROCESSING       Registering Hotkey MSG    The AppLock system communicates with the keyboard  hook via a user defined message  Both Applock exe and  Kbdhook dll register the message at initialization     LOG_PROCESSING       Registry read failure at reenter user  mode    The registry has to be read when entering user mode is  the AppName is missing  This user mode entry is  attempted at boot and after a hotkey switch when the  administrator has closed the application being locked or  has changed the application name or command line     LOG_ERROR       Registry read failure at reenter user  mode    The registry has to be read when switching into user  mode  This is because the administrator can change the  settings during administration mode  The read of the  registry failed which means the Administration key was  not found or the AppName value was missing or empty     LOG_ERROR       Registry read failure    The registry read failed  The registry information read  when this message is logged is the application  information  It the Administration key cannot be opened  or if the AppName value is missing or empty  this error  is logged  The other application information is not  required  If the AppName value is not available   AppLock cannot switch into user mode     LOG_ER
248. llustrations for Detail   2nd Indicator    Caps Lock Indicator    Figure 1 2 VX6 Components  Front View    VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Components       6     7     COM1 Scanner  Connector    COM3 Connector    Keyboard Mouse  Connector  Not Used     Ethernet USB Cable  Connector  USB Host and  USB Client    Fuse    Audio Connector    Power Cable Connector    Figure 1 3 VX6 Components  Bottom View    Note  COMI is configured with Pin 9  5V  COM3 is labeled    COM2 3    and is configured  with Pin 9 RI  Please see Chapter 4   Scanner   for details on configuring Pin 9 of the    serial ports        Antenna Connectors  Bracket Mounting Area    Strain Relief Bracket and  Screws    Figure 1 4 VX6 Components  Back View    E EQ VX6RG J    V X6 Reference Guide    Note     VX6 Reference Guide          Components    Power LED  Power Switch  Brightness Increase    Brightness  Decrease    Figure 1 5 VX6 Control Panel    1  SD Memory Card  Slot    2  Compact Flash Hard  Drive    3  PCMCIA Slots    Figure 1 6 VX6 Access Panel    The tethered access panel cover is not shown in the illustration above     E EQ VX6RG J    Data Entry    Data Entry    You can enter data into the VX6 through several different methods  A tethered scanner connected  to the COMI serial port provides barcode data entry  the serial ports are used to input output data   keyboards provide manual entry and the touchscreen also provides manual entry  simulating a  desktop PC   s mouse      Keyboard Data Entry    
249. lot is used for Secure Digital  SD  memory cards        CF ATA PCMCIA A 4  L    rouca s E 1  SD Card Slot                2  Compact Flash Hard  Drive    3  PCMCIA Slots       Figure 2 32 The PCMCIA and ATA Slots    PCMCIA Slots    Slot A and B PCMCIA Card Management is handled by the Microsoft Windows CE operating  system  The PCMCIA cards are Plug and Play devices and can be    hot swapped     For more  details  refer to the Windows CE help screens or refer to the documentation delivered with the  PCMCIA card     Note  Although cards in the PCMCIA slot may be hot swapped  the VX6 is not environmentally  sealed while the access panel cover is removed to hot swap PCMCIA cards     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    62 PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots    PCMCIA Pinout    BVD2  SPKR       VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots 63    Install PCMCIA Cards    Equipment Needed  Phillips No  1 screwdriver and a Torque wrench capable of measuring to 9   inch pounds  1 016  11 N m                   Note  The example below details installing a wireless radio card  Installation of other  PCMCIA cards is similar  except there is no antenna     The radio card is installed in slot A  the upper slot   When a second PCMCIA card is present   such as a Bluetooth CF card via a PCMCIA adapter  the second card is installed in Slot B  the  lower slot      Install the Type Il PCMCIA Radio    The LXE Model VX6 Vehicle Mount Computer is specifically for use with LXE  Model 6726  6816  4830
250. lso  Application Panel   Launch   Manual  Launch  and Allow Close    Using the Switch Key Sequence    One switch key sequence  or hotkey  is defined by the administrator for the end user to use when  switching between locked applications  This is known as the Activation key  The Activation key  is assigned by the Administrator using the Global Key parameter  When the switch key sequence  is pressed on the keypad  the next application in the AppLock configuration is moved to the  foreground and the previous application moves to the background  The previous application  continues to run in the background  End user key presses affect the application in focus only     See Also  Application Panel   Global Key    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    270 Application Configuration    Application Configuration    The default Administrator Hotkey sequence is Shift Ctrl A     Administrator mode allows access to all features on the device  When the hotkey is pressed to  switch into Administrator mode  a password prompt is displayed  if a password has been  configured   A password must be entered within 30 seconds  and within three tries  or the  password prompt is removed and the device remains in end user mode with the focus returned to  the locked application  Without entry of a valid password  the switch into Administrator mode  will not occur     Access  Settings   Control Panel   Administration icon    The password prompt is displayed if a password has been configured  When the valid
251. mber decal support all features     including those noted as Platform 2 specific     Note  If software revision IED or greater is installed     LXE VX6 Platform 2  is displayed  during boot up  See  Software Revisions   below  to determine the software revision  installed on the VX6     Software Revisions    system software  These features are available on all VX6 s if the proper revision     S  Some features described in this manual require a certain minimum revision level of  level  or newer  of system software is installed     The software revision is displayed during boot up and on the default desktop wallpaper  The  revision can also be viewed using the Start   Settings   Control Panel   About icon  For more  information  please refer to Chapter 3   System Configuration      To upgrade the VX6 with a newer revision of system software  please refer to    Reflash the VX6   in Chapter 3     System Configuration        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    30 Hardware Configuration    Hardware Configuration    System Hardware    The VX6 hardware configuration is shown in the following figure                                                     Compact  Flash   o    Hor      PCMCIA Drive Secure Digital  Antenna Card Memory Card  Connector r1 n    CF SD  Slot Slot  SOS AA AO E e  A SI E  Ao Hl SIC KM UL  ENTER  E SES  AT SP Z x c y    E ON  M Home PgDn END E o DEL  Ww a  IN  Serial NE NE  Connector Mouse Connector  COM    Scanner Connector   9 pin male  D    Not Used   Serial USB
252. n        Manage Taskbar  Lock or Hide     Note the dimmed options  The Enabler can restrict user  access to other applications when the user interface is  accessed by either locking or hiding the taskbar        Program Shutdown  Continue or  Stop monitoring           The system administrator can control whether the  Enabler continues to monitor the Mobile Device Server  for updates once the Enabler application is exited        E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide       148 Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    Scan Config    Note  Scan Config functionality is a standard option of the Wavelink Avalanche System but is  not currently supported by LXE on Windows CE     Avalanche Update Settings    B       Figure 3 44 Scan Config Option    Display    Avalanche Update Settings       Figure 3 45 Window Display Options    Update Window Display    The user interface for the Enabler can be configured to dynamically change based on the status of  the connection with the Mobile Device Server     At startup Half screen  Hidden or Full screen  Default is Half screen   On connect As is  Half screen  full screen  Locked full screen  Default is As is   Normal Half screen  Hidden or As is  Default is As is     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 149    Shortcuts    LXE recommends using LXE AppLock for this function  AppLock is resident on each mobile  device with a Windows OS  AppLock configuration instructions are located in Chapter 6     Avalanch
253. n    Multi Application AppLock    A mobile device running the Multi Application version of AppLock becomes a dedicated  dual  application device  Only the applications or features specified in the AppLock configuration by  the Administrator are available to the end user  This version offers a user mode taskbar icon  allowing the end user to switch between user applications     If your Administrator Control Panel has Application  Security and Status tabs  then the device  has LXE Multi Application AppLock installed  The Administrator can configure multiple  applications to lock and the end user can swap between the applications        Administrator Control    Filename    El Icon  El  Title  FO Order  la      Arguments       Internet  7 Menu Status    Global    Key   ctrl Spa y  Delay  fic       clear   Lale     APLCKPNET2BF          Figure 6 1 Multi Application AppLock    The configuration instructions in this chapter are designed for users of Multi Application  AppLock     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Introduction    265    Single Application AppLock    A mobile device running the Single Application version of AppLock becomes a dedicated  single  application device  In other words  only the application or feature specified in the AppLock  configuration by the Administrator is available to the user     If your Administrator Control Panel has Control  Security and Status tabs  then the device has  LXE s Single Application AppLock installed  The Administrator can configur
254. n  Discovered devices  without an icon can be paired as printers or scanners  the Bluetooth panel will assign an icon to  the device name     An icon with a red background indicates the device Bluetooth connection is inactive     An icon with a white background indicates the device is connected to the VX6 and the device  Bluetooth connection is active     Doubletap a device in the list to open the device properties menu  The targeted device does not  need to be active     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    96    Control Panel Options       LXEZ Pairing      Bluetooth Devices   Settings    Name Last 4      Bluetooth Address    LXEZ Pairing      Bluetooth Devices   settings    Name Last 4      Bluetooth Address          PrinterO1 12 34 00 20 E0 00 12 34      PrinterQ2     Bu ditti  Hs   ScannerO1 Pair as Scanner      76 00 AB CD  Scanner  2     S TE7A 00 1A 2B    PrinterO1 12 34 00 20 E0 00 12 34  ge Printer  2 LI   Scanner01 Pair as Scanner       76 00 AB CD  ScannerD2 UU  74 00 1A 2B       Pair as Printer 5   b    Disconnect  Properties             Pair as Printer  Delete D   Properties    Figure 3 11 Bluetooth Device Disconnect   Delete    Tap Pair as Scanner to set up the VX6 to receive data from the scanner     Tap Pair as Printer to set up the VX6 to send data to the printer     Tap Disconnect to stop the connection between the VX6 and a paired Bluetooth device     Tap Delete to remove an unpaired device from the Bluetooth device list  The device name and  identifier is 
255. n 258  CHAPTER 6 APPLOCK 263  IN a HOPS sre een a vse A E are A A E E A E a 263  D  terminine Your AppLock Versiot eed UDINE ARP Ge eae 264  Multi Application O A idane 264  Sinple Application Za Pc        ER 265  Setup a New DOOR 266  o  MAA A 267  Fand Usor MODO rsrsrs EEEE EAE 267  O A A 268  End User Switching Technique romina RR A 269  Usine qos  A A 269  Using the Switch Key DOQUEBESG ipie depen a EIN NM DM EUM MEE REM PME 269  Application Configuration aa 270  ApphicatiomP anel orasan n heo a 270  Launch O Ci    273  PCO  ACB OO E A E EE ET AOL E E TET E E utpes 273  Auto RELAIS E N aes  274  Mamah Laune Hocine E 274  Alloy Clos e AO IAO O EE I E TARNE 274  Medea o 219  End User Internet Explorer  ELE  ri pi ica 275  SA PA A UE 276  UCSC 6 2  RR ERE NETT ROR a HC rr MRR ye BEE eCRP EEE ORT Term eh Rene ReaD 217  A A net ebat Ec 27   A A dud iM de 217  o A du Uia MMC  AT   A E TES 2T  SAS Pane id ii Ai 278  Lg  A NE 278  P  c                                                                           219   E LAE MORENO E 219  Troubleshooting AppLock rui pnt Pia pd XR RRKRI DU KENN AK RE RIRURN RRR ARMAR RO 280    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents xi    APPENDIX A KEY MAPS 281  TIE VAR Sir    OO               281  Key Map 101 Koy EQUIVISTCIOS isccrrcinninaneiacananniacinicrin cnica rre al 281  IBM 3270 Terminal Emulator Keypad     cocoonnncccccncccccccnnnnnnnnanaccncnenonnnnnnananccnenenenos 286  IBM 5250 Terminal Emulator Keypad                        
256. n Properties    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    114 Control Panel Options    Owner    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Owner Icon  Set VX6 owner details        Factory Default Settings  Identification   Blank  Notes Blank                      There is no change from general desktop PC Owner Properties display  Enter the information and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately        Owner Properties    Identification   Notes   Network ID  At Power On    Name     _  Display owner identification    Company       Address  Work     Home     Area code  Phone        Figure 3 26 Owner Properties    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    Password    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Password Icon    Set VX6 access power up password properties        Factory Default Settings       Password    Blank          At Power On          Disabled       115    Note  Once a password is assigned  the Owner and Password Control Panel options require  the password to be entered before the Control Panel option can be accessed  If you  forget the password  it cannot be restored without performing a cold boot on the unit   which erases all memory      Enter the password  then type it again to confirm it and click the OK box to save the changes  The  password is immediately in effect     Tap the Power On checkbox to set whether the user types a password at Power On     Tap the Screen Saver checkbox to set whether the user typ
257. n and procedures are contained in Chapter 3     System Configuration        Windows CE   NET 4 2 Operating System    LA For general use instruction  please refer to commercially available Windows CE  user s guides or the Windows CE on line Help application installed with the VX6     This chapter   s contents assume the system administrator is familiar with Microsoft Windows  options and capabilities loaded on most standard Windows computers     Therefore  the sections that follow describe only those Windows capabilities that are unique to the  VX6 and its Windows CE environment     Wireless Network Configuration    Warmboot    Coldboot    All radio configuration is included in Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration        A warmboot reboots the computer without erasing any registry data  However  any applications  installed to RAM are lost  as is all data in RAM  This happens because the operating system is  stored on the flash drive  but must be loaded into RAM to run     All registry configurations are automatically preserved  Any applications stored as  CAB files in  the System directory and configured in the registry to persist are reinstalled on boot up by the  Launch utility     A coldboot reboots the computer  erases all registry data and returns the computer to factory  default settings  In order to be preserved  applications and data must be stored in the System  folder  Registry information is not preserved  Only factory default applications and drivers stored
258. n app still open The switch to user mode is being made via a hotkey LOG EX  press and the administrator has left the application open  and has not made any changes in the configuration   ToUser after admin no app or cmd If user mode is being entered via a hotkey press  the LOG EX  line change administrator may have left the configured application  open  If so  AppLock does not launch the application  again unless a new application or command line has  been specified  otherwise  it just locks it   E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide                                        338 AppLock Error Messages  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Unable to move desktop The desktop is moved when switching into user mode  LOG_ERROR  This prevents them from being visible if the application  is exited and restarted by the timer  This error does not  affect the screen mode switch  processing continues   Unable to move taskbar The taskbar is moved when switching into user mode  LOG_ERROR  This prevents them from being visible if the application  is exited and restarted by the timer  This error does not  affect the screen mode switch  processing continues   Unhook taskbar wndproc failure AppLock could not remove its control of the taskbar  LOG_ERROR  This error does not affect AppLock processing  Unhook wndproc failure AppLock could not remove the hook that allows LOG_ERROR  monitoring of the application   Unhooking taskbar In administration mode  the taskbar should return to LOG_EX 
259. n takes time  to launch and then initialize before a display a window is created  use this delay to specify the  delay period     Replace timeout  This timeout specifies the period of time  in milliseconds  for AppLock to wait after an initial  screen  like a password prompt screen  is replaced by another application window    Restart timeout    This specifies the period of time  in milliseconds  for AppLock to wait for an application to  restart  If the application fails to restart automatically  AppLock then proceeds according to the  options selected when the application was configured on the Application and Launch panels     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    278    Application Configuration    Status Panel    View    Use the Status panel to view the log of previous AppLock operations and to configure which  messages are to be recorded during AppLock operation     Status information is stored in a specific location on the storage device and in a specific logfile  specified by the Administrator  For this reason  the administrator can configure the type of status  information that is logged  as well as clear the status information        Administrator Control El OK Ea       Application Security Options Status  Filename    System applock  Ext  zs     View    Level   None v      Log    Level    None v                  Figure 6 8 Status Panel    Move the cursor to the Filename text box and either type the logfile path or tap the Browse button   the     button   The standard W
260. name and Password when connecting to the  network        Credentials E  User  user2    Password  LXE       Figure 5 17 LEAP Credentials       Enter the Domain Username  if the Doman is required   otherwise enter the Username  Enter the  password and click OK     Once configured  click the Commit button  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the  Main tab and warmboot  The SCU Main tab shows the device is associated after the radio  connects to the network     VX6 Reference Guide    208 Summit Radio    PEAP MSCHAP  To use PEAP MSCHAP  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to PEAP MSCHAP  e Set Encryption to WPA TKIP  e Set Auth Type to Open    Summit Client Utility     put          m             Figure 5 18 PEAP MSCHAP    Please review    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials  earlier in this chapter   Click the Credentials button     e No entries except the CA Certificate Filename are necessary for Sign On Credentials  as the user will be prompted for the User Name and Password when connecting to  the network     e For Stored Credentials  User  Password and the CA Certificate Filename must be  entered     Enter these items as directed below     Credentials                Figure 5 19 PEAP MSCHAP Credentials    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 209    Enter the Domain Username  if the Doman is required   otherwise enter the Username   Enter the password    Leave the CA 
261. ncrypt generate key failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt get user key failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt get user key ok Encrypt password process successful  LOG_EX  Encrypt hash data failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt hash data from pwd OK Encrypt password process successful  LOG_EX  Encrypt length failure Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypt out of memory for key Unable to encrypt password  LOG_ERROR  Encrypted data OK The password has been successfully encrypted  LOG_EX  Enter AppLockEnumWindows In order for AppLock to control the application being LOG_EX   locked so it can prevent the application from exiting   AppLock launches the application and has to wait until  it has created and initialized its main window  This  message is logged when the function that waits for the  application initialization is entered   Enter DecryptPwd Entering the password decryption process  LOG_PROCESSING                   VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J                                                                                        AppLock Error Messages 333  Message Explanation and or corrective action Level  Enter EncryptPwd Entering the password encryption processing  LOG_PROCESSING  Enter FullScreenMode Entering the function that switches the screen mode  In LOG_PROCESSING  full screen mode  the taskbar is hidden and disabled   Enter GetAppInfo Processing is at the beginning of the function that LOG_PROCESSIN
262. nd    Hide Password           E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    352 Revision History    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    A    About  software  hardware  version  network IP     88  306  AC Adapter  Specifications                    sss 287  AC to DC Power Supply                  eee 69  Accessibility settings                 esses 91  309  Activation Key  ADDLOCI siu Dates linia 5  ActiveSync  ari s os 16  Cold Boot and Loss of Host Re connection      127  CA 16   Connect eae netu boites 16  126  Create Comm Option                    sse 129  EXPLOTE   coi tit ai 126  Heli 82  300  IR port transmission                      eene 82  300  ODDS osos enn 125  Prerequisites               sss 125  Setup Wiz iii 125  Troubleshooting                     sse 128  Use this cabl       ect tnn ede en 39  130  VOSTRA 82  300  ActiveSync version 3 8    13  Adapter Cable  VX1 2 4 Power Supply                    72  Add prefix and suffix control                             s 168  Admin Hotkey  ADDLDOCE niteat ed T RE 267  Allow  Clos ainia 274  Allow ComnectiOM   ooocccnnccccnononccononnncnonanancnnnos 116  320  Antenna  Connector  Locati0M      oooooccnncccnononcconnnancnonananoss 6  8  Diversity  Rec Sinai e ea 196  A E E a 195  External ie e ee ees 50  A emere eee 51  APC css educ eniin Pes 134  Appearance  Sheme etie ese NE 102  313  Application Panel                     eenee 270  AppLock  End user mode                    sse 267  EUIB ec oi e eno 275  Hotkey for Administrator     
263. nd a separate private key file  Windows CE equipped    devices such as the V X6 require the private key to be saved as a separate file rather than including  the private key in the user certificate        Microsoft Certificat es    johndoe    Welcome    Use this Web site to request a certificate for your Web browser  e mail client  or other program  By  using a certificate  you can verify your identity to people you communicate with over the Web  sign and  encrypt messages  and  depending upon the type of certificate you request  perform other security  tasks     You can also use this Web site to download a certificate authority  CA  certificate  certificate chain  or  certificate revocation list  CRL   or to view the status of a pending request     For more information about Certificate Services  see Certificate Services Documentation     Select a task   Request a certificate    View the status of a pending certificate request  Download a CA certificate  certificate chain  or CRL       Figure 5 88 Certificate Services Welcome Screen    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    254    Certificates    Click the Request a certificate link        Microsoft Certificate Services    johndoe    Request a Certificate    Select the certificate type   User Certificate    Or  submit an advanced certificate request     Figure 5 89 Request a Certificate Screen    Click on the advanced certificate request link     Microsoft Certificate Services    johndoe       Advanced Certificate Request  The 
264. nd line none    End User Mode    End user mode locks the end user into the configured application or applications  The end user  can still reboot and respond to dialog boxes  Each application is automatically launched and runs  in full screen mode when the device boots up     The user cannot unintentionally or intentionally exit the application nor can the end user execute  any other applications  Normal application exit or switching methods and all Microsoft defined  Windows CE key combinations  such as close  X  icon  File Exit  File Close  Alt F4  Alt Tab  etc   are disabled  The Windows CE desktop icons  menu bars  task bar and system trays are not visible  or accessible  Task Manager is not available     If the end user selects File Exit or Close from the applications menu bar  the menu is cleared and  nothing else happens  the application remains active  Nothing happens when the end user clicks  on the Close icon on the application   s title bar and the application remains active     Note  A few applications do not follow normal procedures when closing  AppLock cannot  prevent this type of application from closing  but is notified that the application has  closed  For these applications  AppLock immediately restarts the application which  causes the screen to flicker  If this type of application is being locked  the administrator  should close all other applications before switching to end user mode to minimize the  screen flicker     Windows accelerator keys such as Al
265. nds on what authentication protocol is  to be configured     e Cisco PEAP should not be installed if using PEAP MSCHAP   e Cisco PEAP must be installed if using PEAP GTC     e  Forall other authentications  LEAP  EAP TLS  WPA PSK  it does not matter if  Cisco PEAP is installed or not     To determine if Cisco PEAP is installed or to change the installation  follow the instructions  below     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    224 Cisco Radio    Checking for the Cisco PEAP Supplicant    With a Cisco radio installed  open the Wireless network properties as described in    Wireless  Network Configuration     later in this chapter  With the Authentication tab selected check the text  in the EAP type drop down box  Refer to the following figures to determine if Cisco PEAP is  installed     Wireless Network Properties  Network name  SSID    peapTest     This is a computer to computer  ad hoc     Wireless network key  WEP   This network requires a key for     Encryption   TKIP     Authentication   we A  y      network  wireless access points are not used    Network key    Key index  fr Key provided automatically    IEEE 802 1X Authentication  Enable 802 1  authentication on this network    EAP type   PEAP y     Figure 5 36 No Cisco PEAP          Wireless Network Properties    Network name  SSID   peanTest       This is a computer to computer  ad hoc      i    i jpeapTest network  wireless access points are not used  Wireless network key  WEP     This network requires a kev for     
266. nfiguration VX6        Cisco Aironet Configuration Utility  ACU         Symbol         Accessibility    and    Date Time    sections     Added    2 4GHz Radio Configuration        Disabling the Touchscreen  Heater        Configuring CapsLock Behavior    and    Configuring IPv6  Broadcast Messages    sections     Removed    Cisco     Aironet Configuration Utility  ACU     and    Symbol     sections  This information is now included in Chapter 5     Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Added new chapter containing sections removed from Chapter 4   Configuration  Appendix A     Key Maps Revised    Keymap Source Format    and    COLxROWx Format    sections     Revision C  October 2005    Chapter 1     Introduction Updated    When To Use This Guide       Updated    Accessories    list   Chapter 4     System Renamed    Configuring IPv6 Broadcast Messages  section to    Configuring  Configuration IPv6    and revised section        Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Revised    Introduction    and    Cisco     Aironet Client Utility  ACU     section     Configuration Renamed    Configuring VX6 Radio    to    Configuring VX6 Radio Without  WPA        Added    WPA for the VX6    section        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    348 Revision History    Revision D  2006    Revised    Accessories    listing     Chapter 2     Physical Revised    On Off Switch        Scanner Serial Connector  COM1        Description and Layout    Printer PC Serial Connector  COM3         Install the 2 4GHz Type I
267. ng Temperature  Specifications              289   Storage Temperature  Specifications                  289  USB   Connector 41  USB Connector  Location    ooooconoccccnononccononancnnonnnanonos 7  USB  MOUSE Gr rtr iere EAR eS oeedue 11  User Certificates   Generatii p ti E I Erden 253   Installing on VX6                   sss 258  User specific application version information 88  306  Utilities  c teo RD ODD DURS 131  VX6 Reference Guide    Index    V    Vehicle Chassis Ground                          esee 47  Vehicle Power             sese ee 32  69   Adapting VX1 2 4 Power Supply                         72  Video Subsystem                    esee 31  View   Display    ice iti ettet testes Eres dert 60  Viewing Area  Specifications                 sess 289  Virtual Keyboard                     sess 103 314  VE Code List  unitur ruo Ut RES 340    Warmboot    2 seit taraen 24  WARMBOOT  EXE    cccscccsseeseeseesceteeseeseeneeseeesens 133  WAVPLAY EXE  o  ececccecccsesccseeeecnseseeeeeseseeseeeens 133  Wedge                 159  Wedge  Barcode  acier tenis 157  WEP   Cisco Radio    eiie nnne 221   Summit Radio                  ssssseseeeee 205   Symbol Radio                       sss 247  When to use this guide                      sss 2  Windows   Network Configuration                   esses 137  Windows CE on line Help                                79  297  Windows Explorer                          eee 85  303  Windows version    cccoooccccnononccnnoncccnnnnnccrnnnanoos 12
268. ng the appropriate detachable cordset  In all cases  connect  the external AC supply to a properly grounded source of supply provided with maximum 15 Amp  overcurrent protection  10 Amp for 230V circuits      Note    Instructions for using this configuration are contained in  VX6 User s Guide  section  titled  Installation      E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    70 Power Supply    Specifications    3 40    x 5 87  x 2 00   Power  ON  Indicator  Input Surge Current   included with US units only     Output Voltage     8   measured at the end of the output  Tolerance power cable    Output Current 0 Amps min  1 87 Amps max    Safety and Emissions FCC  Part 15  Radio Frequency Devices   Compliance Class B     EN 55022  UL1950 and IEC 950          Environmental Specifications    The AC to DC adapter will withstand the following environmental characteristics     Operating Temperature see VX6 Environmental Specifications  Storage Temperature see VX6 Environmental Specifications    Humidity Operates in a relative humidity of   5     95   non condensing     ESD Immunity Per IEC 801 1       VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Power Supply 71    Vehicle 12 80VDC Direct Connection    Note  Instructions for using this configuration are contained in    VX6 User s Guide    section  titled    Installation        1  To Vehicle Battery    2  To Vehicle  Mounted Device  or UPS Battery  Pack    3  White  DC    4  Black  DC    5  6                      Green  GND   12 80VDC    Figure 2 41 Direct 
269. ning  18AWG wires     Do not use this cable with VX1 2 4 DC power cables with gray colored cable  containing 22AWG wires  These power cables must be replaced with a VX5 6 7  power cable         gt     Caution     When a DC power cable that is eight feet or longer is in a 12V application  there  may be an excessive voltage drop over the longer cable  If this occurs  a new  power cable is required         gt        Caution        Do not use this adapter with AC power supplies originally designed for the 1380   1390  VX1  VX2 or VX4  These power supplies do not have sufficient power for  the VX6           VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Power Supply 73    CMOS Battery    The LXE VX6 has a permanent 190 mAh Lithium battery installed to maintain time  date and  CMOS setup information  The lithium battery is not user serviceable and should last five years  with normal use before it requires replacement     Fuse    The VX6 uses a 100V  10A time delay  slow blow   high current interrupting rating fuse that is  externally accessible and user replaceable  Should it need replacement  replace with same size   rating and type of fuse     Littlefuse 0234010 or Optifuse MSC 10A  5x20mm      1  Fuse    2  Twist in this  direction to  remove    3  Twist in this  direction to insert       Figure 2 45 Fuse Replacement    Caution  Fuse has voltage on it even when power is off  Always disconnect input power    i before changing fuse     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    74 Power Supply  
270. nnons 119  Registry and save settings                sss 24  Registry content   back up location                     sese 124  Registry settings   APPL OCK cacon 339  REGLOAD EXE                 esee nennen 133  Remote desktop connection                              85  303  Remove user installed programs                      119  323  hoc EE 105  315  Replacement    ete meret 169  Resol atari tobera 31  Resolution  Specifications                       esses 289  Revers   Polarity            eicere tr 71  Revision History    347  Revision Level   Hardware               eese 29  180  223   SO ALC C       X    29  Root CA Certificates   Generating    iiie der RR ERR Ee 249   Installing on VX6                   sss 251  RS 232   Data ENY iii ia 9  Rules   match list    eor 167   Match list        orte orte 167    S    Save Settings ie E UR ee 24  Scan Keys   Left and Right                      sss 157  Scanner   and Pin 9 on COMI              see 37    E EQ VX6RG J    357  Data entry    teer Rer tetas 9  Scanner Control Characters Tab                             169  Screen blanking                 rec 176  Cable  oma mn MI MU 40  SD Flash Cards  CAB Files and Programs              124  Secondary Mode LED Indicator                               54  Security Options  Wirerless                   sss 179  Security Panel  Applesana natales 276  Security Password  AppLock cerier nissene tr apisia 277  Send Key Messages and Wedge                            159  Serial Cable  for Activ
271. ntrol Action   CAN 17  X CANcel line Ctrl x  EM 19  Y End of Medium Ctrl y  SUB la  Z SUBstitute Ctrl z          VK CONTROL  0x11 down  VK PACKET  0xe7  down  ESC 1b A ESCape WM_CHAR 0x1b  VK_PACKET up  VK_CONTROL up          VK CONTROL  0x1 1 down  VK_PACKET  0xe7  down  FS lc N File Separator WM CHAR 0xlc   VK PACKET up   VK CONTROL up          VK CONTROL  0x11 down  VK PACKET  0xe7  down  WM CHAR 0x1d down   WM CHAR  0x1d  up   VK PACKET up   VK CONTROL up    GS Id    Group Separator          VK CONTROL  0x11 down  VK SHIFT  0x10  down  WM CHAR 0x36 down   WM CHAR 0x36 up   VK SHIFT up   VK CONTROL up    RS le A Record Separator          VK CONTROL  0x11  down  VK SHIFT  0x10  down   VK PACKET  0xe7  down  US If 2 Unit Separator WM CHAR 0x1f   VK PACKET  0xe7  up   VK SHIFT  0x10  up   VK CONTROL  0x11  up                                                                         VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    343    Hat Encoding    Hat Encoding    The VX6 supports only 7 bit hat encoding which means only    through    underscore  are supported     Desired    Desired Hat  A  A     Underscore         EO  E VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    344    Desired Hat    VX6 Reference Guide       Hat Encoding    Desired       E EQ VX6RG J    Decimal   Hexadecimal Chart 345    Decimal   Hexadecimal Chart    Oo Be UNEO  oa         5            c  X XA X X X X  OB WN EPR o  CX 0 Cx    x a e  S O 6 O Sa          ono             a 6c oc oO o   a c c c col     iX OX X X X           
272. ntrol Tab  Slot 2    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide                                           118 Control Panel Options  Power  Depending on the Software Revision  some devices may have a Schemes tab   Factory Default Settings  Switch state to User Idle Never  Switch state to System Idle Never  Switch state to Suspen Never  The Schemes tab can be used to control the display backlight and shut the VX6 Off  The mode  timers are cumulative  The System Idle timer begins the countdown after the User Idle timer has  expired and the Suspend timer begins the countdown after the System Idle timer has expired  For  example  if the User Idle timer is set to Never  the power scheme timers never place the device in  User Idle  System Idle or Suspend modes   For a VX6  the User Idle state turns off the display backlight  There is no System Idle mode so  the VX6 remains in User Idle mode until the Suspend timer expires or a primary even occurs   Please see    Power Modes    in Chapter 2     Physical Description and Layout      IMPORTANT  There is no Suspend mode on the VX6  If the Suspend timer is enabled  the  VX6 will shut down when the Suspend timer expires   Power Properties m OK E  Schemes   Device Status  Power Scheme  Jac Power y  3  Switch state to User Idle   Never y   Switch state to System Idle   Never y   Switch state to Suspend   Never y   Figure 3 31 Power Properties  The Device Status tab displays the status of power managed devices  Note that since the VX6  does not suppor
273. o Secundaria pb LN Oo e Rr EHE ls 204  WEP Encryption    sa iU v n c Hv vae a i rU i eve ee eratis 205  WER e MT EM 205  LEAP Configura coperta or a ie E ROO RR EH UH oasis 206  LEAP Credentials asit m no a t e HO RTT EH ORTHO TERRAE 207  PEAR  NUS CHAP dnce epe poi 208  PEAP MSCHAP Credential ssi niece iia 208  PEAPIMSGHAP Cerificate Palen anne oda ER CUR ex ERE reei  209  PEAPOTC  ch aa O eee 210  PEAP GTU Credential sic  tata dances 210  PEAP GTC Certficale Eilenatus  sas eed roni lr Heb ende Dun ire ER 211  WEXLEAP cape bp db oO A 212  WBAUJEEAP Credos ia AS 213  EXP ASTON aii ia 214  EAP EAST Credentials reniri E a re e Oe e ee tertie a 215  PAPAE enen Men IE AUCI UE IMS 216  EAPSTES Credential Ss usina aaa 216  EAP TLS Credentials iii 217  WPAPSE EDO Pino 218  PSK ENI adas aia 218  Cisco Aironet Client Utility ori sra leon EHE eant EORR 219  Cisco Profile Properties acu 220    Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents xvii    igure S 33 Cisco Prole WEBS unii esito HN aei e iere OE a s 221  Figure 5 36 No Cisco PEAP unio dr d i ER E LR E PR PH E ir Pellis RI I Tels 224  Figure  3 37 Cisco PEAP installed  coin 224  Bigute 5238 Cisco AC U Prolle Selection as 226  Figure 5 39 Cisco ACU Reboot MeSSaBe  cust ett n ertet ri otn ra at b pt f 226    Figure 5 40  Figure 5 41  Figure 5 42  Figure 5 43  Figure 5 44  Figure 5 45  Figure 5 46  Figure 5 47  Figure 5 48  Figure 5 49  Figure 5 50  Figure 5 51    Microsoft Wireless Connection  COR   occi etr Obere i et er Oe FED Rs 226  Wi
274. ode  The default hotkey sequence is  Shift Ctrl A     A 2    key keypress is an invalid keypress for a hotkey sequence     Move the cursor to the Hot Key text box  Enter the new hot key sequence by first pressing the  Shift state key followed by a normal key  The hotkey selected must be a key sequence that the  application being locked does not use  The hotkey sequence is intercepted by AppLock and is not  passed to the application     Input from the keyboard or Input Panel is accepted with the restriction that the normal key must  be pressed from the keyboard when switching modes  The hotkey sequence is displayed in the Hot  key text box with    Shift        Alt     and    Ctrl    text strings representing the shift state keys  The  normal keyboard key completes the hotkey sequence  The hotkey must be entered via the keypad   Some hotkeys cannot be entered via the Input Panel  Also  hotkeys entered via the SIP are not  guaranteed to work properly when switching operational modes     For example  if the    Ctrl    key is pressed followed by    A        Ctrl A    is entered in the text box  If  another key is pressed after a normal key press  the hotkey sequence is cleared and a new hotkey  sequence is started     A normal key is required for the hotkey sequence and is unlike pressing the normal key during a  mode switch  this key can be entered from the SIP when configuring the key  However  when the  hotkey is pressed to switch modes  the normal key must be entered from the 
275. ol Panel   Without this password  general users are unable to access the Control Panel to  disable the screen blanking feature  For more information on the Password feature   please refer    Password     earlier in this chapter     e AppLock can be used to restrict the general user s access to only certain programs   Since the user under AppLock cannot access the Control Panel  the user cannot  disable the screen blanking feature  For more information on AppLock  please refer  to Chapter 6     AppLock        Operation of the VX6 is unchanged except for the blank display  The keypad and touchscreen are  still enabled  however any input from they keypad  touchscreen or other device DOES NOT wake  up the display     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    178 Screen Blanking    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Chapter 5 Wireless Network Configuration    Introduction    The VX6 computer may have a Summit  Cisco or Symbol radio  The Summit radio is either an  802 11b g radio or an 802 11a b g radio  The Cisco and Symbol radios are 802 11b radios  The  radio can be configured for no encryption  WEP encryption or WPA security  N A with Symbol  radio      Certificates are necessary for many of the WPA authentications  Please refer to the    Certificates     section at the end of this chapter for more information on generating and installing certificates     Please refer to the table below for the security options supported for each radio type                                Security Op
276. on    Warmboot    Coldboot    All radio configuration is included in Chapter 5     Wireless Network Configuration        A warmboot reboots the computer without erasing any registry data  However  any applications  installed to RAM are lost  as is all data in RAM  This happens because the operating system is  stored on the flash drive  but must be loaded into RAM to run     All registry configurations are automatically preserved  Any applications stored as  CAB files in  the System directory and configured in the registry to persist are reinstalled on boot up by the  Launch utility     A coldboot reboots the computer  erases all registry data and returns the computer to factory  default settings  In order to be preserved  applications and data must be stored in the System  folder  Registry information is not preserved  Only factory default applications and drivers stored  as  CAB files in the System directory are loaded by Launch     A cold boot is initiated by running the Coldboot application in the Windows directory  This  application automatically cold boots the VX6  erasing any customer applied registry changes and  returning the VX6 to its factory settings     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    76 Installed Software    Installed Software    When you order a VX6 you receive the software files required by the separate programs needed  for operation and radio communication  The files are loaded by LXE and stored in subdirectories  in the VX6     This section lists the cont
277. one  Settings   Turn Off Bluetooth Disabled  Report when connection lost Enabled  Report when connected Disabled  Report failure to reconnect Enabled  Computer is connectable Enabled  Computer is discoverable Disabled  Prompt if devices request to pair Disabled  Continuous search Disabled                Bluetooth taskbar Icon state and Bluetooth device Icon states change as Bluetooth devices are  discovered  pair  connect and disconnect  There may be audible or visual signals as paired devices  re connect with the mobile device     e The default Bluetooth setting is On and all options on the Settings Panel are enabled     e The VX6 cannot be discovered by other Bluetooth devices when the Computer is  discoverable option is disabled  unchecked  on the Settings panel     e Other Bluetooth devices cannot be discovered if they have been set up to be Non   Discoverable or Invisible     e The mobile device can pair with one Bluetooth scanner and one Bluetooth printer     e Itis not necessary to disconnect a paired scanner and printer before a different  scanner or printer is paired with the VX6     e The Bluetooth device should be as close as possible  line of sight  to the mobile  device during the pairing process     Assumption  The System Administrator has Discovered and Paired targeted Bluetooth  devices for the VX6  The VX6 operating system has been upgraded to the revision level required  for Bluetooth client operation     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    94 Control Panel 
278. one GMT 05 00  Daylight Savings   Disabled                         Date Time Properties    Date Time    Current Time      8  02 12 AM        Time Zone      GMT 05 00  Eastern Time  US  amp  Canada  y     Automatically adjust clock for daylight saving       Figure 3 15 Date Time Properties    There is little change from general desktop PC Date Time Properties options  Adjust the settings  and click the OK box or the Apply button to save the changes  The changes take effect  immediately  Double tapping the time displayed in the Taskbar causes this display to appear     If an Internet connection is available  click the Sync button to synchronize time with a time server     The VX6 includes a GrabTime utility     e  GrabTime can be executed manually at any time by clicking the Sync button on this  control panel     e  GrabTime can be configured to synchronize the time at boot up  Please see     Enabling GrabTime     later in this chapter  for details     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 101    Dialing  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Dialing    Dialing Properties             Figure 3 16 Dialing    Set dialup properties for internal modems  not supplied supported by LXE   Tap the         and  follow the instructions in Help     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    102    Display    Access     Control Panel Options    Start   Settings   Control Panel   Display Icon    Set background graphic  color scheme appearance  and power scheme properties    
279. one input   Factory Default Settings  Master Volume   0dB  Record Gain 22 5dB  Sidetone 12 0dB  Input None  Input Boost Disabled  Mixer  Master Volume Record Gain  ode  4  22 5d8  KA  46 5dB  MA Ode   6 0 dB 6 0 dB  settings   The following options are available for Input  device   device   e Bluetooth     Reserved for future use   VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 317    Mouse    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Mouse    Set the double click sensitivity for stylus taps on the touchscreen     Network and Dialup Connections    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Network and Dialup Connections  Create a dialup  direct  or VPN connection on the VX6     To configure the VX6 to use DHCP or a fixed IP address  select the desired connection  The  default is to obtain an IP address via DHCP     A static IP address can be assigned by clicking the Specify an IP address radio button and entering  the desired IP address  subnet mask and gateway           Cisco Wireless Lan Adapter    Settings m OK E3  IP Address   An IP address can be  8  Obtain an IP address via DHCP   automatically assigned to this     computer  If your network    Specify an IP address   does not automatically assign   e     IP addresses  ask your network IP Address     administrator for an address Subnet Mask  MEE  and then type it in the space  gt     provided  Default Gateway  as          Figure C 13 Network Connection Properties    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    318 
280. ooooconoccnononcnononancnconananononnnnrnnns 60    E EQ VX6RG J    355  Hexadecimal   Decimal Equivalent  0x00 to  OXOE           cocer ertet tren 345  OxAO to OXFF                   eese eere 346  Hidden Keys    oed oe erased 53  Host Connection prerequisites                     esesssss 12  Hotkey  Apphock ariete ritieni fete 276  How To  Initiate Page Up command                                    55  Install Radio Card                           esses 63  Keyboard data entry   ooooconccnoconoconocccnncnnnonnnonnonanonos 9  Toggle 2nd key on and off                                   55  Toggle Caps Lock on and off                              55  A e O 55  HyperTerminal   oooooccciccnocanoccoonconnconccnnocnnonnnonnnonno 128  I  Icons  Explorer  Internet    79  297  My Computer               eese 79  297  My Documents   ococcccocccocnnoncnoncnnnconaconocinonnnos 79 297  Recycle Blaise 79 297  Idle Time smosso 102  313  Input Panel    2ossesnecodnme ee ope 103  314  Install  Equipment Needed                          sss 63  Iu m                     73  Type II 2 4GHz Radio Card                     63  67  68  Internet Explorer  AppLock                     eren 275  Radio card and ISP required                         84  302  Internet Options                     seen 104  315  CE 50        M  104  IP Address  O NS 113  317  vri                 P 113  317  K  Key Map  iemeee et vince tete PE HER Re ee ace 281  101 Key Chart    281  Hidden Keys                 ssssseseeeenree 53
281. ooth taskbar Icon state and Bluetooth LED states change as Bluetooth devices are  discovered  pair  connect and disconnect  There may be audible or visual signals as paired devices  re connect with the VX6  Only LXE printers or scanners are recognized and displayed in the  Bluetooth panel  All other Bluetooth devices are ignored              Taskbar Legend   Icon   3  Bluetooth module is connected to one or more of the targeted Bluetooth  device s    VX6 is not connected to any Bluetooth device    3 VX6 is ready to connect with any Bluetooth device   VX6 is out of range of all paired Bluetooth device s   Connection is  inactive                 Note  When an active paired device enters Suspend Mode  is turned Off or leaves the VX6  Bluetooth scan range  the Bluetooth connection between the paired device and the VX6 is  lost  There may be audible or visual signals as paired devices disconnect from the VX6     See Accessories for supported Bluetooth printers and scanners     AppLock  if installed  does not stop the end user from using Bluetooth applications  nor does it  stop authorized Bluetooth enabled devices from pairing with the VX6 while AppLock is in  control  See Chapter 6     AppLock for more information     See Also  Chapter 3     System Configuration  section titled Bluetooth     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Bluetooth    21    Bluetooth Barcode Reader Setup    Introduction    Please refer to the Bluetooth scanner manufacturer   s User Guide  it may be available
282. operties   Appearance options  Adjust the settings  and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately  The default is  Windows Standard   Backlight       Display Properties  Ed OK Fa  Background   Appearance Backlight    To save battery life  you can adjust when the backlight  automatically shuts off               Automatically turn off backlight while on battery power    Turn off after fac seconds  gt   of continuous idle time         Automatically turn off backlight while on external power    Turn off   2 minutes  gt   of continuous idle time     Figure C 10 Display Properties   Backlight Tab          Adjust the settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect  immediately  When the backlight timer expires  the display  display backlight and keyboard  backlight are all turned off     Note  The display can also be configured to turn off when the vehicle to which the VX6 is  mounted is in motion  This feature required a serial cable connection and is enabled  using the Scanner control panel  Please see    Screen Blanking    in Chapter 4     Scanner     for details     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    314 Control Panel Options    Input Panel    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Input Panel    Select the current key   data input method        Factory Default Settings   Input Method Keyboard  Allow applications to Disabled  change input panel state  Keys Small keys  Use gestures Disabled    Input Panel Properties 
283. or the currently associated authenticated Access  Point is stronger than  60 dBm but not stronger than  40 dBm    The signal strength for the currently associated authenticated Access  Point is stronger than  40 dBm    Wireless Zero Config Utility and the Summit Radio    The WZC utility has an icon in the toolbar that looks like networked computers with  a red X through them  indicating that Wireless Zero Config application is enabled  but the connection is inactive at this time  the VX6 is not connected to a network      You can use either the Wireless Zero Configuration Utility or the Summit Client  Utility to connect to your network  LXE recommends using the Summit Client  Utility to connect to your network  The Wireless Zero Configuration Utility cannot  control the complete set of security features of the radio     Select ThirdPartyConfig in the Active Profile drop down list as the active profile  Warmboot  the VX6  The Summit Client Utility passes control to Wireless Zero Config and the WZC  Wireless Information control panel  Using the options in the Wireless Zero Config panels  setup  radio and security settings     To switch back to the SCU  select any other profile in the SCU Active Config drop down list   except ThirdPartyConfig  Warmboot the VX6  Radio control is passed to the SCU     VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio    Main Tab    183    Summit Client Utility      Status   Diags   Global    Active Profile   Default y     SUMMIT Status  Associat
284. ormat in the   System folder  Click Start   Run and type prtscrn and click OK  or press Enter  There is a 10  second delay before the screen print is made  The device beeps and screen captured file   scrnnnnn bmp  is placed in the  System folder  The numeric filename is incremented by 1 each  time the PrtScrn function is activated  The command is not case sensitive     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    134 API Calls    API Calls    See Also  LXE CE API Programming Guide E SW WINAPIPG    The LXE CE API Programming Guide documents only the LXE specific API calls for the VX6  It  is intended as an addition to the standard Microsoft Windows CE API documentation  Details of  many of the calls in the LXE guide may be found in Microsoft   s documentation     The APIs documented in the programming guide are included in the file LXEAPI DLL  which is  in the standard Windows CE image on the VX6     For ease of software development  the files LXEAPI H and LXEAPI LIB are available on the  accessories CD  which are the C C   include files and the link library for the DLL  respectively     A full SDK is now included for Microsoft Embedded Visual C   4 0  which is available free on  the Microsoft website      VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Reflash the VX6 135    Reflash the VX6    Note  When reflashing  LXE recommends using a Compact Flash  CF  card that is greater  than 64MB  Files to be loaded on the CF card are  NK BIN  EBOOT NBO  XSCALE BIT    Requirements   e A screwdriver  not 
285. ote  The tethered access panel cover is not shown in the illustration above    Note  When this process is complete  reattach the access cover screws using a torque  wrench capable of measuring to 9 1 inch pounds  1 016  11 N m   The screws  must be fastened to 9 inch pounds each  The screws require a Phillips size 1  driver head     4  Re connect the power cord cable and turn the V X6 on     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Power Supply 69    Power Supply    AC to DC power input for the VX6 is delivered via an optional external power supply  See     External Power Supply        Vehicle power input for the VX6 is 12V to 80V DC nominal and is accepted without the need to  perform any manual operation within the VX6  See    Vehicle 12 80VDC Direct Connection     An  optional uninterruptible power supply  UPS  battery can be used with the vehicle DC power  supply     Power input is fused for protection and the fuse is externally accessible on the VX6     External Power Supply    1  AC Input Cable   US only     0 9     2  DC Output Cable    Figure 2 40 Optional Power Supply Cable    In North America  this unit is intended for use with a UL Listed ITE power supply with  output rated 12     80 VDC  minimum 75 W  Outside North America  this unit is intended  for use with an IEC certified ITE power supply with output rated 12     80 VDC  minimum  75 W     The external power supply may be connected to either a 120V  60Hz supply or  outside North  America  to a 230V  50Hz supply  usi
286. ou want does not exist  double click Make New Connection     Give the new connection an appropriate name  Click the Direct Connection radio button   Click the Next button     From the popup menu  choose the port you want to connect to  Only the available ports are  shown     Click the Configure    button     Under the Port Settings tab  choose the appropriate baud rate  Data bits  parity  and stop bits  remain at 8  none  and 1  respectively     Under the Call Options tab  be sure to turn off Wait for dial tone  since a direct connection  will not have a dial tone  Set the timeout parameter  default is 90 seconds   Click OK     TCP IP Settings should not need to change from defaults  Click the Finish button to create  the new connection     Close the Remote Networking window     To activate the new connection select Start   Settings   Control Panel   PC Connection and  click the Change button     Select the new connection  Click OK twice   Close the Control Panel window   Connect the desktop PC to the VX6 with the appropriate cable     Click the desktop Connect icon to test the new connection     You can activate the connection by double clicking on the specific connection icon in the Remote  Networking window  but this will only start an RAS  Remote Access Services  session  and does  not start ActiveSync properly     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    130 Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync    Technical Specifications     Connection Cable    The exact serial cable is cruc
287. our desktop computer  and    e customize your synchronization settings     Because ActiveSync is already installed on your device  your first synchronization process begins  automatically when you finish setting up your desktop computer in the ActiveSync wizard     Prerequisites    VX6 and ActiveSync Partnership  A partnership between the VX6 and ActiveSync has been established  See section    ActiveSync      Initial Setup    in Chapter 1    Introduction        Getting Started       Serial Port Transfer    e A desktop or laptop PC with an available serial port and a VX6 with a serial port   The desktop or laptop PC must be running Windows 95  98  NT  2000 or XP     e Null modem cable with all control lines connected  LXE recommends using the null  modem cable part number listed in Chapter 1    Introduction     subsection     Accessories        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    126 Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync    USB Transfer    e A desktop or laptop PC with an available USB port and a VX6 with a USB port  The  desktop or laptop PC must be running Windows 98 SR2  2000 or XP     e A standard USB cable with a type A plug on one end  and a type B plug on the    other   Connect  Connect the modem cable to the PC  the host  and the VX6  the client   Select    Connect    from the  Start Menu on the VX6  Start   Programs   Communications   Connect    Note  Run    Connect    when the    Get Connected    wizard on the host PC is checking COM  ports to establish a connection for 
288. out the ATA card     The SD slot accepts an SD memory card  These cards are hot swappable     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Hardware Configuration 33    Bluetooth LXEZ Pairing    The VX6 contains Bluetooth version 2 0 with Enhanced Data Rate  EDR  up to 3 0 Mbit s over  the air  Bluetooth device connection  or pairing  can occur at distances up to 32 8 ft  10 meters   Line of Sight  The wireless client retains wireless connectivity while Bluetooth is active     The user will not be able to select PIN authentication or encryption on connections from the HX3   However  the HX3 supports authentication requests from pairing devices  If a pairing device  requests authentication or encryption  the VX6 displays a prompt for the PIN or passcode   Maximum encryption is 128 bit  Encryption is based on the length of the user   s passcode     Bluetooth will simultaneously support one printer as a slave Bluetooth device and one scanner   either as a slave or as a master Bluetooth device   See Chapter 3 System Configuration  control panel section titled Bluetooth   Notes  e The VX6 does not have a Bluetooth managed LED   e The LED on the Bluetooth scanner illuminates during a scanning operation     e Barcode data captured by the Bluetooth scanner is manipulated by the settings in the VX6  Scanner Properties control panel applet     e Multiple beeps may be heard during a barcode scan using the Bluetooth scanner  beeps  from the Bluetooth scanner as the barcode data is accepted rejecte
289. ovides access to the Summit Client Utility  SCU   For details on the SCU  please see Chapter  5  Wireless Network Configuration     Note  This Control Panel icon is not present with some versions of the SCU     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    124 CF Flash Cards  CAB Files and Programs    CF Flash Cards  CAB Files and Programs    The Flash card  located under the main battery pack  is intended to protect the user from losing the  LXE drivers and configuration information in the event of a cold boot  Also  on any boot  the    contents of any registered CAB files are automatically unpacked     Access Files on the Flash Card  Tap the My Device icon on the Desktop then tap the System icon     Files    A flash card is used for permanent storage of the LXE drivers and utilities  It is also used for  registry content back up  The flash card is located in the socket under the main battery pack     CAB files  when executed  are not deleted           SUMMIT CAB Summit Client files needed for network card operation   The following CAB files are optional and may or may not be present   BLUETOOTH CAB Bluetooth Client files needed for LXEZ Pairing operation   LXE_VX3C_ENABLER CAB Wavelink Avalanche Enabler    RFTERM CAB RFTerm terminal emulation application    JAVA CAB Java application    APPLOCK CAB AppLock program  See Chapter 6    AppLock              Note  Always perform a warm reset  Start   Run   Warmboot  when exchanging one flash card    for another     VX6 Reference Guide    E 
290. p  is first created  An ActiveSync partnership between a unique client can be established to two  hosts     If the VX6 is cold booted  the random number is deleted     and the partnership with the last one of  the two hosts is also deleted  The host retains the random numbers and unique names of all  devices having a partnership with it  Two clients cannot have a partnership with the same host if  they have the same name   Control Panel   System   Device Name     If the cold booted VX6 tries to reestablish the partnership with the same host PC  a new random  number is generated for the VX6 and ActiveSync will insist the unique name of the VX6 be  changed  If the VX6 is associated with a second host  changing the name will destroy that  partnership as well  This can cause some confusion when re establishing partnerships with hosts     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    128 Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync    Troubleshooting    ActiveSync on the host says that a device is trying to connect  but it cannot identify it     One or more control lines are not connected  This is usually a cable problem  but on a laptop or  other device  it may indicate a bad serial port     ActiveSync indicator on the host  disc in the toolbar tray  turns green and spins as soon as you    connect the cable  before clicking the Connect icon  or REPLLOG EXE in the Windows  directory         One or more control lines are tied together incorrectly  This is usually a cable problem  but on a  laptop or ot
291. p Recalibrate     Recalibrate    Figure 3 32 Stylus Properties   Recalibration Start          Carefully press and briefly hold stylus on the center of the target   Repeat as the target moves around the screen   Press the Esc key to cancel        Figure 3 33 Stylus Properties   Recalibration    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    121                                  System  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   System Icon  Review System and Computer data and revision levels  Adjust Storage and Program memory  settings   Factory Default Settings  General N A  Memory 1 3 storage  2 3 program memory  Device Name VXC0001  Device LXE_VXC  Description  Copyrights N A  General          System     Computer     System Properties ka OK E  General   Memory   Device Name   Copyrights      System   Microsoft   Windows   CE  NET  Wersion 4 20         1996 2003 Microsoft Corp  All  rights reserved  This computer  program is protected by U S  and  international copyright laws              Computer     Processor Type   intel Corp   ARM XSca  Expansion Slots       gt      Memory  36044 KB RAM                    Registered to        Figure 3 34 System   General tab    This screen is presented for information only  The System parameters cannot be  changed by the user     The processor type is listed  The type cannot be changed by the user  The name of  the installed radio card is listed in the dropdown list  Total computer memory and  the identification of the regis
292. ping operations have already occurred  stripping  settings do not affect the suffix  The suffix is added to the output buffer for the  Symbology selected from the pulldown list  If    All    is selected  the suffix is  added for any symbology that has not been specifically configured     See    Hat Encoding    and    Decimal Hexadecimal Chart    in Appendix B    Technical  Specifications        Note    Non ASCII equivalent keys in Key Message mode are unavailable in this option  Non   ASCII equivalent keys include the function keys  e g   lt F1 gt    arrow keys  Page up  Page  down  Home  and End     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation 169    Barcode   Ctrl Char Mapping  See Also  Barcode Processing Overview earlier in this chapter     The Ctrl Char Mapping button activates a dialog to define the operations the LXE Wedge  performs on control characters  values less than 0x20  embedded in barcodes  Control characters  can be replaced with user defined text which can include hat encoded or hex encoded values  In  key message mode  control characters can also be translated to their control code equivalent key  sequences            Control Character      Translate Al   control Character Replacement           Character  Replacement      uuu     Ianore drop           Figure 4 8 Barcode Tab   Ctrl Char Mapping    See    Hat Encoding  and    Decimal Hexadecimal Chart  at the end of Appendix B    Technical  Specifications      Translate All    When Translate All i
293. policy of the CA determines the types of certificates you can request  Click one of the following  options to    Create and submit a request to this CA     Submit a certificate request by using a base 64 encoded CMC or PKCS  10 file  or submit a  renewal request by using a base 64 encoded PKCS  7 file     Request a certificate for a smart card on behalf of another user by using the smart card certificate  enrollment station     Note  You must have an enrollment agent certificate to submit a request on behalf of another user     Figure 5 90 Advanced Certificate Request Screen    Click on the Create and submit a request to this CA link     V X6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Certificates 255    Microsoft Certifica es    johnd       Advanced Certificate Request    Certificate Template                 User E  Key Options        Create new key set    Use existing key set       CSP    Microsoft Enhanced Cryptographic Provider v1 0 El          Key Usage    Exchange    Key Size   1024   Min S80 512 1024 2048 4096 8192                     Automatic key container name    User specified key container name          Y Mark keys as exportable  v  Export keys to file  Full path name   userlkey pvk                         Enable strong private key protection                Store certificate in the local computer certificate store  Stores the certificate in the loca  computer store  instead of in the users certificate store  Does not  install the root CA s certificate  You must be an  adm
294. pped unconditionally  This is disabled by  default     Code ID Strips the Code ID based on the type code id specified in the Enable Code ID field  in the Barcode tab  Programmed custom identifiers are always checked  in the  order they are entered  and stripped  regardless of Enable Code ID setting  By  default  Code ID stripping is enabled for all symbologies  meaning code IDs will  be stripped  unless specifically configured otherwise      E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    166 Barcode Manipulation    Barcode Data Match List    Barcode This panel is used to strip data that matches the entry in the Match list from the  Data barcode  Enter the data to be stripped in the text box and tap the Insert or Add  button  The entry is added to the Match list     To remove an entry from the Match list  highlight the entry in the list and tap  the Remove button     Tap the OK button to store any additions  deletions or changes        Barcode Data    Figure 4 6 Barcode Data Match List          Barcode Data Edit Buttons       Add Entering data into the text entry box enables the Add button  Tap the Add  button and the data is added to the next empty location in the Custom ID list        Insert Tap on an empty line in the Custom ID list  The Add button changes to Insert   Enter data into both the Name and ID Code fields and tap the Insert button  The  data is added to the selected line in the Custom IDs list        Edit Double tap on the item to edit  Its values are copied to the text box
295. pt the Root CA certificate by name as shown below              Validate Server Certificate         N  You have connected to a server that is signed by Root Certification Authority   RFRootCA   which is different than the specified trusted CA  Do you want  to accept this connection   Warning  Connecting to a server signed with untrusted CA might compromise    your security           Figure 5 55 Server Connection Warning    If this is the correct server certificate Root CA  click OK  If not  install the correct Root CA as  described in  Installing a Root CA Certificate  in this chapter     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 235    By clicking OK  the Trusted root certificate box is filled in on the properties window     PEAP Properties    REROOtCA           Figure 5 56 PEAP Properties  Trusted Root Certificate  The same thing can be done for the Connect only if server name ends in field  Check the box and    leave the field blank  A prompt window will appear asking for confirmation of the correct server  name     Validate Server Certificate       Figure 5 57 Accept Server Connection Warning    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    236 Cisco Radio    PEAP Properties    Walidate server certificate  Connect only if server name ends in   RFRootACServer    Trusted root certificate    RFRootCA    Connect only if server is signed by  specified trusted root CA    Always try to resume secure session     Figure 5 58 PEAP Properties  Connect Only If Server Name Ends In       If
296. ptions    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel or My Computer   Control Panel    Getting Help    Please click the         box to get Help when changing Control Panel options     Option Function                                                                      About Displays hardware and software details    Accessibility Customize the way the keyboard  display or mouse functions    Administrator AppLock configuration   See Chapter 6     AppLock        Control   Aironet Client Utility   Set the parameters for a Cisco radio   See section    Start Menu  Program Options     only present if Cisco radio software installed     Bluetooth Discover and manage Bluetooth devices    Certificates Manage digital certificates used for secure communication    Date Time Set Date  Time  Time Zone  and Daylight Savings    Dialing Set dialup properties for internal modems  not supplied supported by  LXE     Display Set background graphic  color scheme appearance  and power scheme  properties    Input Panel Select the current key   data input method    Internet Options Set General  Connection  Security and Advanced options for Internet  connectivity    Keyboard Set key repeat delay and key repeat rate    Mixer Adjust the volume  record gain  and sidetone for microphone input    Mouse Set the double click sensitivity for stylus taps on the touchscreen    Network and Dial Set network driver properties and network access properties    Up Options   Owner Set VX6 owner details    Password Set VX6
297. quiring an end user response  memory resource issues requiring an  end user response  etc  Also at the administrator   s discretion  these types of applications can be  started manually  see Manual  Launch   by the end user     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Application Configuration 275    Match    Default is blank  match is not used      AppLock works by associating display windows with the launched process ID  If an application  uses different process IDs for windows it creates  the Match field must be used     Use the Match field to specify up to 32 characters of the class name for the application     For example  DOS applications using a standard DOS display box should specify condev_appcls  in the Match textbox     End User Internet Explorer  EUIE     AppLock supports applications that utilize Internet Explorer  such as  HTML pages and JAVA  applications  The end user can run an application by entering the application name and path in  Internet Explorer   s address bar     To prevent the end user from executing an application using this method  the address bar and  Options settings dialog are restricted in Internet Explorer  This is accomplished by creating an  Internet Explorer that is used in end user mode  End user Internet Explorer  EUIE EXE   The  EUIE executes the Internet Explorer application in full screen mode which removes the address  bar and status bar  The Options Dialog is also removed so the end user cannot re enable the  address bar     The administ
298. r and an input output  device connected to one of the VX6   s serial ports     e Touch the stylus to the field of the data entry form to receive the next data feed   e The cursor begins to flash in the field   e The unit is ready to accept data from either the keyboard or a device connected to a    serial port     Note  The touchscreen may be disabled  Please refer to  MX3 VXC Options    in Chapter 3    System Configuration  for details     Right Click    A right click can be simulated on the touchscreen  To perform a right click  touch the touchscreen  with the stylus and hold it in the same location for a short time     Note  Some applications may not support this right click method  Please review documentation  for the application to see if it provides for right mouse click configuration     Input Panel  Virtual Keyboard     Data may be entered via the input panel  virtual keyboard  on the touchscreen  For more details  on the input panel  please refer to Chapter 2   Physical Description and Layout      VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Data Entry 11    Touchscreen and Mouse    The behavior of the mouse pointer on the touchscreen varies by VX6 construction     To identify your VX6 platform type  please see    Identifying Your VX6   in  Chapter 2     Physical Description and Layout      Platform 1 VX6 s    Because the touchscreen also functions as a mouse  the pointer for a USB mouse may not always  be visible on the screen  The mouse pointer reappears when the USB mouse 
299. r button when the VX6 is  On  The VX6 is also off when it is not connected to a power source  However  an  internal Real Time Clock  RTC  powered by an internal battery maintains the date  and time while the VX6 is off     E EQ VX6RG J    Physical Controls da    Physical Controls    On Off Switch    The power  on off  switch is a push button switch located on the front control panel of the VX6   The switch is a momentary switch  If the VX6 is Off  pressing the power switch turns the VX6  On     For Platform 2 VX6   s  the keyboard LEDs turn on for about one second when the operating  system loads the keyboard driver  If the LEDs blink more than once  this indicates a keyboard  problem     e Onan external USB keyboard  the NumLock  CapsLock and Scroll Lock keys blink  the same as a desktop PC     e On the 60 key keyboard  only the CAPs led is lit during this process     To identify your VX6 platform type  please see    Identifying Your VX6     earlier in  this chapter     If the VX6 is On  pressing and releasing the power switch turns the VX6 Off  An orderly  shutdown is preformed  Any open programs are closed  the Windows CE operating system shuts  down and then the VX6 powers off     If a software lockup should occur and the VX6 is unresponsive to keyboard or touchscreen input   pressing and holding the power button for several seconds forces a shutdown  However  the  forced shutdown is not an orderly shutdown  All unsaved data and any registry settings not saved  to persist
300. r c                                                    es 48  PO                                                                    48  UPS Battery Extensi  n Cable CONCE dao iaa 49  jj  e        ac                                49  Jun dq 49  A T                       i            49  unn                                                         aa 49  A sicondi a equ e nin a M UD NE fes nM tx et Uta DES 50  Spread Spectrum RF Antenna Connector Pi  a HUP ERIIdUR 50  Veiicle Remote Antenna Mouni NR mm  50  T  kethgl ANTENNA iii iii 21  The QWERTY Keyboard irene 52  IBM S270 OVE lay ering R E aA Oa EEOSE EEE Eaa 52  IBM 5252 Overlay seeno a EAO LOEDE 52  A AM PP E EA                 53  Custom ey Maps eraen E E E E 53  Veo 33  Keyboard i   ART 23  Keyboard LEDS PM       M P 54  d vow A op T          Y                                 54  Secondary Keys LED e                   S 35  A CT                     r 56  General Windows CE Keyboard Shortcuts iia di 57  USB Keyboard Iii 37  Input Panel  Virtual fo  o7 P CET                          58    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    iv Table of Contents    Enabling the Dit Panel oir 59  TOS DIE         Y                                     60  Cl  anine the TIMERE ii 60  Mt ON TU LU ME 60  Touchscreen El atra 60  PCMCIA  GF and SD SlotS nina RR ED 61  PCMCIA SIO oaan bn II EIE IDE M RED DM 61  PCMCIA DIBOUEAG ia 62  Install PCMCIA Cards               eese eene e ne enne enennnnennnrer nest enint tn nnn a etes erai te dne 63  Instal
301. r can still  reboot the mobile device and respond to dialog boxes  The administrator specified application is  automatically launched and runs in full screen mode when the device boots up     See Also  Chapter 6    AppLock    for instruction     Wavelink Avalanche Enabler  Optional     The following features are supported by the Wavelink Avalanche Enabler when used in  conjunction with the Avalanche Molility Center  MC  Console     After configuration  Enabler files are installed upon initial bootup and after a hard reset  Network  parameter configuration is supported for     e IP address  DHCP or static IP  e RF network SSID  e DNS hosts  primary  secondary  tertiary   e Subnet mask  e Enabler update  Related Manual     Using Wavelink Avalanche on LXE Windows Computers        The VX6 has the Avalanche Enabler installation files loaded  but not installed  on the mobile  device when it is shipped from LXE  The installation files are located in the System folder on CE  devices  The installation application must be run manually the first time Avalanche is used     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    78 Installed Software    After the installation application is manually run  a reboot is necessary for the Enabler to begin  normal performance  Following this reboot  the Enabler will by default be an auto launch  application  This behavior can be modified by accessing the Avalanche Update Settings panel  through the Enabler Interface  The designation of the mobile device to the Ava
302. r stops searching for paired  Bluetooth devices that have lost connection  When  disabled  the VX6 stops searching after Y hour    Computer Friendly Empty The name  or identifier  entered in this space by the System   Name Administrator is used exclusively by Bluetooth devices and  during Bluetooth communication        Note  The Device Name listed in Start   Settings   Control Panel   System   Device Name is not  used during Bluetooth operation  Owner Identification name listed in Start   Settings    Control Panel   Owner   Identification is not used during Bluetooth operation     About          LXEZ Pairing   OK  x1    Bluetooth Devices   Settings   About       Computer Friendly Name      LXE BT Terminal    Bluetooth Address      00 40 FD 02 03 04          BTC version 1 0 BTDRGCESO1E  Bluetooth Stack Revision  1 3  Bluetooth Radio HCI 2 12288  Bluetooth Radio LMP 2 16907  Copyright 2006 2007 LXE Inc  y        Figure 3 14 Bluetooth About Panel    This panel lists the assigned Computer Friendly Name  that other devices may discover during  their Discovery and Query process   the Bluetooth MAC address  and software version levels  The  data cannot be edited by the user     VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    99    Easy Pairing and Auto Reconnect    The Bluetooth module can establish relationships with new devices after the end user taps the  Discover button  It can auto reconnect to devices previously known but which have gone out of  and then return
303. r to prevent automatic monitoring  upon startup     5  Select Stop Monitoring for an immediate shutdown of all enabler update functionality upon  exiting the user interface     6  Click the OK button to save the changes     7  Reboot the device if necessary     Update Monitoring Overview    There are three methods by which the Enabler on an LXE device can communicate with the  Mobile Device Server running on the host machine     e Wired via a serial cable between the Mobile Device Server and the LXE device     e Wired via a USB connection  using ActiveSync  between the Mobile Device Server  and the mobile device     e Wirelessly via the radio and an access point    After installing the Enabler on the mobile unit  a reboot is required for the Enabler to begin  normal functionality  Following a mobile device reboot  the Enabler searches for an Mobile  Device Server  first by polling all available serial ports and then over the wireless network  The  designation of the mobile device to the Avalanche Mobility Center Manager is LXE_VXC     The Enabler running on LXE Windows CE devices will attempt to access COMI  COM2  and  COM3     Agent not found    will be reported if the Mobile Device Server is not located or a serial  port is not present or available  COM port settings can be verified using the LXE scanner applet  in the Control Panel      The wireless connection is made using the default radio interface on the mobile device therefore  the device must be actively communicatin
304. rasure  etc   at all times  It may be required when pairing  connecting   and disconnecting new Bluetooth barcode readers        VX6 with Label    If the VX6 has a Bluetooth address barcode label attached  follow these steps     1  Scan the Bluetooth address barcode label  attached to the VX6  with the LXE Bluetooth  mobile scanner     2  If this is the first time the Bluetooth scanner has scanned the VX6 Bluetooth label  the devices  are paired  See section titled    Bluetooth Beep and LED Indications     If the devices do not  pair successfully  go to the next step     Open the LXEZ Pairing panel  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth    Tap Discover  Locate the Bluetooth scanner in the Discovery panel     Doubletap the stylus on the Bluetooth scanner  The right mouse click menu appears     Hs 9    Select Pair as Scanner to pair the VX6 with the Bluetooth mobile scanner     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide       22 Bluetooth    The devices are paired  The Bluetooth barcode reader responds with a series of beeps and LED  flashes  Refer to the following section titled    Bluetooth Beep and LED Indications        Note  After scanning the VX6 Bluetooth label  if there is no beep and no LED flash from the  Bluetooth device  the devices are currently paired     VX6 without Label    If the VX6 Bluetooth address barcode label does not exist  follow these steps to create a unique  Bluetooth address barcode for the VX6     First  locate the VX6 Bluetooth address by tapping Sta
305. rator specifies the EUIE by checking the Internet checkbox in the Application tab of  the Administrator applet  The internet application should then be entered in the Application text  box     When the Internet checkbox is enabled  the Menu and Status check boxes are available     Enabling the Menu checkbox displays the EUIE menu which contains navigation functions like  Back  Forward  Home  Refresh  etc   functions that are familiar to most Internet Explorer users   When the Menu checkbox is blank  the EUIE menu is not displayed and Navigation functions are  unavailable     When the Status checkbox is enabled  the status bar displayed by EUIE gives feedback to the  end user when they are navigating the Internet     If the standard Internet Explorer that is shipped with the mobile device is desired  it should be  treated like any other application  This means that IEXPLORER EXE should be specified in the  Application text box and the internet application should be entered in the command line  In this  case  do not check the Internet checkbox     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    276 Application Configuration    Security Panel       Administrator Control m OK A  Application Security Options   Status JE    Hot Key     mmo    Password     t o          Confirm Password     er o ooo             Figure 6 6 Security Panel    Hotkey    Specify the hotkey sequence that triggers AppLock to switch between administrator and user  modes and the password required to enter Administrator m
306. rd protected by the Administrator     End user mode locks the end user into the configured applications  The end user can still reboot  the mobile device and respond to dialog boxes  The administrator specified applications are  automatically launched in the specified order and run in full screen mode when the device boots  up     When the mobile device is reset to factory default values  for example after a cold reset  the  Administrator may need to reconfigure the AppLock parameters     LXE has made the assumption  in this chapter  that the first user to power up a new mobile device  is the system administrator     Note  AppLock Administrator Control panel file Launch option does not inter relate with  similarly named options contained in other LXE Control Panels     Note  A few applications do not follow normal procedures when closing  AppLock cannot  prevent this type of application from closing  but is notified that the application has  closed  For these applications  AppLock immediately restarts the application  see Auto  Re Launch  which causes the screen to flicker  If this type of application is being locked   the administrator should close all other applications before switching to end user mode  to minimize the screen flicker     AppLock is updated periodically as new options become available  Contact your LXE  representative for assistance  downloads and update availability     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    264 Introduction    Determining Your AppLock Versio
307. rd that has been set by the administrator  Enter this LXE back door key  sequence     Ctrl L Ctrl X Ctrl E  Or  Ctrl 5 Ctrl 9 Ctrl 3    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    End User Switching Technique 269    End User Switching Technique  Note  The touch screen must be enabled     Keyboard        v RFTerm EXE  v pword exe       Figure 6 3 Switchpad Menu    A checkmark indicates applications currently active or available for Launching by the user  When  Keyboard is selected  the VX6 default input method  Input Panel  Transcriber  or custom input  method  is activated     Using a Stylus Tap    When the mobile device enters end user mode  a Switchpad icon  it looks like three tiny windows  one above the other  is displayed in the taskbar  The taskbar is always visible on top of the  application in focus     When the user taps the Switchpad icon  a menu is displayed showing the applications available to  the user  The user can tap an application name in the popup menu and the selected application 1s  brought to the foreground  The previous application continues to run in the background  Stylus  taps affect the application in focus only  When the user needs to use the Input Panel  they tap the  Keyboard option  Input Panel taps affect the application in focus only     The figure shown above is an example and is shown only to aid in describing how the user can  switch between applications using a stylus  The switchpad lists user applications as well as the  Keyboard option     See A
308. re C 20 Stylus Properties   Recalibration Start          Carefully press and briefly hold stylus on the center of the target   Repeat as the target moves around the screen   Press the Esc key to cancel        Figure C 21 Stylus Properties   Recalibration    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    325                                  System  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   System Icon  Review System and Computer data and revision levels  Adjust Storage and Program memory  settings   Factory Default Settings  General N A  Memory 1 3 storage  2 3 program memory  Device Name VXC0001  Device LXE_VXC  Description  Copyrights N A  General          System     Computer     System Properties ka OK E  General   Memory   Device Name   Copyrights      System   Microsoft   Windows   CE  NET  Version 4 20         1996 2003 Microsoft Corp  All  rights reserved  This computer  program is protected by U S  and  international copyright laws              Computer     Processor Type   intel Corp   ARM XSca  Expansion Slots       gt      Memory  36044 KB RAM                    Registered to        Figure C 22 System   General tab    This screen is presented for information only  The System parameters cannot be  changed by the user     The processor type is listed  The type cannot be changed by the user  The name of  the installed radio card is listed in the dropdown list  Total computer memory and  the identification of the registered user is listed and cannot be ch
309. reen when the VX6 is  used in an abrasive environment  For information on installing or removing the protective film   please refer to the    VX6 User   s Guide        Heater    Extended temperature versions of the VX6 contain a touchscreen heater  The touchscreen heater  can be disabled on Platform 2 VX6   s when not needed  Please see    MX3 VXC Options    in  Chapter 3     System Configuration        To identify your VX6 platform type  please see    Identifying Your VX6     earlier in  this chapter     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots 61    PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots    The VX6 has two PCMCIA slots  one Compact Flash slot and one Secure Digital slot  The  PCMCIA slots are stacked on top of each other and located on the right hand side of the opening   The PCMCIA slots support the Personal Computer Memory Card International Association   PCMCIA  2 1 standards  The upper slot is designated as Slot A and the lower slot is designated  as Slot B     Slot A accepts Type I or II PCMCIA cards  If a radio card is used  it must be installed in Slot A to  prevent damage to the internal radio cables  LXE supports only Type II radios     Slot B accepts Type I or II PCMCIA cards     The PCMCIA slots may be disabled by the user  To enable or disable a PCMCIA slot  select  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PCMCIA icon     The center slot is a Compact Flash slot  containing the CF ATA hard drive  This drive contains  the operating system and settings     The left s
310. reless Information Scrolls 227  Advanced  Wireless  Setting vita 227  Wireless Network Properties 228  PEAP MSCHAP Wireless Network Properties    n rrt npo Per ede 229  Authentication Seltinps   cie tbe obio iaa lupa E Ye EO EE RR CHEER EGG 220  Wireless Network Loe e EET 230  IP Information Taba iaa adri 230  Authentication Settings  Validate Server sss iue do io ri rr e RESP n raea tie road dido 231  Advanced Wireless Settings  Authenticated SSID s sid irisse percer teer aee rr eroe x Sr Pur teie 231  PEAP GTC  Wireless  Network Properties    a aicanneotani dnm eve de on erus 232  PEAP Prop dms eet T  C                                    232    Figute 532 Login SOEC sorarrain E N E AN EeR ER FUITE aes cea ste me eee tens 233  Eigure 5 55  IP Information Db  aiite per REPE EURO FUSE USED rotos 233  Eipure5 54 PEAP Properties  Validate Server Cerbificate    iuo cepe rr ed berita aleaci  n 234  Eignie5 35 Server Connection WArpinga s ide daten ad oe E EDUARD ati Ed de gee 234  Figure 5 50 PEAP Properties  Trusted Root Certificate incisos nooo alone idear 235  Figure 5 57 Accept Server Connection  Warning icon alcoi i ieaie lola aaa 235  Figure 5 58  PEAP Properties  Connect Only If Server Name Ends In         cei eret eee 236  Eigure5 59  Wireless Information  Authenticated   uiuere eren ERRARE Un HE PEE e ERE AE RSSA EAEAP EERE 236  Eienre5 60  ACU Prone  Tabasco emen ole m uri RE RETE DI 237  Figure 5 61 Renan Prol tenor Ota Tae aE EIE 237  Eiente 5 52 ProBble Properties  cr
311. removed from the VX6 Bluetooth Devices panel after the user taps OK     Bluetooth Device Properties    Bluetooth Properties E       Name   ET    Bluetooth Address   00 20 E0 00 12 34    COD    0x8B00614    Subclass     COM port       Status   not paired    Figure 3 12 Bluetooth Device Properties Menu    Data on the Bluetooth Properties panel cannot be changed by the user  The data displayed is the  result of the device Query performed during the Discovery process     The Status dialog box reflects the current state of the highlighted device     VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    Settings    Turn Off Bluetooth Button    97          LXEZ Pairing   OK  x      Bluetooth Devices   Settings   About             V  Report when connection lost Turn Off Bluetooth    L Report when reconnected   v  Report failure to reconnect   v  Computer is connectable   y Computer is discoverable      Prompt if devices request to pair      Continuous search    Computer Friendly Name     Lx BT Terminal            Figure 3 13 Bluetooth Device Settings Panel    Tap the button to toggle Bluetooth hardware On or Off  The default value is Bluetooth On                 Options   Option Default   Information   Report when Enabled   There may be an audio or visual signal when a connection   connection lost between a paired  active device is lost  A visual signal may  be a dialog box placed on the display  Tap the X button or  OK button to close the dialog box    Report when Disabled
312. rength and quality  IP address  MAC    address  SSID  BSSID and Link speed  The user cannot edit this  information           E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide                                  144 Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration  Connection  Avalanche Update Settings  Connection   Server Contact   Startup Shut  Avalanche Server Address   Check serial connection      Disable ActiveSync      Restrict Adapter Link Speed  Min  Link Speed   1000 kbs  Figure 3 40 Connection Options  Avalanche Server   Enter the IP Address or host name of the Mobile Device Server assigned to  Address the mobile device  Check Serial Indicates whether the Enabler should first check for serial port connection  Connection to the Mobile Device Server before checking for a wireless connection to  the Mobile Device Server   Disable Disable ActiveSync connection with the Mobile Device Server   ActiveSync  Restrict Adapter  Link Speed  VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J       Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration 145    Execution    Note the dimmed options on this panel  This menu option is designed to manage downloaded  applications for automatic execution upon startup           Avalanche Update Settings OK E    Execution   server Contact   Startun Shut_ lt    gt     Auto Execute selection  Select Auto Execution App     Delay before execution  seconds      P       Figure 3 41 Execution Options  Dimmed        Auto Execute Selection An application that has been installed with the Avalanche Mobility
313. rews securing the access panel cover so the cover    can be removed  The screws are a captive part of the cover and cannot be removed     3  Remove the card currently installed present in the CF slot and replace it with the new CF  card  The replacement CF card must contain the operating system in order for the VX6  to operate        CF Card  Figure 2 38 Inserting the CF ATA Card    Note  The tethered access panel cover is not shown in the illustration above    Note  When this process is complete  reattach the access cover screws using a torque  wrench capable of measuring to 9 1 inch pounds  1 016411 N m   The screws  must be fastened to 9 inch pounds each  The screws require a Phillips size 1    driver head     4  Re connect the power cord cable and turn the VX6 on     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    68 PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots    SD Card Slot    The slot accepts a Secure Digital  SD  memory card  The card in this slot can be hot swapped     Note  Although cards in the SD slot may be hot swapped  the VX6 is not environmentally  sealed while the access panel cover is removed to hot swap cards     Install an SD Card  1  Turn the VX6 off and detach the power cable     2  Loosen the three  3  Phillips head screws securing the access panel cover so the cover  can be removed  The screws are a captive part of the cover and cannot be removed     3  Insert the card into the ATA SD  This slot accepts an SD memory card only        SD Card  Figure 2 39 Inserting the SD ATA Card    N
314. rograms   Communications   Connect      Note  Run    Connect    when the    Get Connected  wizard on the host PC is checking COM  ports to establish a connection for the first time     Cable for Serial ActiveSync Connection   Serial Client to PC Laptop RS 232 9 Pin to 9 Pin 9000A054CBL6D9D9    Note  You must establish a partnership with a desktop computer prior to running ActiveSync  on the VX6  The initial partnership must be done using direct serial   USB cable  connection     Once the relationship is established using the serial port  the ActiveSync link in the Start Menu  gives a choice of connections  one of which is radio     Select Start   Settings   Programs   Communication   ActiveSync  From the popup list  choose  Network and then click the Connect button     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Bluetooth    Bluetooth    Initial Use    17    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth or Bluetooth icon  in taskbar or Bluetooth icon on desktop  E Tap the Bluetooth icon in the taskbar to open the Bluetooth LXEZ Pairing  or application     The VX6 default Bluetooth setting is Enabled     The LXE HX3 Bluetooth   module is designed to Discover and pair with nearby LXE Bluetooth  devices  Only LXE printers or scanners are recognized and displayed in the Bluetooth panel  All  other Bluetooth devices are ignored     Prerequisite The Bluetooth devices  printers and or scanners  have been setup to allow them  to be    Discovered    and    Connected Paired     The SysA
315. rosoft website  Follow their  instructions to locate  download and install ActiveSync on your desktop  computer     For more information about using ActiveSync on your desktop computer  open ActiveSync  then  open ActiveSync Help  See also section titled    Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync    for more  ActiveSync information    Synchronizing from the VX6 using a USB ActiveSync connection     You must have set up ActiveSync on your desktop computer and completed the first  synchronization process before you initiate synchronization from your device     1  To initiate synchronization from your device  connect the USB cable to the PC and to the  dongle cable on the VX6  The VX6 connects automatically     2  Click the Syne Now button to synchronize with the PC    3  Click the Disconnect button or remove the cable to disconnect    4  To modify the Synchronization settings  see the Options icon on the ActiveSync window on  the desktop PC    Synchronizing from the VX6 using Serial or RF connection     You must have set up ActiveSync on your desktop computer and completed the first  synchronization process before you initiate synchronization from your device     1  To initiate synchronization from your device  tap Start   Programs   Communication    ActiveSync to begin the process     Click the Connect button   Tap the Syne Now button to synchronize with the PC     Tap the Disconnect button to disconnect     Gi a  ae    To modify the Synchronization settings  see the Options icon on
316. rt   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth    About tab        LXEZ Pairing   OK  x    Bluetooth Devices   Settings About       Bluetooth Address   00 40 FD 02 03 04  BTC version 1 0 BTCFPCESOAb  Bluetooth Stack Revision  1 3  Bluetooth Radio HCI 2 12288    Bluetooth Radio LMP 2 16907  Copyright 2006 2007 LXE Inc  El              Figure 1 14 About tab and Bluetooth Address    Next  create a Bluetooth address barcode label for the VX6     The format for the barcode label is as follows   e Barcode type must be Code 128     e FNC3 character followed by string Uppercase L  lowercase n  lowercase k  uppercase B  and then the Bluetooth address  12 hex digits  no colons   For example   LnkB0400fd002031     Create and print the label   Scan the VX6 Bluetooth address barcode label with the Bluetooth barcode reader   The devices are paired  The Bluetooth barcode reader responds with a series of beeps and LED    flashes  Refer to the following section titled    Bluetooth Beep and LED Indications        Note  After scanning the VX6 Bluetooth label  if there is no beep and no LED flash from the  Bluetooth device  the devices are currently paired        Free barcode creation software is available for download on the World Wide Web  Search  using the keywords    barcode create        VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Bluetooth Beep and LED Indications    23             Beep Type from Bluetooth Device Behavior  Acknowledge label 1 beep  Label rejected 2 beeps at low frequency       Transmis
317. rtificate is installed navigate to Start   Control Panel   Certificates     a 2  wr  Certificates    Set the drop down box to  My Certificates  as shown below     The correct user certificate should be shown in the right pane     Certificates     wv Certificates     Lists your personal digital  certificates    Figure 5 66 Certificate Stores       Click the View button     Certificate Details    Friendly Name    Field  Private Key y     Present              Figure 5 67 View Certificate Details    Set the Field to Private Key    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 241    Make sure the private key is Present   If it is not present  install the private key file     If there is no user certificate refer to    User Certificates     earlier in this chapter  to acquire a user  certificate and private key file     Setting EAP TLS Parameters    With the radio parameters configured  see    Wireless Network Configuration     set the EAP type to  TLS as shown     Wireless Network Properties    peapTest            rr    WPA          Figure 5 68 EAP TLS Configuration    Click the Properties button     Authentication Settings       Figure 5 69 Authentication Settings    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    242 Cisco Radio    Click the Select button to choose the user certificate        Figure 5 70 Select Certificate    Authentication Settings    User Certificate    Issued to  vx6user rf local  Issued by   RFRootcA        validate Server       Figure 5 71 Authentication Settings  C
318. s  facing down  Connect the antenna cable s  as follows     e  Single antenna     Connect antenna cable to Main a port or the Main b g port  depending on antenna type  Auxiliary port is not used        Dual a antennas     Connect antenna cables to both Main a and Auxiliary a ports     e Dual antennas  one a antenna and one b g antenna     Connect the a antenna cable  to the Main a port and connect the b g antenna cable to the Main b g port        Auxiliary  a Port       Auxiliary Main  b g Port   a Port    Figure 2 34 Summit 802 11 a b g Antenna Cable Connections    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    PCMCIA  CF and SD Slots 65    Summit CF Radio Card  The Summit 802 11b g radio has two antenna ports     The Summit CF radio is installed on a PCMCIA adapter  Hold the radio card with the  antenna ports facing down  Connect the antenna cable s  as follows     e Summit radio with single antenna     Connect antenna cable to Main port   Auxiliary port is not used     e Summit radio with dual antennas     Connect antenna cables to both Main and  Auxiliary ports        Port Port    Figure 2 35 Summit 802 11b g Antenna Cable Connections    Cisco Radio Card    Hold the radio card with the Cisco logo label facing up  Connect the antenna cable s  as  follows     e Single antenna     Connect antenna cable to right port  as shown below     e Dual antennas     Connect antenna cables to both ports     el  lo   e    e   E  z   e   E  lul       E   fu  m  m  9     Eo  5  E   gt   y  E   al  EH
319. s Full  All B and G rates   G rates only  6  9  12  18  24  36  48 and 54 Mbps   BG optimized or BG subset  1  2  5 5  6  11  24  36 and 54 Mbps    A rates only  6  9  12  18  24  36  48 and 54 Mbps   ABG Rates Full  All A rates and all B and G rates with A rates preferred   BGA Rates Full  All B and G rates and all A rates with B and G rates preferred   Ad Hoc    Default  BG Rates Full  for 802 11b g radio   BGA Rates Full  for 802 11a b g radio   Note  For the802 11 b g radio  some SCU versions may have the default set as BG Optimized  rather than BG Rates Full     It is important this parameter correspond to the AP to which the device is to connect  For  example  if this parameter is set to G rates only the LXE device may only connect to APs set for G  rates and not those set for B and G rates     The options for this parameter should be set as follows                       Antenna Configuration Radio Mode  A Main and BG Main ABG Rates Full  BGA Rates Full  A Main and A Aux A Rates Only  BG Main and BG Aux B Rates Only  G Rates Only  BG Rates Full  BG Subset  A Main only A Rates Only  BG Main only B Rates Only  G Rates Only  BG Rates Full  BG Rates Subset                Please contact your LXE representative if you have questions about the antenna s  installed on  your VX6     Infrastructure Mode vs  Ad Hoc Mode    e When any of the options except Ad Hoc are selected  the radio is in Infrastructure  Mode  meaning the radio attempts to associate with an AP     e When Ad Hoc
320. s S           5  Increase Contrast        Decrease Contrast         Increase Volume          The Brightness Adjustment keys have no function  Brightness is adjusted via the buttons on  the VX6 control panel    The Contrast Adjustment keys have no function because the VX6 is equipped with a TFT  display that has no provision for these adjustments    The Volume Control keys have no function as the volume control is adjusted via the Windows  CE Control Panel     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    282 Key Map 101 Key Equivalencies    T tthis k Press These Keys and Then p this ke  o get this key ress this key    Decrease Volume     7    F9    ewww    dS   LLL  T     1 xt     LL LI   LC  Esc ee   Enter  numeric  x EMEN Enter   Casto Tosa    x              Tab      I Le   Down Arrow  o  p bo   d Down Arrow  Right Arrow ERE ee O Right Arrow  Left Arrow   b   d Left Arrow  Delete  numeric  Pex        p    DOT  Page Down Pex    d         Down Arrow  F1 ppp   A  F2 lp      F2  F3 lo pp   F3       The Suspend Resume key has no function as Windows Power Management controls all power  management modes on the VX6    Press  lt Ctrl gt  then   2     then   F2   to produce Ctrl Break    NumLock is always On  This keypress sequence has no effect     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Key Map 101 Key Equivalencies 283    Press These Keys and Then    Pe sum   om  an  cession   F4 op T   jp   F4  F5 op pj   F5  F6 o pj   F6  F7 op CE   F7  F8 pp     jp   F8  F9 O T T   F9  F10 o pj   F10    To g
321. s checked  unprintable ASCII characters  characters below 20H  in scanned  barcodes are assigned to their appropriate CTRL code sequence when the barcodes are sent in  Character mode     The wedge provides a one to one mapping of control characters to their equivalent  control character sequence of keystrokes  If control characters are translated  the translation is  performed on the barcode data  prefix  and suffix before the keystrokes are simulated        Translate All   This option is grayed unless the user has Key Message mode  on the Main tab   selected  In Key Message mode  when this option is enabled  control  characters embedded in a scanned barcode are translated to their equivalent     control    key keystroke sequence  13  0x0d  is translated to Control M  keystrokes as if the user pressed the CTRL  SHIFT  and m keys on the  keypad   Additionally  when Translate All is disabled  any control code which  has a keystroke equivalent  enter  tab  escape  backspace  etc   is output as a  keystroke  Any control code without a keystroke equivalent is dropped        Character This is a drop down combo box that contains the control character name  Refer  to the Character drop down box for the list of control characters and their  names  When a character name is selected from the drop down box  the default  text Ignore  drop  is shown and highlighted in the Replacement edit control   Ignore  drop  is highlighted so the user can type a replacement if the control  character is
322. s configuration parameters as specified by the  Administrator     To set the AppLock parameters  please see Chapter 6     AppLock    for details     Bluetooth  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Bluetooth  Bluetooth is not supported with the Windows CE  NET Operating System  Please contact your  LXE representative for upgrade options    Certificates    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Certificates  Manage digital certificates used for secure communication     Lists the Stored certificates trusted by the VX6 user  These values may change based on the type  of radio security resident in the client  access point or the host system     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options    Date Time    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Date Time Icon    Set Date  Time  Time Zone  and Daylight Savings        Factory Default Settings       Current Time    Midnight       Time Zone    GMT 05 00             Daylight Savings   Disabled          Date Time Properties    Date Time    Current Time    April 2005 Lk   e 0euzam E  W TF OS 8  02 12 AM    31 1 2   Time Zone    311    14 15 16  GMT 05 00  Eastern Time  US      Canada     21 22 23 Automatically adjust clock for daylight saving    28 29 30    3 6 7       Figure C 8 Date Time Properties    There is little change from general desktop PC Date Time Properties options  Adjust the settings  and click the OK box or the Apply button to save the changes  The changes take effect  immediately  Double tapping 
323. s displayed on the screen   Survey Tab    Immediately runs signal strength and quality and link speed  An option is available to Setup  parameters for Active Mode reporting     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 223    Configuring for WPA             Wi Fi Protected Access  WPA  is only available on VX6 s equipped with the  u updated Cisco radio driver  release 2 60 or later         WPA requires software revision 1ED or greater  To identify the software revision   please click on the    About    icon in the Windows CE Control Panel         amp    Please refer to the    LXE Security Primer    to prepare the Authentication Server and  Access Point for VX6 communication        A23 It is important that all dates are correct on CE computers when using any type of  ES certificate  Certificates are date sensitive and if the date is not correct authentication  Date Time   will fail                 System Requirements  To support Wi Fi Protected Access  WPA   the VX6 must be equipped as follows   e Cisco 350 radio card with driver release 2 60  or later      The LXE VX6 supports WPA and all authentications  The Microsoft supplicant and Cisco  supplicants are used separately or together to provide support for the different authentications     Most of the configuration is done with the Microsoft Wireless Configuration tool WPA LEAP  requires the Cisco supplicant and configuration tool     Installing Radio drivers    Which version of the Cisco driver should be installed depe
324. s for Internet  connectivity        Factory Default Settings       General                                                                                           Start Page http   www lxe com   Search Page http   www  google com  Cache Size 512 Kb   User Agent Windows CE  Connection   Use LAN Disabled   Autodial Name Blank   Proxy Server Disabled   Bypass Proxy Disabled   Security   Allow cookies Enabled   Allow TLS 1 0 security Disabled   Allow SSL 2 0 security Enabled   Allow SSL 3 0 security Enabled   Warn when switching Enabled   Privacy   First party cookies Accept   Third party cookies Prompt   Session cookies Always allow  Advanced   Stylesheets Enable   Theming Support Enable   Multimedia All options enabled  Security All options enabled  Popups   Block popups Disabled   Display notification Enabled   Use same window Disabled             Select a tab  Adjust the settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take  effect immediately     VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 105    Keyboard    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Keyboard Icon    Set key repeat delay and key repeat rate        Factory Default Settings  Repeat Enable  Delay Short   Rate Slow   Key Map   Default                            There is no change from general desktop PC Keyboard Properties options  Adjust the settings and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     When new key maps are added to the registry  th
325. s going to be locked and any parameters  that are needed by the application  These registry settings are as follows     HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE  Software  LXE  Administration  AppName  HKEY LOCAL MACHINENNSoftwareNNLXENNAppCommandLine                          In addition to the registry settings needed to specify the application  additional registry settings are  needed to store the configuration options for AppLock  These options include  among others  the  administrator   s password and hotkey     HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE  Software  LXE  AppLock  Administration  HotKey   HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE  Software  LXE  AppLock  Administration  EP                             E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    340    Valid VK Codes for CE    Valid VK Codes for CE    This is the list of codes parsed by KEYCOMP compiler  Refer to Microsoft Windows documentation for further  clarification of the meaning of these key codes  Any VK keys not defined here are not valid for use under                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Windows 
326. s screen are saved in the  profile     When not logged in  the parameters can be viewed  but cannot be changed     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 187    Using the Scan Feature  Clicking the Scan button opens a pop up window displaying any APs found during the scan        Figure 5 6 Scan    The scan displays information on the available APs   e SSID   Lists the SSID of the network  e RSSI     Displays the Received Signal Strength Indication  RSSI  of the AP   e Secure     Displays True if the data encryption is used by the AP  false is data  encryption is not used   Notes  The APs can be sorted by clicking on any of the column headings     If there is more than one AP with the same SSID  the listing displays the AP with the  strongest signal and least security     If you are logged in as an administrator  you can use the Connect button to create a new profile   The button is grayed out is an administrator is not logged in     e Highlight the desired network in the listing and click the Connect button     e The new profile is named based on the SSID of the selected AP  If a profile already  exists with that name  the new profile name contains an incremental number to avoid  duplicate names     e The SSID parameter is assigned the value of the SSID of the AP  Other profile  entries must be completed manually     Click the Refresh button to update the display     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    188 Summit Radio    Parameters    IMPORTANT     Remember to clic
327. s to admin mode  If a password is specified  the  password prompt is displayed and remains until a valid  password is entered   Switching to admin registry read See the explanation of the    Registry read failure    above    LOG_PROCESSING  failure AppLock is switching into Admin mode  If a password  has been configured  the prompt will be displayed and  will not be dismissed until a valid password is entered   Switching to TaskbarScreenMode In administration mode  the taskbar is visible and LOG_EX  enabled   Switching to user mode The registry was successfully read and AppLock is LOG_PROCESSING  starting the process to switch to user mode   Switching to user hotkey press The system is currently in admin mode and is now LOG_PROCESSING  switching to user mode  The switch occurred because of  a hotkey press by the administrator   Taskbar hook failure AppLock is unable to control the taskbar to prevent the LOG_ERROR  locked application from re enabling it   Taskbar hook OK AppLock successfully installed control of the taskbar  LOG EX  Timeout looking for app window After the application is launched  AppLock must wait LOG ERROR  until the application has initialized itself before  proceeding  The application did not start successfully  and AppLock has timed out   ToUser after admin  not at boot The user mode switch is attempted when the device LOG EX  boots and after the administrator presses the hotkey  The  mode switch is being attempted after a hotkey press   ToUser after admi
328. screensaver chosen  this checkbox is ignored     Note  Screensaver option only works with Remote Desktop screensavers        a       E EQ VX6RG J    Password Properties    Password Settings    Password          Password     Confirm password       Enable Password Protection   _  At Power On   _  screen Saver       Figure C 15 Password Properties       VX6 Reference Guide    320 Control Panel Options    PC Connection    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   PC Connection    Control the connection between the VX6 and a nearby desktop laptop computer        Factory Default Settings  Allow Connection Enabled  Connect Using     USB Client                         Tap the Change button to adjust the settings and click the OK button to save the changes  The  changes take effect immediately     Unchecking the    Allow connection with          disables ActiveSync     Change         Clicking Change lists configured ActiveSync connections  In addition  there is a checkbox for  Automatic Connect  This option applies to USB connection only  If this checkbox is checked   when the USB cable is connected  the VX6 will automatically try to start ActiveSync over the  USB port  Note that this interferes with processes on the configured port at the same time     PC Connection Properties E OK  3      PC Connection       ac These settings control the connection between your Windows  CE device and desktop computer  Warning  Adjusting these   Eu settings may result in an inability to connect with
329. shold setting can be useful in  areas where many client devices are associating with the Access Point     Options  0 to 2347  Default  2347    LED    The LED on the radio card is not visible to the user when the radio card is installed in a sealed  mobile device     Options  On  Off  Default  Off    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 197    Tray Icon   Determines if the Summit icon is displayed in the system tray   Options  On  Off  Default  On    Hide Password   If On  the Summit Client Utility masks passwords as they are typed and when they are viewed   Options  On  Off  Default  Depends on SCU revision    Admin Password    A string of up to 64 alphanumeric characters that must be entered when the Admin Login button is  tapped  If Hide Password is On  the password is masked when typed in the Admin Password Entry  text box  The password is Case Sensitive     Default  SUMMIT    Note  Password is case sensitive     Auth Timeout    Specifies the number of seconds the Summit software waits for an EAP authentication request to  succeed or fail     If the authentication credentials are stored in the active profile and the authentication times out   the association fails  No error message or prompting for corrected credentials is displayed     If the authentication credentials are not stored in the active profile and the authentication times  out  the user is again prompted to enter the credentials     Options  An integer from 3 to 60  Default  8  Certs Path    A vali
330. sil iia 223  Inle A ici 223  Checking for the Cisco PEAP Stipplicant sssciszcsscccasesaaesateasaacauassacaaassaasaanasadaaeassaasadaancasteassaanncaatoas 224  Witeless  Network COn OO  rial is a EEE pati 226  PEAP MS CHAP Authentication ConfipurgllOD   2 2  nr itt ei 229  Configuring the PEAPI MS CHAP Supplicdnt ete ee ei rete tito three itte se esto 229  Server AptienticaoMe  Em 23   PEAP  GIL Augthentcoton Conc siria ias 232  Contipurinpg the PEAP GTC SUDDLICAlt  ai etr e toes R et ien RN sed 232  Server Authentication to aia 234  poo LTB a A A A                       237  MTS CO AL nece to TO Une A MEO UN HEN EI NUN dS 237  EAP TLS Authentication Configuration  ari 240  NSO WGC ALG as ara starts E ER cene testes 240  Setting HAPIVLS  DAA a Eis iut eeu EUREN  241  Validating the  Server Certifica asis 243  WPA ESKE CA A Na 244  Simbol Aa sacs E e E tn babbbannlniebaubuanbilanaaana 245  Mins socie ie nui doa bbc For oin te a ient 245  IS Inionpation E Deseo dass A nd usa dE 245  Wireless Information MI Eo RT T EP 246  VIEW LOT aerieni                                       246  Adda SI A E A E e a 247  Selecta User Certi oa ITI RR 248    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    x Table of Contents    E AAA 249  o A ORE tree CRW Tene RTE CORR NE RP RO WR YE ES NE 249  Generating a Root CA Certificate ssas n n E N 249  Tngtotimi a Root CA Certificat    ida 251  UE de ridic io iaa dd 233  Mug BN OSA cO nico E T 253  Installing     User Certi Idle a adaguanuiintubiiensuialgcasinataaio
331. sion error    Beep will sound high low high low                            Link successful Beep will sound low medium high  Link unsuccessful Beep will sound high low high low  LED on Bluetooth Device Behavior   Yellow LED blinks at 2 Hz Linking in progress   Off Disconnected or unlinked   Yellow LED blinks at 50 Hz Bluetooth transmission in progress       Yellow LED blinks at the same rate  as the paging beep  1 Hz     Paging          Green LED blinks once a second       Disabled indication          Upon startup  if the scanner sounds a long tone  this means the scanner has not passed its  automatic Selftest and has entered isolation mode  If the scanner is reset  the sequence is repeated     Contact LXE Support for assistance     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    24 Saving Changes to the Registry    Saving Changes to the Registry    The VX6 saves the registry when you   e Tap the Start   Run then type Warmboot  Tap OK     e Install Restart in the Start menu by Start   Run then type CTL RESTART 1 and tap the  OK button  Tap Start   Restart     The registry save process takes 0     3 seconds  If nothing has been changed  nothing is saved  e g   0 seconds     The registry is automatically saved every 20 minutes  It is also saved every tenth time the registry  settings are changed  Registry settings are changed when control panel applet  e g  Date Time   parameters are changed by the user and a warm boot was not performed afterward     When you tap the Start   Run then typ
332. st the settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take  effect immediately     Keyboard    Access     Set key repeat delay and key repeat rate     Start   Settings   Control Panel   Keyboard Icon       Factory Default Settings                   Repeat Enable  Delay Short  Rate Slow  Key Map   0409             There is no change from general desktop PC Keyboard Properties options  Adjust the settings and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     When new key maps are added to the registry  they will appear in the Key Map dropdown list on  the Keyboard Panel     These values do not affect virtual keyboard taps     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide                                     Sidetone    a   12 0dB    BA  34 5dB     12 0 dB    Figure C 12 Mixer    Control Panel Options      fox  x    Input    O None    ici    O Bluetooth     _ Input Boost       Select the Input for the mixer  Move the sliders to adjust the decibel level  Tap OK to save the    e None      No microphone  Use this setting when stereo headphones are attached to the    e Micl     Use this setting when a mono headset with microphone is attached to the    When checked   enabled  Input Boost provides increased sensitivity of the microphone by 20  dB  Input Boost can only be enabled after an Input type other than None is selected     316  Mixer  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Mixer Icon  Adjust the volume  record gain  and sidetone for microph
333. supplied by LXE   e PCMCIA to CF card adapter    e LXE recommends that installation of the CF card be performed on a clean  well lit  surface     e Loosen the captive screws securing the user access panel cover  The cover is  tethered to the VX6        Caution Make sure the VX6 has an uninterrupted power connection before beginning the  reflash procedure  Loss of power during the reflash process can result in  corrupted files                 IMPORTANT   Please contact LXE Customer Support for information on upgrading Windows  CE  NET to Windows CE 5 0  These instructions are only valid for upgrading to a newer  revision of the same operating system     How To  Reflash using Keypress Method    1  Place the PCMCIA adapter containing the CF card with new image files on it in the PCMCIA  slot next to the radio     Double click My Computer  then Storage Card folder    Select NK BIN  EBOOT NBO  XSCALE BIT  Select Edit   Copy    Tap Back Arrow  Doubleclick  System folder    Select Edit   Paste  When asked    Overwrite       click Yes to All    When the copy process finishes  remove the PCMCIA adapter containing the CF card   Select Start   Run and type Coldboot  Click OK     2 ch Qv We PS go    Before the splash screen appears  press and hold down the  lt A gt  key  Continue to hold it down  until the displays shows    Writing to boot flash       Note  If you do not press and hold the  lt A gt  key quickly enough  the display shows     Loading OS Image     Reboot and press and hold 
334. t  The  VX6 does not have a Bluetooth LED     See following section    Bluetooth    for more information     Only LXE Bluetooth scanners and LXE Bluetooth printers are supported by LXE  See  Accessories     RS 232 Data Entry    The VX6 accepts input from an RS 232 device connected to either RS 232 port  COM1 or COM3   labeled    COM2 3      The data is entered at the cursor position  and the data is subject to all of the  barcode RS 232 input menu parameters  such as truncate     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    10 Data Entry    Touchscreen Entry    Note    The touchscreen should be calibrated before initial use  See    Touchscreen Calibration   in Chapter 3   System Configuration      Note  Always use the point of the stylus for tapping or making strokes on the display  Never use  an actual pen  pencil or sharp object to write on the touchscreen     The touchscreen input performs the same function as the mouse that is used to point to and click  elements on a desktop computer  A stylus is used in the same manner as a mouse     single tap or  double tap to select menu options  drag the stylus across text to select  hold the stylus down to  activate slider bars  etcetera     Hold the stylus as if it were a pen or pencil  Touch an element on the screen with the tip of the  stylus then remove the stylus from the screen  The touchscreen responds to an actuation force   touch  of up to 4 oz  of pressure     The touchscreen can be used in conjunction with the keyboard and scanne
335. t F4 are disabled     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    268 Passwords    Passwords    A password must be configured  If the password is not configured  a new device switches into  Administration mode without prompting for a password  In addition to the hotkey press  a mode  switch occurs if inaccurate information has been configured or if mandatory information is  missing in the configuration     There are several situations that display a password prompt after a password has been configured     If the configured hotkey is pressed  the password prompt is displayed  In this case the user has 30  seconds to enter a password  If a valid password is not entered within 30 seconds  the password  prompt is dismissed and the device returns to end user mode     All other situations that present the password prompt do not dismiss the prompt    this is because  the other situations result in invalid end user operation     These conditions include     e If inaccurate configuration information is entered by the administrator  i e  an application is  specified that does not exist     e Ifthe application name  which is mandatory for end user mode  is missing in the  configuration     e Invalid installation of AppLock  e g  missing DLLs     e Corrupted registry settings   To summarize  if an error occurs that prevents AppLock from switching to user mode  the  password will not timeout and AppLock will wait until the correct password is entered   Troubleshooting    Can   t locate the passwo
336. t power management  all devices show the    high    power level  There are no user  options on this screen   VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 119    Regional Settings    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Regional Settings   Set the appearance of numbers  currency  time and date based on regional and language settings   No change from general desktop PC Regional Settings Properties options  Adjust the settings and  click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately    Options  and defaults  for the regional settings depend on the fonts included in the OS image   Please refer to the section on the About control panel earlier in this chapter for more details     A language must be installed before it can be selected  After selecting a language to use  and after  all changes are made  tap OK to save your changes then warmboot the device                                               Factory Default Settings  Regional Settings  Your Locale English  United States   Number 123 456 789 00    123 456 789 00 neg  Currency  123 456 789 00 pos     123 456 789 00  neg  Time h mm ss tt  tt AM or PM   Date M d yy short   dddd  MMMM  dd  yyyy long  User Interface Language  User Interface Language Dimmed  default is Your Locale setting   Input Language  Input Language Dimmed  default is Your Locale setting   Installed Input Languages   English  US           Tap the Customize button to set Number  Currency  Time and Date format for the se
337. t to Open  e The appropriate WEP keys must be entered   o 40 bit WEP keys consist of 10 hexadecimal characters of 5 ASCII characters  o 128 bit WEP keys consist of 26 hexadecimal or 13 ASCII characters   o After a WEP key is entered  it will be hidden from view if you return to the screen   However  the    Already Set    indicates if a key has previously been entered   Tap the WEP Keys button to enter WEP information  If a key is already entered  the Already set   Checkbox is checked  The previously entered key value is not displayed for security    Profile    WEP Keys  3 OK  nd   Key Size  Set   Key 40 128  Jv WEP Key 1 el eO    weey2O  00    WEP Key 3 Ol eO  I wekey  4O  0  Figure 5 35 Cisco Profile WEP Keys  LEAP    Note  The instructions in this section are for LEAP without WPA  Please see WPA LEAP later  in this chapter for instructions on using LEAP with WPA     Create a new profile or edit an exiting profile   e Network security must be set to LEAP     e The following parameters are accessible when LEAP is selected  Please enter the  appropriate information     o User Name  o User Password    o User Domain  optional     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    222 Cisco Radio    Firmware Tab    Displays the current firmware version and allows you to load new firmware  Tap the Browse  button to locate the new firmware file     Status Tab   Immediately runs status on   signal strength and signal quality   Statistics Tab   Select the Receive Stats or Transmit Stats  The data i
338. tab  The parameters on this tab can be set to  unique values for each profile  This tab was labeled Config in early versions of the SCU     The Status tab contains information on the current connection   The Diags tab provides utilities to troubleshoot the radio     Global parameters are found on the Global tab  The values for these parameters apply to all  profiles  This tab was labeled Global Settings in early versions of the SCU     Help  Help is available by clicking the   icon in the title bar on most SCU screens     The SCU help may also be accessed by selecting Start   Help and tapping the Summit Client  Utility link  The SCU does not have to be accessed to view the help information using this  option     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    182    Summit Tray Icon    Summit Radio    The Summit tray icon dil provides access to the SCU and a visual indicator of radio status     The Summit tray icon is displayed when     The Summit radio is installed and active  The Windows Zero Config utility is not active    The Tray Icon setting is On    Click the icon to launch the SCU     Use the tray icon to view the radio status     dl     amp  BBB B    The radio is not currently associated or authenticated to an Access  Point    The signal strength for the currently associated authenticated Access  Point is  80 dBm or weaker    The signal strength for the currently associated authenticated Access  Point is stronger than  80dBm but not stronger than  60 dBm    The signal strength f
339. tents xiii    DEVIC NAME MN A 326  A A lessties 326  Volume MIES ri   347  APPENDIXD REFERENCE MATERIAL     Oa  o eT                                                                      329  AppLock Error Messages NR 330  Fase Ee sid  is ipti n LT I 339  valid VK Codes for Esc 340  ASCII Control CodeS Sane eee ee ee ee ee eee eee ee Ree eRe Ree eee eer 341  Har xps 1  ITI 343  Decimal   Hexadecimal Ghart   sisirin naaa 345  Revision History csiscisscsinsssicsincssisadncssrsntentaasscccaanantantacnedesssianinciaansinreabesiassunnniecnnianss 347  ME M    E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    xiv    Illustrations    Figure 1 1  Figure 1 2  Figure 1 3  Figure 1 4  Figure 1 5  Figure 1 6  Figure 1 7  Figure 1 8  Figure 1 9  Figure 1 10  Figure 1 11  Figure 1 12  Figure 1 13  Figure 1 14  Figure 2 1  Figure 2 2  Figure 2 3  Figure 2 4  Figure 2 5  Figure 2 6  Figure 2 7  Figure 2 8  Figure 2 9  Figure 2 10  Figure 2 11  Figure 2 12  Figure 2 13  Figure 2 14  Figure 2 15  Figure 2 16  Figure 2 17  Figure 2 18  Figure 2 19  Figure 2 20  Figure 2 21  Figure 2 22  Figure 2 23  Figure 2 24  Figure 2 25  Figure 2 26  Figure 2 27  Figure 2 28  Figure 2 29  Figure 2 30  Figure 2 31  Figure 2 32  Figure 2 33  Figure 2 34  Figure 2 35  Figure 2 36  Figure 2 37    VX6 Reference    Table of Contents   VX6 Components  Top VIew scrinio s vie i Ud e Ie ire iniciada 6  VX6 Components  Front Vi Wisin n dv er vp Oa UR e E ERI UR E REAL 6  MRO COMPONEN Boltony Vi Wii ie ii ias 7  V Xo  Components  Back
340. tered user is listed and cannot be changed by the user     Memory sizes given do not include memory used up by the operating system  Hence  a system  with 64 MB may only report 35 MB memory  since 29 MB is used up by the Windows CE  operating system  This is actual DRAM memory  and does not include internal flash or the  internal ATA card used for storage     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    122 Control Panel Options    Memory    System Properties      General   Memory   Copyrights    Move slider to the left for more memory to run programs  Move slider to  the right for more storage room  Only unused RAM can be adjusted     Storage LEDITOCECKEUCOLEOHCOCUBIGOETUCPBECPCDETOCEHCCHGUCORELOCEDCEREDCERGEBODELUCEDCERUSU Program  Memory Eoo        M Memory    Allocated 11892KB Allocated 24152KB  In Use 1280KB In Use 8020KB       Figure 3 35 System   Memory    Move the slider to allocate more memory for programs or storage  If there isn   t enough space for a  file  increase the amount of storage memory  If the VX6 is running slowly  try increasing the  amount of program memory  Adjust the settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The  changes take effect immediately     Device Name    System Properties     General   Memory   Device Name   Copyrights    These settings are used to identify your Windows CE device to  other computers     Please type a name  without any spaces  and a short description     Device name   vxcoo1  Device description   LXE VXC       Figure 3 36 
341. tform type        e        Differences in operation or commands due to software revision        ATTENTION    Keyword that indicates vital or pivotal information to follow        A    Attention symbol that indicates vital or pivotal information to follow  Also   when marked on product  means to refer to the manual or user   s guide        A    International fuse replacement symbol  When marked on the product  the label  includes fuse ratings in volts  v  and amperes  a  for the product        Note     Keyword that indicates immediately relevant information        e  S  S  ES  S  S     gt     Keyword that indicates a potentially hazardous situation  which  1f not avoided   may result in minor or moderate injury              WARNING   Keyword that indicates a potentially hazardous situation  which  if not avoided   could result in death or serious injury   DANGER Keyword that indicates an imminent hazardous situation  which  if not avoided      gt        will result in death or serious injury        VX6 Reference Guide    E EQ VX6RG J       Quick Start                         Quick Start  This section   s instructions are based on the assumption that your new system is pre configured  and requires only accessory installation  e g  antenna  external keyboard and or barcode scanner   and a power source   In general  the sequence of events is   1  Install Vehicle Mounting Bracket on vehicle and secure VX6 in Mounting Bracket  Assembly  see    VX6 User   s Guide       2  Connect pow
342. the  English only  default  extended  fonts     When an Asian font is copied into the fonts folder on the  System folder  the font works for Asian  web pages  the font works with RFTerm  the font does not work for Asian options in Regional  Settings control panel  the font does not work for naming desktop icons with Asian names  the  font does not work for third party  NET applications  the font does not work for some third party  MFC applications     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    90 Control Panel Options    Identifying Software Versions    The    Versions    tab displays the versions of many of the software programs installed  Not all  installed software installed on the VX6 is included in this list and the list varies depending on the  applications loaded on the VX6  The LXE Image line displays the revision of the system software  installed  Please refer to the last three digits to determine the revision level  i e   in the example  below  the revision level is 2BT         About OK E    Software   Hardware Versions   Network IP                  LXE CF Radio Driver   SGCFGCECO1A    NET Compact Framework   v1 1  Internet Explorer   MSIE 6 0   LXE Utilities   YXCPC422BT   LXE Drivers   VXCPC422BT   LXE Image P2    VXCPC422BT             Figure 3 4 About Properties  Versions    Radio MAC Address  The    Network IP  tab displays the MAC address of the radio card     About kd OK  ES          Software   Hardware   Versions Network IP   l   Adapter 0 5M5C1111 Adapter 1 CISCO1
343. the  lt A gt  key again     9  The VX6 automatically reboots after flashing the bootloader     Loading OS Image    is  displayed on the screen and when the new OS finishes loading  all software upgrades are  complete    10  Secure the user access cover using the captive screws     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    136    Reflash the VX6    How To  Reflash using TAG file Method    revision  please click on the    About    icon in the Windows CE Control Panel      S  This method requires software revision 2BT or greater  To identify the software    1     ZA A p  amp     10     11     Place the PCMCIA adapter containing the CF card with new image files on it in the PCMCIA  slot next to the radio     Double click My Computer  then Storage Card folder    Select NK BIN  EBOOT NBO  XSCALE BIT  Select Edit   Copy   Tap Back Arrow  Doubleclick  System folder    Select Edit   Paste  When asked    Overwrite       click Yes to All     Additionally a REFLASH TAG file is needed to trigger the reflash  This file can be created  on the VX6 or copied to it along with the system files  The contents of the file are  unimportant  but the file must be named REFLASH TAG and it must be in the  System folder  with the new system load     When the copy process finishes  remove the he PCMCIA adapter containing the CF card   Select Start   Run and type Coldboot  Click OK   When booting  the VX6 looks for a file named REFLASH TAG in the  System folder     When this file is encountered  the VX6 loads a
344. the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to PEAP GTC  e Set Encryption to WPA TKIP  e Set Auth Type to Open    Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 21 PEAP GTC    Please review    Sign On vs  Stored Credentials     earlier in this chapter   Click the Credentials button     e No entries except the CA Certificate Filename are necessary as the user will be  prompted for the User Name and Password when connecting to the network     Enter these items as directed below     Credentials                Figure 5 22 PEAP GTC Credentials    Enter the Domain Username  if the Doman is required   otherwise enter the Username     Enter the password     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 211    Leave the CA Certificate File Name blank for now   Click OK then click Commit  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the Main tab   Please review    Windows Certificates Store vs  Certs Path    earlier in this chapter     Once successfully authenticated  import the CA certificate into the Windows certificate store   Return to the Credentials screen and check the Validate server checkbox        Credentials ES  User  user2    Password   LXE    CA Cert    roi trusted store  Es     Validate server Use MS store    Exc   cma      Figure 5 23 PEAP GTC Certificate Filename          If using the Windows certificate store   e Check the Use MS store checkbox  The default is to use the Full Trusted Store   e To select an individual certificate  click on t
345. the Summit Radio siii 182  E A A ee A     HO 183   ADAMO oen dette p RN dada inci 184  Auto Professorn                                                      A 185  Prone A N E O A ERE 186  Using the Scan F Satie TM m 187  PAE nuoi A TA sano eaaaieds 188  a A EA A R A NE 191  Diag A A 192  A A O enn Ne Pn eee 193  lyuusccRe T                         193  Pam RU NIRE ITI EEUU 199  Windows Cettificate Store vs  Certs PSI iii 201    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Table of Contents 1x    User e CE   tC                              201  Root WR iiie A detainee iglaeuibnluocabiabs 201  Summit Wireless A d Me MERERI Masa RE RARE ENA 203  NO on e                                 204  WEP emer                               H             M   n m 205  LEAP without WPA Authentication e veniet edt iai ed did 206  A                                  Q 208  PEAP GTC oan a n ccc er renner Me ee eer 210  bu LEAP e                                 a 212  EAP FAS e                       em                  214  BA PETS T                                               PM 216  WEA TPN eR Tc 218  Cisco ASIS                                   219  Cisco   Aironet Chent Utility  ACU oasis 219  Profiles Tabs 220  NO SECUI eocen E E E E mA sisneveatie aeaataceeaat 220  WER aers PER 22  EBAP uiu DM DE MU UL ID ee DELIS 221  liano T                                   iaess 222  Status  TDi atada 222  Statistics TD T          O                       222  SUN Tian 222  Contato WEA ads ir 223  System Requiem 
346. the first time   Note  USB will start automatically when the cable is connected  not requiring you to select   Connect  from the Start menu   Explore    From the ActiveSync Dialog on the Desktop PC  click on the Explore button  which allows you to  explore the VX6 from the PC side  with some limitations  You can copy files to or from the VX6  by drag and drop  You will not be allowed to delete files or copy files out of the Windows  directory on the VX6   Technically  the only files you cannot delete or copy are ones marked as  system files in the original build of the Windows CE image  This  however  includes most of the  files in the Windows directory      VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync 127    Disconnect    Serial Connection    e Disconnect the cable from the VX6     e Click the status bar icon in the lower right hand corner of the status bar  Then click  the Disconnect button     USB Connection    e Disconnect the cable from the VX6   e Click the status bar icon in the lower right hand corner of the status bar  Then click  the Disconnect button     Radio Connection    e Click the status bar icon in the lower right hand corner of the status bar  Then click  the Disconnect button     Important Information     Cold Boot and Loss of Host Re connection    ActiveSync assigns a partnership between a client and a host computer  A partnership is defined  by two objects    a unique computer name and a random number generated when the partnershi
347. the time displayed in the Taskbar causes this display to appear     If an Internet connection is available  click the Sync button to synchronize time with a time server     The VX6 includes a GrabTime utility     e  GrabTime can be executed manually at any time by clicking the Sync button on this  control panel     e GrabTime can be configured to synchronize the time at boot up  Please see       Enabling GrabTime     later in this chapter  for details     E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide    312 Control Panel Options    Dialing  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Dialing    Dialing Properties             Figure C 9 Dialing    Set dialup properties for internal modems  not supplied supported by LXE   Tap the         and  follow the instructions in Help     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 313                                              Display  Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Display Icon  Set background graphic  color scheme appearance  and power scheme properties   Factory Default Settings  Background Windowsce  Tile Disable  Appearance  Scheme  Windows Standard  Backlight  Battery Auto Turn Off Enabled  Idle Time 30 seconds  External Auto Turn Off   Enabled  Idle Time 2 minutes  Background  There is no change from general desktop PC Display Properties   Background options  Adjust the  settings and click the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately   Appearance  No change from general desktop PC Display Pr
348. tion  RS232  without universal  power supply     PowerScan 7000BT Base Station Power Supply  Std US  120V    PowerScan 7000BT  RS232 Cable for Base Station  DB9S  Coil   g   PowerScan 7000BT Battery Charger with Power Supply  Four  Station  US Std    PowerScan 7000BT Battery Pack   Bluetooth Standard Range Fuzzy Logic laser scanner  Bluetooth Auto range    LORAX    scanner   Desk Cradle  Radio Charging  Multi Interface   Desk Cradle  Charge Only  Mulit Interface   Forklift Cradle  Radio Charging  Multi Interface  Forklift Cradle  Charge Only  Multi Interface   US AC Power Cord   Universal Desktop Power Supply 90 264 VAC  9 60VDC Forklift Power Supply   Power Cable  connects Power Supply to Forklift   Cable Assembly  DA9F  9 ft  Cradle to Terminal  Forklift Rugged Scanner Holder with RAM mount  8800 Spare Battery   Single slot Universal Battery Charger Adapter Cup  Single Slot Battery Charger w International Power  Universal Battery Charger  4 slot  Requires 4 adapter cups  Scanner Holster for Belt   Mounted take up Reel   Auto Sense Intellistand  Hands Free Scanning    Strap with Scanner Clip    VX6 Reference Guide    Manuals and Accessories    8651A100BTLASERKIT  8652A100BTIMAGERKIT    8650A376BTBOHBATTERY    8650A377BTBOHCHGRUS  8651A379SINGLECHGRUS  8700A301SCNRBTSRI    8700A501BASERS232  8700A502PSACUS    8700A001CBL8DA9F    8700A503CHGR4US    8700A504BATT  8810A326SCNRBTFZ  8820A327SCNRBTER  8800A001CRADLERCMI  8800A002CRADLECMI  8800A003 CRADLEVRCMI  8800A004CRADLEVCMI 
349. tions Er   z RA ENS  PUDOR SS Som Cien EIU  Yes Yes Yes Yes  WEP Yes Yes Yes Yes  LEAP Yes Yes Yes Yes  WPA PSK Yes Yes Yes No  WPA LEAP Yes Yes Yes No  PEAP MSCHAP Yes Yes Yes No  PEAP GTC Yes Yes Yes No  EAP TLS Yes Yes No No  EAP FAST Yes Yes No No                               Radio Availability   The Summit 802 11a b g radio is available only with Windows CE 5 0    The Summit 802 11b g radio is available with Windows CE  NET or CE 5 0   The Cisco radio is available only with Windows CE  NET    The Symbol radio is available only with Windows CE  NET     Note  The Cisco and Summit radios are obsolete  Information on these radios is provided as a  courtesy to LXE s customer     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    180    Summit Radio    Summit Radio        S     The Summit radio requires software revision 2BT or greater  All VX6 s with a  Summit radio ship with this software revision or greater  To identify the software  revision  please click on the  About  icon in the Windows CE Control Panel        Please refer to the    LXE Security Primer  to prepare the Authentication Server and  Access Point for VX6 communication        AD         Date Time    It is important that all dates are correct on CE computers when using any type of  certificate  Certificates are date sensitive and if the date is not correct authentication  will fail        A          It may be necessary to upgrade radio drivers to in order to use certain Summit  Client Utility  SCU  features described in this
350. tooth devices    Certificates Manage digital certificates used for secure communication    Date Time Set Date  Time  Time Zone  and Daylight Savings    Dialing Set dialup properties for internal modems  not supplied supported by  LXE     Display Set background graphic  color scheme appearance  and power scheme  properties    Input Panel Select the current key   data input method    Internet Options Set General  Connection  Security  Privacy  Advanced and Popups    options for Internet connectivity        Keyboard Set key repeat delay and key repeat rate        KeyPad Remap keys to a single keypress  combination of keypresses or to  launch an application or command                                Mixer Adjust the volume  record gain  and sidetone for microphone input    Mouse Set the double click sensitivity for stylus taps on the touchscreen    MX3X VXC Set various device specific configuration options    Options   Network and Dial Set network driver properties and network access properties    Up Options   Owner Set VX6 owner details    Password Set VX6 access password properties    PC Connection Control the connection between the VX6 and a local desktop or laptop  computer    PCMCIA Manage PCMCIA cards    Power Displays the status of all power managed devices                 E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    88    About    Control Panel Options    Option Function    Regional Settings Set appearance of numbers  currency  time and date based on regional  and language settings
351. tylus tap is equivalent to a double click   e A touch and hold is equivalent to a right mouse click   Note  Some applications may not support this right click method  Please review    documentation for the application to see if it provides for right mouse click  configuration     USB Keyboard Mouse    A standard USB mouse can be attached to the VX6 using the appropriate dongle cable  A standard  USB keyboard can be attached to Platform 2 VX6   s using the appropriate dongle cable  The  dongle cable attaches to the VX6 and provides a USB connector  Please refer to documentation  provided with the USB keyboard and mouse for more information on their operation     To identify your VX6 platform type  please see    Identifying Your VX6     earlier in  this chapter     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    58 The QWERTY Keyboard    Input Panel  Virtual Keyboard     The Input Panel may be enabled via the Input Panel icon in the Control panel  The Input Panel  can be displayed as a large or small keyboard     Input Panel    Esc 1 2 3 4  5 6 7 8 9 0            Tabjqjw e rjt yju i o p E T   CAP  a s d f  g h  j k 1      shift  z x   c v b n m       7   CHET  Gs il Lele    Input Panel     e  Fa 62  ea   Pa   es es   7   Fe   ro  FrofF1a  P12  rona  ew  pron       1 2 3 4 s e 7 8   9  o        las   re a w e r  t v u  i  o  P E   1  V   Caps   ema sjajrjejn i k  tr z     rem  se z x  e v  b n m        ue   mo  jowtfwinf ef ins   cet  tejdnf rt  e       Figure 2 30 Small and Large Virtual K
352. un the app after it has loaded and client device is ready   HKEY LOCAL _MACHINE SOFTWARE LXE  Persist RFTERM    FileName     WINDOWS  LXE  RFTERM EXE    Installed  dword 0   FileCheck   ALWAYSEXEC    Order  dword 40   Delay  dword  1  When you are installing your custom CAB file to the mobile device   s operating sytem  refer to the  default image segments that are commented with        RFTERM        to see the expected Registry  format     One special key is included to force the system folders  Desktop  Fonts  Programs  etc   to copy  from the internal ATA card   System  to the  Windows directory  This is implemented as a persist  key so the sequence of startup events can be controlled  especially for AppLock   The filename is  a special internal trigger for the Launch utility  to activate the CopyFolders function  DO NOT  EDIT OR ALTER THIS KEY  OR IT MAY NO LONGER FUNCTION  You may however change  the Order or Delay values if necessary for a particular startup sequence      HKEY LOCAL MACHINE SOFTWARE LXE Persist COP YFOLDERS      FileName       COPY FOLDERS        FileCheck               Order    dword 0F    To have files  CAB  EXE  REG  or WAV files  loaded on startup  when sequence of execution is  not important  you can put these files in the  System Startup folder  on the internal ATA card    This is parsed by the Launch utility  and these programs are started or executed     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Utilities 133    REGEDIT EXE    Registry Editor   LX
353. unch Delay in seconds  after it terminates  This  option allows the Administrator to disable the re launch operation  AppLock cannot prevent all  applications from closing  When an application that AppLock cannot prevent from closing  terminates  perhaps because of an error condition  AppLock re launches the application when this  option is enabled     Note  If Allow Close is enabled and both Auto Re launch and Manual  Launch  are disabled   the application cannot be restarted for the end user or by the end user after the  application terminates     Auto Re Launch Retries default is 0 tries  Retries is the number of times AppLock will try to re   launch the application  The retry count is reset after an application is successfully launched and  controlled by AppLock  Valid values are between 0  no tries  and 99 tries or  1 for infinite   Infinite tries ends when the application successfully launches     Auto Re Launch Delay timer default is 0 seconds  no delay   Delay is the amount of time  AppLock waits prior to re launching an application that has terminated  The delay is specified in  seconds  Valid values are between 0  no delay  and 99 seconds     AppLock must also be configured to automatically re launch an application  To AppLock   application termination by the end user is indistinguishable from application termination for any  other reason     Manual  Launch     Allow Close    Default is Disabled  Enabling this option allows the end user to launch the specified  appl
354. using the scanner APIs  refer  to the    CE API Programming Guide    and the ClearBuf setting  When two applications are reading  the data using block mode  ClearBuf must be off so that the data is not erased when read     Note  The user can also open the WDG  device and perform standard OS read functions to  retrieve the data without using the LXE APIs     When Enable Internal Scanner Sound is checked  it does not affect any beeps emitted by a  Bluetooth or tethered scanner  In some cases  the scan of data by the external scanner triggers a  good scan beep from the scanner  and then the rejection of scanned barcode data by the processing  routine causes a bad scan beep from the VX6 on the same data     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    160 Barcode Manipulation    COM Port Tabs    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Scanner   COM1 or COM3    Do not connect a tethered scanner to the USB labeled ports     la         Scanner Control Ed    OK ES    Data Bits    O 38400 e 5  O 19200 O7   8  9600   O 4800 Stop Bits  O 2400    O 1200       COM1 and COM3 Panel Options are Identical   Figure 4 2 Scanner Control   COM Port Tab  Adjust the settings and tap the OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     The COM 1 tab contains the same parameters as the COM 3 Tab  Adjust the settings and tap the  OK box to save the changes  The changes take effect immediately     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Barcode Manipulation 161    Barcode Tab    Buttons    Acc
355. ust be properly set on the device to authenticate a certificate     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    218 Summit Radio    WPA PSK  To connect using WPA PSK  make sure the following profile options are used   e Enter the SSID of the Access Point assigned to this profile  e Set EAP Type to None  e Set Encryption to WPA PSK  e Set Auth Type to Open    Summit Client Utility             Figure 5 31 WPA PSK Encryption    Click WEP keys PSKs button     PSK Entry          Figure 5 32 PSK Entry    This value can be 64 hex characters or an 8 to 63 byte ASCII value  Enter the key and click OK     Once configured  click the Commit button  Ensure the correct Active Profile is selected on the  Main tab and warmboot  The SCU Main tab shows the device is associated after the radio  connects to the network     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Cisco Radio 219    Cisco Radio  The Cisco radio is a 2 4GHz 802 11b radio  This radio supports no encryption  WEP  LEAP or    WPA  PEAP MSCHAP  PEAP GTC  EAP TLS  WPA LEAP and WPA PSK  Configuring  without WPA    Cisco   Aironet Client Utility  ACU     Note  When making changes to profile parameters  the VX6 should be warmbooted afterwards     Access  Start   Programs   Cisco ACU or ACU Icon on Desktop    Aironet Client Utility    Statistics   Survey    Manage Profiles  Select Active Profile   Profiled Profiled    350 Series Radio is  Associated       Figure 5 33 Cisco Aironet Client Utility    Note  To configure WPA  please see    Configuring for W
356. utton   Add the data for the match codes     Barcode Data       Figure 4 12 Barcode Match Data for C1    Refer to the previous section BarcodeData Match List for instruction     Scan a barcode and examine the result     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    176 Screen Blanking    Screen Blanking    The VX6 can be configured to blank the display when the vehicle to which it is mounted is  moving  eliminating a possible distraction for the driver  When configured properly  the screen  blanking feature provides a tamper resistant method to blank the vehicle screen  The screen  blanking feature consists of Scanner Control Panel Options and a customer supplied cable  connected to one of the COM ports on the VX6  Properly configured  the display is visible only  when the cable provides a signal that the vehicle has stopped     The customer must supply their own cable  The cable specifications are detail in    Technical  Specifications     Screen Blanking Cable    in Chapter 2  Physical Description and Layout        The cable can be hooked to either the COM1 or COM3 port  The COM port used must be  selected in the Scanner control panel     Screen blanking is configured on the Main tab of the Scanner control panel     Scanner Control E OK El    Main   com   coma   Barcode    Port 2  O disabled                  disabled O Bluetooth       O comi O coma O comi O coma   O com1 serctl    COM3 Serctl   comi serctl    coms SerCtl      Output Enable C  Output Enable    _  Power Port 1 while as
357. v6 information screen  The contents cannot be edited by the user     Note    IPv6 can be disabled  Please see  Configuring IPv6 Broadcast Messages     earlier in  this chapter     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    246    Wireless Information Tab    View Log    Symbol Radio                                              Factory Default Settings   Wireless Information tab   Notify when new networks available Enabled  Advanced Button   Use Windows to configure wireless settings Enabled  Automatically connect to non preferred networks Disabled  Networks to access  Only APs  Only comp to comp    All available  Encryption  WEP  TKIP  WEP  Authentication  WPA  Open  Shared  WPA PSK  WPA  Ad hoc network Disabled  Key provided automatically Enabled  Enable 802 1X authentication Enabled  EAP Type  MDF Challenge  PEAP  TLS  TLS                NETWLAN1             Y Add New     A APOL     apne    Status  Connected to APO1  Signal Strength  Low    LIP Information   IPv6 Information Wireless Information  Select a network and press connect or right click for more options     Notify me when new wireless networks are available    ox  x      j       Advanced            View Log         Figure 5 76 Symbol Wireless Information Tab    Displays the logon connection data for the current network connection     VX6 Reference Guide       E EQ VX6RG J    Symbol Radio 247    Add a new connection  Select Add New  Enter the SSID in the Network Name text box     Wireless Network Properties    APOL a       
358. ver the Windows GrabTime ini file   System Grabtime ini also persists after a coldboot  Windows Grabtime ini does not persist   Misc    Options on this tab configure device specific options  Note that options not available on the VX6  are grayed out     MX3X VXC Options m OK E    Communication   MCP        CapsLock  C  NumLock        Touch Screen Disable              Touch Screen Heater Disable    O Screen size 640x480             Figure 3 24 MX3X VXC Options Properties   Misc Tab    CapsLock  By default  CapsLock is disabled after a warmboot  To enable CapsLock after a warmboot  check  this checkbox    Touch Screen Disable  By default  the VX6 touchscreen is enabled  To disable the touchscreen after a warmboot  check  this checkbox    Touch Screen Heater Disable    By default  the VX6 touchscreen heater is enabled  To disable the touchscreen after a warmboot   check this checkbox     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Control Panel Options 113    Network and Dialup Connections    Access  Start   Settings   Control Panel   Network and Dialup Connections  Create a dialup  direct  or VPN connection on the VX6     To configure the VX6 to use DHCP or a fixed IP address  select the desired connection  The  default is to obtain an IP address via DHCP     A static IP address can be assigned by clicking the Specify an IP address radio button and entering  the desired IP address  subnet mask and gateway        Cisco Wireless Lan Adapter    Settings       Figure 3 25 Network Connectio
359. w installed and ready to use     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Configuring the VX6 with LXEComnect 15    Using LXEConnect    1  Ifan ActiveSync connection is has not been established  connect the VX6 to the PC  Details    on ActiveSync are included in the following section     2  Double click the LXEConnect icon that was created on the desktop   3  LXEConnect launches       Yx3x001  Elle zoom Tools Help    RFTERM    u    A ar  El    My Device My b About CERDisp          Docurnents    Recycle Bin   Remote  Desktop     ger   gt  LL  tl  Internet Summit  Explorer Client Utility         amp  Sa 8 59 Pm  Figure 1 10 LXEConnect Notice    4  Click the OK button to dismiss the About CERDisp dialog box  The dialog box  automatically times out and disappears after approximately 30 seconds       Yx3x001  File Zoom Tools Help        RETERM  r nar LU   gt  2  EJ     My Device My LXE RFTerm  Docurnents       Microsoft    Recycle Bin    E Windows CE    Internet Summit Microsoft    t Windows CE v5 00 MX3XPESO01Bb  Explorer Client Utility         amp   gt  9 01 PM    Figure 1 11 LXEConnect Desktop    5  The VX6 can now be configured from the LXEConnect window  Input from the PC   s mouse  and keyboard are recognized as if they were attached to the VX6   6  When the remote session is completed  terminate the LXEConnect program by selecting File    Exit or clicking on the X in the upper right hand corner to close the application then  disconnect the ActiveSync cable   E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 
360. wer Properties sil  sec teas steaks athe EO OU ETHER D arthur GC En rcu 322  Figure C20 Stylus Properties   Recalibratob ainia cte a ent ede RT oci in 324  bigure C 21 Stylus Properties 7 RecaliDratioti sosa ita oe 324  Figure C2  System  General Dus arencor rope Hr er rd iii 325  Eius System MemOfy i unie Ebr EEG Ur eode bes He EM RS RUE p RE RSEN RR DRS 326  Fiere  5224 System  Device Name ccrte ti rire pe n Urb P Een tds 326  Fiene C 25 Vollime and SOU RET                                EEEE EERE 327  Figure D 1   Decimal  Hexadecimal Chart  0 to 159 Decimal  sii rico 345  Figure D 2  Decimal   Hexadecimal Chart  160 to 255 Decimal           5 eee eterne 346    VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Chapter 1 Introduction                                     Overview  The VX6 Vehicle Mount Computer  VMC  is a rugged  vehicle mounted  PC  Personal  Computer  running a Microsoft    Windows    CE operating system and capable of wireless data  communications from a fork lift truck or any properly configured vehicle  The VX6 provides  power and functionality in a vehicle mounted unit  with a wide range of options   CPU 400MHz Intel   PXA255  Memory 128MB DRAM  Displa Indoor or Outdoor half screen display  integrated Touchscreen   pray adjustable brightness  Wireless LAN radio  single or dual antenna   Network  n Ethernet port  connectivity  Optional Bluetooth module  Audio Speakers in front bezel  audio jack for headset with microphone  Compact Flash  Storage media PCMCIA  Secure D
361. where applicable     Chapter 1     Introduction Added Bluetooth information   Revised    Accessories    listing     Chapter 2     Physical Added Bluetooth information     Description and Layout Revised    Vehicle 12 80VDC Power Connection  with updated graphic        Chapter 3     System Added Bluetooth information   Configuration Revised    Mixer    and    Step 3  Check Barcode Length  sections   Revised    Enabling GrabTime        Revised    Wavelink Avalanche Enabler Configuration    for Avalanche  Mobility Center     Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Updated chapter for EAP FAST support  tray icon  help feature  etc   Configuration included in latest version of SCU        Revised section     Admin login        E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    350 Revision History    Revision G  May 2008    Section Explanation  Chapter 1     Introduction Revised    Accessories    listing     Chapter 2     Physical Revised    Install the 2 4GHz Type II PCMCIA Radio    and    NumLock and  Description and Layout the VX6        Chapter 3     System Revised    Control Panel Options        Vehicle 12 80VDC Direct Connection     Configuration and    Enabler Configuration        Added    Wi Fi    and    eXpress Scan    sections     Chapter 5     Wireless Network   Revised the following sections     Introduction        Summit Radio        Summit    Configuration Client Utility        Main Tab      Revised Profile Tab parameters     Radio Mode    and    TxPower        Revised Global Tab parameters
362. wide Internet   Option   Option  Terminal emulation application    Music management program   Opens an ASCII notepad   Log on to a Windows Terminal Server   Enter data using the stylus on the touchscreen  Option  Remote management for networked devices  File management program    Note  The Microsoft File Viewers cannot display files that have been password protected     E EQ VX6RG J VX6 Reference Guide    82 Start Menu Program Options    Communication    Access  Start   Programs   Communication    ActiveSync    Once a relationship  partnership  has been established with Connect  ActiveSync will synchronize  using the radio link on the VX6  See also  Chapter 1    Introduction     section    ActiveSync     Initial  Setup        Requirement  ActiveSync version 3 7  or higher  must be resident on the host  desktop laptop   computer  ActiveSync is available from the Microsoft website  Follow their  instructions to locate  download and install ActiveSync on your desktop  computer     For more information about using ActiveSync on your desktop computer  open ActiveSync  then  open ActiveSync Help  See also section titled    Backup VX6 Files using ActiveSync    for more  ActiveSync information    Synchronizing from the VX6 using a USB ActiveSync connection     You must have set up ActiveSync on your desktop computer and completed the first  synchronization process before you initiate synchronization from your device     1  To initiate synchronization from your device  connect the USB
363. y    Default is Ctrl Spc  Select the Global Key key sequence the end user is to  press when switching between applications  The Global Key default key  sequence must be defined by the AppLock Administrator  The Global key  Is presented to the end user as the Activation key        Global Delay    Default is 10 seconds  Enter the number of seconds that Applications must  wait before starting to run after reboot     Note    Delay  Global  may not be available in all versions of AppLock   You can simulate a Global Delay function by setting a delay for  the first application  lowest Order  launched and setting the delay    to 0 for all other applications  See Boot Options        Input Panel    Default is Disabled  Enable  check  to show the Keyboard option on the  Switchpad menu  When enabled the input panel cannot be enabled or  disabled for each individual application  and is available to the user for all  configured applications           Clear Button       Tap the Clear button to clear all currently displayed Filename or  Application information  The Global settings are not cleared        E EQ VX6RG J    VX6 Reference Guide       272 Application Configuration       Option Explanation       Scroll Buttons Use the left and right scroll buttons to move from application setup screen  to application setup screen  The left and right buttons update the  information on the screen with the previous or next configured application  respectively                 VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX
364. y Properties  Keyboard i o dio iaa 9   Accessibility Properties  SOUNA 5c reti ires cete e HO Base ctr oet E T ER ini 9   Control Panel   Bluetooth  oce mop HORE OEDIPUS 94  Discover Blustooib6viGeSs nda 94    Bluetooth Devices Panel ss cse poer ici HEUNR E OR SEA PUR URN SERERE CRUS 95  Bluetooth Device Discontect  Delete inier m HIPH RR neni 96  Bluetoothi Device Properties Mel  ipto re RE Heb ea ar ERE HUE ERR en e RR E Re To Fa ER ieee 96  Bluetooih Device Set  nps Panel aia et p D e Pr ae Ho HORS 97  Bluetooth About Panels ne teas toc a AT 98  Date Time Properties  Rm 100  Dialitig iia ica 101  Display Properties  Backlight Taba ia 102  Input Panel Properties enreda n ipe p ER eti AE 103  KeyPad Properties keyMap Tab   ires Rr nU Renate 106    MX3X VXC Options Properties   Communication Tab                        sess 111  MX3X VXC Options Properties  Mis   Tab    iei tn ee t oa E eH iE 112  Networle Connection Properties aia 113  Owner Propertie Sennen nan indica Os 114  Password Properties avisan sita idad ada 115  Communication  PC Connection Tab e erp rb a tt Ha ER Hn eben 116  PCMCIA Control Tab  Slot 0 and Slot  ttr n aH hn RE 117  Compact Flash ATA Control Tab  Slot 2    rri rt rt o a he dise 117  Power Propecia 118    Stylus Properties   Recalibration Start    etri alv dialers 120  StylmssPropertissy BecaliDPGiQ  nadas 120  System E Aa eR RI  121  System MEMON qaoniam Y dn nm Th OTRO DU e EET Etats 122  System Device NaMe dcus enean ERO epa a 122  Volume and  Sod
365. y reviewing the Status tab  When the device is property    configured  the Status tab indicates the device is Authenticated and the method used     11  The sign on screen is displayed after a reboot for each of the listed protocols     Note  Complete details are provided in the appropriate Summit Wireless Security section    following in this chapter     If a user enters invalid credentials and clicks OK  the device associates but does not  authenticate  The user is again prompted to enter credentials     If the user clicks the Cancel button  the device does not associate  The user is not  prompted again for credentials until the device is rebooted  the radio is disabled then  enabled  the Reconnect button on the Diags tag is clicked or the profile is modified and  the Commit button is clicked     VX6 Reference Guide E EQ VX6RG J    Summit Radio 201    Windows Certificate Store vs  Certs Path    User Certificates    EAP TLS authentication requires a user certificate  The user certificate must be stored in the  Windows certificate store     e To generate the user certificate  follow the instructions in    Generating a User  Certificate for the Mobile Device     later in this chapter     e Import the user certificate into the Windows certificate store by following the  instructions in    Installing a User Certificate on the Mobile Device     later in this  chapter     e A Root CA certificate is also needed for EAP TLS  Refer to the section below     Root CA Certificates    Root
    
Download Pdf Manuals
 
 
    
Related Search
    
Related Contents
Pacifico Yokohama Conference Center Emergency Information  CV940-CV1000 Owner`s Manual CH940-CH1000  tickets  Manuel d`utilisation - SMA Solar Technology AG  TL4.0BPDI (9KBP) INSTALLATION / OWNERS MANUAL    limpiador-bioalcohol-caselli-l-4-marmol-terrazo-barro  MOTORTRONICS    Copyright © All rights reserved. 
   Failed to retrieve file